UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
 
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
FORM 10-K
 
x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 or 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010
or
o TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 or 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from             to           
Commission File No. 0-15279

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 
 
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 

 
State of Alaska
 
92-0072737
 
 
(State or other jurisdiction of
 
(I.R.S Employer
 
 
incorporation or organization)
 
Identification No.)
 

 
2550 Denali Street
     
 
Suite 1000
     
 
Anchorage, Alaska
 
99503
 
 
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
(Zip Code)
 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (907) 868-5600
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act:  None
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Exchange Act:

 
Class A common stock
 
Class B common stock
 
 
(Title of class)
 
(Title of class)
 

 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
 
Yes o   No x
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Securities Act.
 
Yes o   No x
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.
 
Yes x   No o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (section 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).
 
Yes o   No o
 
 
1

 
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (section 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” "accelerated filer" and "smaller reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer o
Accelerated filer x
Non-accelerated filer o (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
Smaller reporting company o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes o   No x

The aggregate market value of the voting stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant, computed by reference to the average high and low prices of such stock as of the close of trading as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter of June 30, 2010 was $208,185,109. Shares of voting stock held by each officer and director and by each person who owns 5% or more of the outstanding voting stock (as publicly reported by such persons pursuant to Section 13 and Section 16 of the Exchange Act) have been excluded in that such persons may be deemed to be affiliates. This determination of affiliate status is not necessarily a conclusive determination for other purposes.

The number of shares outstanding of the registrant’s common stock as of March 1, 2011, was:
Class A common stock – 43,868,438 shares; and,
Class B common stock – 3,178,019 shares.

Documents Incorporated by Reference
Portions of the Registrant's definitive proxy statement relating to its 2011 Annual Meeting of Shareholders are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Annual Report on Form 10-K where indicated.  Alternatively, the Registrant may file an amendment to this Form 10-K to provide such information within 120 days following the end of Registrant's fiscal year ended December 31, 2010.

 
2

 

GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
2010 ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K
TABLE OF CONTENTS

         
Page No.
           
Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
4
           
Part I
 
 
Item I.
Business
   
4
 
Item IA.
Risk Factors
   
27
 
Item IB.
Unresolved Staff Comments
   
32
 
Item 2.
Properties
   
33
 
Item 3.
Legal Proceedings
   
33
 
Item 4.
(Removed and Reserved)
   
33
           
Part II
 
       
 
Item 5.
Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
   
34
 
Item 6.
Selected Financial Data
   
37
 
Item 7.
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
    37
 
Item 7A.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
   
62
 
Item 8.
Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
   
62
 
Item 9.
Changes In and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
   
62
 
Item 9A.
Controls and Procedures
   
62
 
Item 9B.
Other Information
   
64
           
Part III
     
 
Item 10.
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
   
64
 
Item 11.
Executive Compensation
   
69
 
Item 12.
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
   
91
 
Item 13.
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
   
94
 
Item 14.
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
   
97
           
Part IV
   
 
Item 15.  Exhibits, Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules
   
100
       
SIGNATURES
 
   
158


This Annual Report on Form 10-K is for the year ending December 31, 2010. This Annual Report modifies and supersedes documents filed prior to this Annual Report. The Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) allows us to “incorporate by reference” information that we file with them, which means that we can disclose important information to you by referring you directly to those documents. Information incorporated by reference is considered to be part of this Annual Report. In addition, information that we file with the SEC in the future will automatically update and supersede information contained in this Annual Report.

 
3

 


Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements

You should carefully review the information contained in this Annual Report, but should particularly consider any risk factors that we set forth in this Annual Report and in other reports or documents that we file from time to time with the SEC. In this Annual Report, in addition to historical information, we state our future strategies, plans, objectives or goals and our beliefs of future events and of our future operating results, financial position and cash flows. In some cases, you can identify those so-called “forward-looking statements” by words such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “expects,” “plans,” “anticipates,” “believes,” “estimates,” “predicts,” “potential,” “project,” or “continue” or the negative of those words and other comparable words. All forward-looking statements involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other important factors that may cause our actual results, performance, achievements, plans and objectives to differ materially from any future results, performance, achievements, plans and objectives expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements. In evaluating those statements, you should specifically consider various factors, including those identified under “Risk Factors,” and elsewhere in this Annual Report. Those factors may cause our actual results to differ materially from any of our forward-looking statements. For these forward-looking statements, we claim the protection of the safe harbor for forward-looking statements provided by the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995.

You should not place undue reliance on any such forward-looking statements. Further, any forward-looking statement, and the related risks, uncertainties and other factors speak only as of the date on which they were originally made and we expressly disclaim any obligation or undertaking to update or revise any forward-looking statement to reflect any change in our expectations with regard to these statements or any other change in events, conditions or circumstances on which any such statement is based. New factors emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict what factors will arise or when. In addition, we cannot assess the impact of each factor on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements.

Part I

Item 1. Business

General
In this Annual Report, “we,” “us,” “our,” "GCI" and “the Company” refer to General Communication, Inc. and its direct and indirect subsidiaries.

GCI was incorporated in 1979 under the laws of the State of Alaska and has its principal executive offices at 2550 Denali Street, Suite 1000, Anchorage, AK 99503-2781 (telephone number 907-868-5600).

GCI is primarily a holding company and together with its direct and indirect subsidiaries, is a diversified communications provider with operations primarily in the state of Alaska.

Availability of Reports and Other Information
Internet users can access information about the Company and its services at http://www.gci.com/, http://www.gci-industrialtelecom.com, http://www.unicom-alaska.com/, http://www.alaska-wireless.com/ and http://www.alaskaunited.com/. The Company hosts Internet services at http://www.gci.net/, broadband delivery of health services at http://www.connectmd.com, and SchoolAccess® services at http://www.schoolaccess.net/. The Company hosts information about our TERRA-Southwest (“TERRA-SW”) project at http://terra.gci.com/.

We make available on the http://www.gci.com/ website, free of charge, access to our Annual Report on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K, Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A and amendments to those materials filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically submit such material to the SEC. In addition, the SEC’s website is http://www.sec.gov/. The SEC makes available on this website, free of charge, reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers, such as us, that file electronically with the SEC. Information on our websites or the SEC’s website is not part of this document.

 
4

 
Financial Information about Industry Segments
Our five reportable segments are Consumer, Network Access, Commercial, Managed Broadband, and Regulated Operations.

For financial information about our reportable segments, see “Part II — Item 7 — Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”  Also refer to note 10 included in “Part II — Item 8 — Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

Narrative Description of our Business

General
We are the largest communications provider in Alaska as measured by revenues. We offer facilities-based local and long-distance voice services, cable television, data and Internet access to residential and business customers across the state under our GCI brand. In addition, we provide wireless telephone services over our own facilities under the GCI and Alaska Wireless brand names. Due to the unique nature of the markets we serve, including harsh winter weather and remote geographies, our customers rely extensively on our systems to meet their communication and entertainment needs. We benefit from the attractive demographic and economic characteristics of Alaska.

Since our founding in 1979 as a competitive long distance provider, we have consistently expanded our product portfolio and facilities to become the leading integrated communication services provider in our markets. Our facilities include redundant and geographically diverse digital undersea fiber optic cable systems linking our Alaska terrestrial networks to the networks of other carriers in the lower 48 contiguous states. As of December 31, 2010, our cable systems passed 84% of Alaska’s households, and we have achieved 55% basic cable penetration of the homes we reach. We believe we offer superior video services relative to digital broadcast satellite (“DBS”), which is limited by Alaska’s geographic location, challenging climate and terrain features. We have continued our statewide deployment of digital local phone service (“DLPS”) utilizing our own coaxial cable facilities enabling us to move off of facilities that we previously leased from incumbent local exchange carriers (“ILEC”). At December 31, 2010, 76% of the local access lines we served were carried on our own last mile facilities. In recent years, we expanded our efforts in wireless and presently operate the only statewide wireless network. Our network provides access for both global system for mobile communications (“GSM”) and code division multiple access (“CDMA”) based devices, and can provide us with an eventual path to fourth generation Long Term Evolution (“LTE”) based wireless communications.

Our Consumer segment serves residential customers. Our Network Access segment serves other common carriers. Our Commercial segment serves small businesses, local, national and global businesses, governmental entities, and public and private educational institutions. Our Managed Broadband segment serves rural school districts, hospitals and health clinics. The financial results of the long-distance, local access and Internet services sold to consumer and commercial customers that we serve in the Bethel, Alaska area are reported in the Regulated Operations segment.

For the year ended December 31, 2010, we generated consolidated revenues of $651.3 million. We ended the period with approximately 97,500 long-distance customers, 144,800 local access lines in service, 147,100 basic cable subscribers, 138,700 wireless subscribers and 116,900 cable modem subscribers.

Development of our Business During the Past Fiscal Year
TERRA-SW Project.  In January 2010 the U.S. Department of Agriculture’s Rural Utilities Service (“RUS”) approved our wholly-owned subsidiary, United Utilities, Inc.’s (“UUI”) application for an $88.2 million loan/grant combination to extend terrestrial broadband service for the first time to Bristol Bay and the Yukon-Kuskokwim Delta, an area in Alaska roughly the size of the state of North Dakota.  Upon completion TERRA-SW will be able to serve over 9,000 households and over 700 businesses in the 65 covered communities.  The project will also be able to serve numerous public/non-profit/private community anchor institutions and entities, such as regional health care providers, school districts, and other regional and Alaska Native organizations. The RUS award, consisting of a $44.2 million loan and a $44.0 million grant, will be made under the RUS Broadband Initiatives Program established pursuant to the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act.  The grant portion of the award will fund backbone network facilities that we would not otherwise be able to construct within our return-on-investment requirements.  UUI began construction on TERRA-SW in 2010 and expects to complete the project in 2012 or earlier if possible.

 
5

 
You should see “Part I — Item 1. Business — Regulation” for regulatory developments.

Business Strategy
We intend to continue to increase revenues using the following strategies:

Offer Bundled Products. We offer innovative service bundles to meet the needs of our consumer and commercial customers. We believe that bundling our services significantly improves customer retention, increases revenue per customer and reduces customer acquisition expenses. Our experience indicates that our bundled customers are significantly less likely to churn, and we experience less price erosion when we effectively combine our offerings. Bundling improves our top line revenue growth, provides operating cost efficiencies that expand our margins and drives our overall business performance. As a measure of success to date, over 62,600 of our residential customers subscribe to one of our service bundles that include two or more services.

Maximize Sales Opportunities. We successfully sell new and enhanced services and products between and within our business segments to our existing customer base to achieve increased revenues and penetration of our services. Through close coordination of our customer service and sales and marketing efforts, our customer service representatives suggest to our customers other services they can purchase or enhanced versions of services they already purchase. Many calls into our customer service centers or visits into one of our 32 retail stores result in sales of additional services and products.

Deliver Industry Leading Customer Service. We have positioned ourselves as a customer service leader in the Alaska communications market. We have organized our operations to effectively focus on our customers. We operate our own customer service department and maintain and staff our own call centers. We have empowered our customer service representatives to handle most service issues and questions on a single call. We prioritize our customer services to expedite handling of our most valuable customers’ issues, particularly for our largest commercial customers. We believe our integrated approach to customer service, including service set-up, programming various network databases with the customer’s information, installation, and ongoing service, allows us to provide a customer experience that fosters customer loyalty.

Leverage Communications Operations. We continue to expand and evolve our integrated network for the delivery of our services. Our bundled strategy and integrated approach to serving our customers creates efficiencies of scale and maximizes network utilization. By offering multiple services, we are better able to leverage our network assets and increase returns on our invested capital. We periodically evaluate our network assets and continually monitor technological developments that we can potentially deploy to increase network efficiency and performance.
 
Expand Our Product Portfolio and Footprint in Alaska. Throughout our history, we have successfully added and expect to continue to add new products to our product portfolio. We have a demonstrated history of new product evaluation, development and deployment for our customers, and we continue to assess revenue-enhancing opportunities that create value for our customers. In addition to new services such as additional high definition television ("HDTV") channels, video-on-demand, on-line advertising placement, on-line content delivery such as streaming music, and mobile high speed data, we are also expanding the reach of our core products to new markets. Where feasible and where economic analysis supports geographic expansion of our network coverage, we are currently pursuing or expect to pursue opportunities to increase the scale of our facilities, enhance our ability to serve our existing customers’ needs and attract new customers.
 
Make Strategic Acquisitions.  We have a history of making and integrating acquisitions of in-state telecommunications providers. In 2008, we completed three acquisitions of telecommunications providers in various Alaska communities. Our management team is adept at sourcing, acquiring and integrating these acquired companies, and we will continue to actively pursue and buy companies that we believe fit with our strategy and networks and that enhance earnings.

Description of our Business by Reportable Segment

Overview
Our five reportable segments are Consumer, Network Access, Commercial, Managed Broadband, and Regulated Operations. Our reportable segments are business units that offer different products, are each managed separately, and serve distinct types of customers.

 
6

 
 Following are our segments and the services and products each offers to its customers:

 
 
Reportable Segments
Services and Products
Consumer
Network Access
Commercial
Managed Broadband
Regulated Operations
Voice:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long-distance
X
X
X
 
X
 
Local Access
X
X
X
 
X
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Video
X
 
X
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Data:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Internet
X
X
X
X
X
 
Data Networks
 
X
X
X
 
 
Managed Services
 
 
X
X
 
 
Managed Broadband Services
 
 
 
X
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wireless
X
X
X
 
 

Many of our networks and facilities are utilized by more than one segment to provide services and products to our customers. The following description of our business by reportable segment includes a comprehensive discussion within the Consumer segment section with references to that section if such common network and facility use exists in another segment. Similarly, many of the same services and products are sold to our customers in different segments.

The following discussion includes information about significant services and products, sales and marketing, facilities, competition and seasonality for each of our five reportable segments.  For a discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations please see “Part II – Item 7 – Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

Consumer Segment
Consumer segment revenues for 2010, 2009 and 2008 are summarized as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Total Consumer segment revenues1
  $ 342,898       294,925       255,632  



1  See “Part II — Item 7 — Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and note 10 included in “Part II — Item 8 — Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for more information regarding the financial performance of our Consumer segment.


Services and Products
Our Consumer segment offers a full range of voice, video, data and wireless services and products to residential customers.

Voice Services and Products
Revenues derived from Consumer segment voice services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $57.3 million, $52.7 million, and $47.0 million, respectively, or 9%, 9%, and 8% of our total revenues, respectively.


 
7

 

Long-Distance
We are a full-service long-distance provider including intrastate, interstate and international calling. The value of our long-distance services is generally designed to be equal to or greater than that for comparable services provided by our competitors.

Local Access
We offer local access services in many communities and areas in Alaska, including the state’s five largest population centers, Anchorage, Fairbanks, the Matanuska-Susitna Valley, the Kenai Peninsula, and Juneau.  Our own DLPS facilities and collocated remote facilities that access the ILEC unbundled network element ("UNE") loops allow us to offer full featured local service products to customers. In areas where we do not have our own DLPS facilities or access to ILEC UNE loop facilities, we offer service using total service resale of the ILEC’s local service or UNE platform.

Video Services and Products
Revenues derived from Consumer segment video services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $118.5 million, $111.0 million, and $105.2 million, respectively, or 18%, 19%, and 18% of our total revenues, respectively.

Our cable television systems serve 41 communities and areas in Alaska, including the state’s five largest population centers, Anchorage, Fairbanks, the Matanuska-Susitna Valley, the Kenai Peninsula, and Juneau.

We offer a full range of video services over our broadband cable systems. Our video service offerings include the following:

Basic cable. Our basic cable service consists of digital basic service with access to between 13 and 21 channels of programming and an expanded digital basic service with access to between 40 and 102 additional channels of programming. These services generally consist of programming provided by national and local broadcast networks, national and regional cable networks, and governmental and public access programming.  We transmit an entirely digital signal for all cable television channels in all markets we serve.

High-definition television. Our high definition television ("HDTV") service provides our subscribers with improved, high-resolution picture quality, improved audio quality and a wide-screen, theater-like display. Our HDTV service offers a broad selection of high-definition programming with access of up to 82 high-definition channels including most major broadcast networks, leading national cable networks, premium channels and national sports networks.

Digital video recorder. Our advanced digital video recorder ("DVR") service lets digital cable subscribers select, record and store programs and play them at whatever time is convenient. DVR service also provides the ability to pause and rewind “live” television.

Premium channel programming. Our premium channel programming service, which includes cable networks such as Home Box Office, Showtime, Starz and Cinemax, generally offers, without commercial interruption, feature motion pictures, live and taped sporting events, concerts and other special features.

Video on demand.  Our video on demand service permits our cable subscribers to order at their convenience and for a separate fee, individual feature motion pictures and special event programs, on an unedited, commercial-free basis.

Pay-per-view programming. Our pay-per-view service permits our cable subscribers to order, for a separate fee, scheduled individual feature motion pictures and special event programs, such as professional boxing, professional wrestling and concerts, on an unedited, commercial-free basis.

Data Services and Products
Revenues derived from Consumer segment data services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $61.4 million, $50.3 million, and $42.7 million, respectively, or 9%, 8%, and 7% of our total revenues, respectively.

Internet
We primarily offer four types of Internet access for consumer use: high-speed cable modem, dial-up, mobile wireless and fixed wireless. Value-added Internet features, such as e-mail virus prevention, personal web
 
 
8

 
site and domain hosting, and additional e-mail accounts, are available for additional charges. Our consumer high-speed cable modem Internet service offers up to 22 Mbps download and 2 Mbps upload speeds.

Wireless Services and Products
Revenues derived from Consumer segment wireless services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $105.7 million, $81.0 million, and $60.7 million, respectively, or 16%, 14%, and 11% of our total revenues, respectively.

We offer mobile wireless voice and data services by selling services over our own facilities under the GCI and Alaska Wireless brand names. We offer fixed wireless local access services over our own facilities, have purchased personal communication services ("PCS") and local multipoint distribution system ("LMDS") wireless broadband licenses in Federal Communications Commission ("FCC") auctions covering markets in Alaska, and secured cellular licenses utilizing the FCC’s established process. We offer mobile wireless service to our customers in the state’s five largest population centers, Anchorage, Fairbanks, the Matanuska-Susitna Valley, the Kenai Peninsula, and Juneau and many other small Alaska communities.

We offer our customers a variety of post-paid and prepaid wireless rate plans so they can choose the plan that best fits their expected calling needs. Consumer voice service is generally offered on a contract basis for one or two year periods. Under the terms of these contracts, service is billed and provided on a monthly basis according to the applicable rate plan chosen. Our offerings include regional and national rate plans at a variety of pricing tiers. Our wireless voice plans generally combine a fixed monthly access charge, a designated number of minutes-of-use, per minute usage charges for minutes in excess of the included amount and additional charges for certain custom-calling features. Most of our plans include basic features such as voice messaging, caller ID, call forwarding and call waiting, and two-way text messaging.  Wireless data service is included in certain plans or can be purchased as a feature to a plan.

We sell a variety of handsets and personal computer wireless data cards manufactured by various suppliers for use with our wireless services. We also sell accessories, such as carrying cases, hands-free devices, batteries, battery chargers and other items. We provide contract subscribers substantial equipment subsidies to initiate, continue or upgrade service.

Bundled Services and Products
We combine one or more of our individual service and product offerings into bundles that we sell to our Consumer segment customers at attractive prices.  Our most popular bundled offering includes long-distance, cable television, cable modem Internet access and local access services.  In addition to several other bundled offerings, we also offer a bundle of wireless services, cable television and cable modem Internet access.

Sales and Marketing
Our Consumer segment sales efforts are primarily directed toward increasing the number of subscribers we serve, selling bundled services, and generating incremental revenues through product and feature up-sell opportunities.

Facilities
We operate a modern, competitive communications network employing digital transmission technology over our fiber optic facilities within Alaska and between Alaska and the lower 48 states. Our facilities include three self-constructed digital undersea fiber optic cable systems linking our Alaska terrestrial networks to the networks of other carriers in the lower 48 states:

·  
Alaska United East was placed into service in 1999 and connects Whittier, Valdez and Juneau, Alaska and Seattle, Washington,
·  
Alaska United West was placed into service in 2004 and connects Seward, Alaska to Warrenton, Oregon, and
·  
Alaska United Southeast was placed into service in 2008 and connects Ketchikan, Wrangell, Petersburg, Angoon and Sitka, Alaska to Alaska United West and Alaska United East.

The combination of our Alaska United East, Alaska United West and Alaska United Southeast systems provides us with the ability to provide fully protected geographically diverse routing of service between Alaska and the lower 48 states.

 
9

 
Our Alaska United Northwest self-constructed terrestrial fiber optic cable system connects Anchorage and Fairbanks, Alaska along the Parks Highway corridor and we own a terrestrial fiber optic cable system that extends from Prudhoe Bay, Alaska to Valdez, Alaska via Fairbanks, Alaska.

We have indefeasible rights to use ("IRU") capacity in the Kodiak-Kenai Cable Company, LLC’s undersea fiber optic cable system linking Anchorage to Kenai, Homer, Kodiak, Narrow Cape on Kodiak Island, and Seward, Alaska.

Another carrier operates a pair of fiber optic cable facilities connecting points in Alaska to the lower 48 states. This additional fiber system provides direct competition to services we provide on our owned fiber optic cable facilities.

We serve many rural and remote Alaska locations solely via satellite communications. Each of our C-band and Ku-band satellite transponders is backed up on the same spacecraft with multiple backup transponders. The primary spacecrafts we use to provide voice, data and Internet services to our rural Alaska customers are Intelsat’s Galaxy 18 for C-band and Intelsat's Horizons 1 for Ku-band, but we also lease capacity on two other spacecraft, SES Americom’s AMC-7 and AMC-8.

We also lease one 36 MHz transponder on SES Americom's AMC-7 spacecraft.  We use this transponder to distribute multi-channel, digitally encoded video programming and services to remote locations within Alaska.  We may use this transponder along with two others that we reserve on AMC-7 to restore service during any fiber outage that may occur in our network.

We operate digital microwave systems to link Anchorage with the Kenai Peninsula, our Prudhoe Bay Earth Station with Deadhorse, Alaska, and to link Bethel, Alaska with 40 rural communities. Virtually all switched services are computer controlled, digitally switched, and interconnected by a packet switched SS7 signaling network.

Other facilities include major earth stations at Adak, Barrow, Bethel, Cordova, Dillingham, Dutch Harbor, Eagle River, Galena, Juneau, Ketchikan, King Salmon, Kodiak, Kotzebue, McGrath, Nome, Prudhoe Bay, Sitka, Unalakleet, and Yakutat, all in Alaska, serving the communities in their vicinity, and at Issaquah, Washington, which provides interconnection to Seattle and the lower 48 states for traffic to and from major Alaska earth stations. The Eagle River earth station is linked to the Anchorage distribution center by fiber optic facilities.

We use a synchronous optical network ("SONET") as a service delivery method for our terrestrial metropolitan area networks and long-haul terrestrial and undersea fiber optic cable systems.

A fiber optic cable system from our Anchorage distribution center connects to the Matanuska Telephone Association (“MTA”), Eagle River central office and to our major hub earth station in Eagle River. The Issaquah earth station is connected with the Seattle distribution center by means of diversely-routed leased fiber optic cable transmission systems, each having the capability to restore the other in the event of failure. The Juneau earth station and distribution centers are collocated. We have digital microwave facilities serving the Kenai Peninsula communities. We maintain earth stations in Fairbanks (linked by digital microwave to the Fairbanks distribution center), Juneau (collocated with the Juneau distribution center), Anchorage (Benson earth station), and in Prudhoe Bay as fiber network restoration earth stations. Our Benson earth station also uplinks our statewide video service; such service may be pre-empted if earth station capacity is needed to restore our fiber network between Anchorage and Prudhoe Bay.

We use our demand assigned multiple access ("DAMA") facilities to serve 69 additional locations throughout Alaska. DAMA is a digital satellite earth station technology that allows calls to be made between remote villages using only one satellite hop, thereby reducing satellite delay and capacity requirements while improving quality. In addition, 54 (for a total of 123) C-band facilities provide dedicated Internet access and private network services to rural public schools, hospitals, health clinics, and natural resource development industries throughout Alaska. Our network of 83 Ku-band facilities provides dedicated Internet access and private network services to rural public schools, hospitals, health clinics, and natural resource development industries throughout Alaska, and in ten locations in the lower 48 states.

Our Anchorage, Fairbanks, and Juneau distribution centers contain electronic switches to route calls to and from local exchange companies and, in Seattle, to obtain access to other carriers to distribute our southbound traffic to the remaining 49 states and international destinations. Our extensive metropolitan area fiber network in Anchorage supports cable television, Internet and telephony services. The Anchorage,
 
 
10

 
Fairbanks, and Juneau facilities also include digital access cross-connect systems, frame relay data switches, Internet platforms, and in Anchorage and Fairbanks, collocation facilities for interconnecting and hosting equipment for other carriers. We also maintain an operator and customer service center in Wasilla, Alaska. Our operator services traffic is processed by an integrated services platform that also hosts answering services, directory assistance, and internal conferencing services.

We utilize our coaxial cable facilities for DLPS. This delivery method allows us to utilize our own cable facilities to provide local access service to our customers and avoid paying local loop charges to the ILEC.

Our statewide cable systems consist of 3,057 miles of installed cable plant having 450 to 625 MHz of channel capacity. Our cable television businesses are located throughout Alaska and serve 41 communities and areas in Alaska, including the state’s five largest population centers, Anchorage, Fairbanks, the Matanuska-Susitna Valley, the Kenai Peninsula, and Juneau. Our facilities include cable plant and head-end distribution equipment. Some of our locations on the fiber routes are served from the head-end distribution equipment in Anchorage.  All of our cable systems are completely digital.

We provide access to the Internet using a platform that includes many of the latest advancements in technology. The physical platform is concentrated in Anchorage and is extended into many remote areas of the state. Our Internet platform includes the following:

·  
Our Anchorage facilities are connected to multiple Internet access points in Seattle through multiple, diversely routed networks;
·  
We use multiple routers on each end of the circuits to control the flow of data and to provide resiliency; and
·  
Our Anchorage facility consists of routers, a bank of servers that perform support and application functions, database servers providing authentication and user demographic data, layer 2 gigabit switch networks for intercommunications and broadband services.

Our dedicated Internet access and Internet protocol ("IP") data services are delivered to a router located at the service point. Our Internet management platform constantly monitors this router and continual communications are maintained with all of the core and distribution routers in the network. The availability and quality of service, as well as statistical information on traffic loading, are continuously monitored for quality assurance. The manage­ment platform has the capability to remotely access routers, servers and layer two switches, permitting changes in configuration without the need to be physically located at the service point.

We own state-wide wireless facilities that cover 98% of the population providing service to urban and rural Alaska communities and we will continue to expand these networks throughout the terrestrially and satellite served portions of Alaska in 2011.  We own GSM and CDMA wireless facilities serving urban Alaska locations. Our urban network includes Ericsson and Nortel wireless switches located in Anchorage and 183 cell sites that serve the following areas of Alaska: Anchorage and Eagle River, the Matanuska-Susitna Valley, Kenai Peninsula, Southeast, Kodiak and Fairbanks.  Our rural network consists of GSM facilities that are located throughout Alaska’s rural villages and communities. We extend our network coverage through roaming arrangements with other GSM and CDMA carriers.

Competition
A discussion of competition by product and service in our Consumer segment follows.

Voice Services and Products Competition
Long-Distance
The long-distance industry is intensely competitive and based upon price and bundling.

In the intrastate, interstate and international long-distance market, we compete against AT&T Alascom, Inc. (“AT&T Alascom”), Alaska Communications Systems Group, Inc. (“ACS”), MTA, long-distance resellers, and certain smaller rural local telephone companies. AT&T Alascom, as a subsidiary of AT&T, Inc., has access to greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we have. There is also the possibility that
 
 
11

 
new competitors will enter the Alaska market. In addition, wireless and voice over Internet protocol ("VoIP") services continue to grow as an alternative to wireline services as a means of reaching customers. Wireless local number portability allows consumers to retain the same phone number as they change service providers allowing for interchangeable and portable fixed-line and wireless numbers. Some consumers now use wireless service as their primary voice phone service for local and long-distance calling.

We have competed in the long-distance market by offering discounts from rates charged by our competitors and by providing desirable bundles of services.

Our ability to compete successfully will depend on our ability to anticipate and respond to various competitive factors affecting the industry, including new services that may be introduced, changes in consumer preferences, demographic trends, economic conditions and pricing strategies.

Local Access
We compete against ACS, the ILEC, in Anchorage, Juneau, Fairbanks and the Kenai Peninsula area; MTA, the ILEC, in the Matanuska-Susitna Valley, and other smaller ILECs in other communities.

In the local telephone services market, the 1996 Telecom Act, judicial decisions, state and federal legislative and regulatory developments, and new technologies have increased the overall likelihood that barriers to local telephone competition will be substantially reduced or removed. These initiatives include requirements that ILECs negotiate with entities, including us, to provide interconnection to the existing local telephone network, to allow the purchase, at cost-based rates, of access to UNEs, to establish dialing parity, to obtain access to rights-of-way and to resell services offered by the ILEC. We have been able to obtain interconnection, access and related services from the ILECs, at rates that allow us to offer competitive services. However, if we are unable to continue to obtain these services and access at acceptable rates, our ability to offer local access services, and our revenues and net income, could be materially adversely affected. To date, we have been successful in capturing a significant portion of the local telephone market in the locations where we are offering these services. However, there can be no assurance that we will continue to be successful in attracting or retaining these customers.

We believe that we have certain advantages over ILECs in providing communications services, including awareness by Alaskan customers of the GCI brand name, our facilities-based communications network, and our prior experience in, and knowledge of, the Alaskan market.

See “Regulation — Wireline Voice Services and Products” below for more information.

Video Services and Products Competition
Our cable television systems face competition from alternative methods of receiving and distributing television signals, including direct broadcast satellite ("DBS"), digital video over telephone lines, broadband IP-based services, wireless and satellite master antenna television ("SMATV") systems, and from other sources of news, information and entertainment such as Internet services, off-air television broadcast programming, newspapers, movie theaters, live sporting events, interactive computer services, and home video products, including video disks. Our cable television systems also face competition from potential overbuilds of our existing cable systems by other cable television operators and municipally-owned cable systems, and alternative methods of receiving and distributing television signals. The extent to which our cable television systems are competitive depends, in part, upon our ability to provide quality programming and other services at competitive prices.

We believe that the greatest source of potential competition for video services comes from the DBS industry. Two major companies, The DirecTV Group, Inc. and DISH DBS Corporation, are currently offering nationwide high-power DBS services. The ILECs in the Matanuska-Susitna Valley and Ketchikan offer digital video service over telephone lines in limited areas. Their product offerings and price points are similar to our product offerings. With the addition of Anchorage local broadcast stations, increased marketing, ILEC and DBS alliances, and emerging technologies creating new opportunities, competition from these sources has increased and will likely continue to increase.

Competitive forces will be counteracted by offering expanded programming through digital services.  Digital delivery technology is being utilized in all of our systems. We have retransmission agreements with Anchorage broadcasters and provide for the uplink/downlink of their signals into all our systems, and local programming for our customers.

Other new technologies may become competitive with non-entertainment services that cable television systems can offer. The FCC has authorized television broadcast stations to transmit textual and graphic information useful to both consumers and businesses. The FCC also permits commercial and non-commercial FM stations to use their subcarrier frequencies to provide non-broadcast services including data
 
 
12

 
transmissions. The FCC established an over-the-air interactive video and data service that will permit two-way interaction with commercial and educational programming along with informational and data services. ILECs and other common carriers also provide facilities for the transmission and distribution to homes and businesses of interactive computer-based services, including the Internet, as well as data and other non-video services. The FCC has conducted spectrum auctions for licenses to provide PCS, as well as other services. PCS and other services will enable license holders, including cable operators, to provide voice and data services. We own a statewide PCS license in Alaska.

Cable television systems generally operate pursuant to franchises granted on a non-exclusive basis. The 1992 Cable Act gives local franchising authorities jurisdiction over basic cable service rates and equipment in the absence of “effective competition.”  The 1992 Cable Act also prohibits franchising authorities from unreasonably denying requests for additional franchises and permits franchising authorities to operate cable systems. Well-financed businesses from outside the cable industry (such as the public utilities that own certain of the poles on which cable is attached) may become competitors for franchises or providers of competing services.

We expect to continue to provide, at reasonable prices and in competitive bundles, a greater variety of communication services than are available off-air or through other alternative delivery sources. Additionally, we believe we offer superior technical performance and responsive community-based customer service. Increased competition, however, may adversely affect our market share and results of operations from our cable services product offerings.

Data Services and Products Competition
The Internet industry is highly competitive, rapidly evolving and subject to constant technological change. Competition is based upon price and pricing plans, service bundles, the types of services offered, the technologies used, customer service, billing services, and perceived quality, reliability and availability. We compete with other Alaska based Internet providers and domestic, non-Alaska based providers that provide national service coverage. Several of the providers headquartered outside of Alaska have substantially greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do.

With respect to our high-speed cable modem service, ACS and other Alaska telephone service providers are providing competitive high-speed data subscriber line services over their telephone lines in direct competition with our high-speed cable modem service. Competitive local fixed wireless providers are providing service in certain of our markets as is a national WiMax-based provider in Anchorage with plans for Juneau and Fairbanks. WiMax is a standards-based wireless technology that provides high-throughput broadband connections over long distances. WiMax can be used for a number of applications, including last mile broadband connections, hotspots and cellular backhaul, and high-speed enterprise connectivity for business. DBS providers and others provide wireless high speed Internet service in competition with our high-speed cable modem services.

Niche providers in the industry, both local and national, compete with certain of our Internet service products, such as web hosting, list services and e-mail.

Wireless Services and Products Competition
We compete against AT&T Mobility, LLC (“AT&T Mobility”), ACS, MTA, and resellers of those services in Anchorage and other markets.

Regulatory policies favor robust competition in wireless markets. Wireless local number portability, which was implemented by the FCC late in 2003, has also increased the level of competition in the industry. Number portability allows subscribers to switch carriers without having to change their telephone numbers.

The communications industry continues to experience significant technological changes, as evidenced by the increasing pace of improvements in the capacity and quality of digital technology, shorter cycles for new products and enhancements and changes in consumer preferences and expectations. Accordingly, we expect competition in the wireless communications industry to continue to be dynamic and intense as a result of the development of new technologies, services and products.

We compete for customers based principally upon price, bundled services, the services and enhancements offered, network quality, customer service, network coverage and capacity, the type of wireless handsets
 
 
13

 
offered, and the availability of differentiated features and services. Our ability to compete successfully will depend, in part, on our marketing efforts and our ability to anticipate and respond to various competitive factors affecting the industry.

Seasonality
Our Consumer segment services and products do not exhibit significant seasonality. Our ability to implement construction projects is hampered during the winter months because of cold temperatures, snow and short daylight hours.

Network Access Segment
Network Access segment revenues for 2010, 2009 and 2008 are summarized as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Total Network Access segment revenues1
  $ 107,227       122,072       153,821  


1  See “Part II — Item 7 — Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and note 10 included in “Part II — Item 8 — Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for more information regarding the financial performance of our Network Access segment.


Services and Products
Our Network Access segment offers wholesale voice, data, and wireless services and products to other common carrier customers. We provide network transport, billing services and access to our network to other common carriers. These services allow other common carriers to provide services to their customers that originate or terminate on our network, or on the networks of other communication companies to which we connect.

Voice Services and Products
Revenues derived from Network Access segment voice services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $29.0 million, $49.8 million, and $79.7 million, respectively, or 4%, 8%, and 14% of our total revenues, respectively.

We are engaged in the transmission of interstate and intrastate-switched message telephone service. We terminate northbound message telephone service traffic for several large resellers who do not have facilities of their own in Alaska. We also provide origination of southbound calling card, toll-free services, and toll services for interexchange carriers. Services are generally provided pursuant to contracts.

Data Services and Products
Revenues derived from Network Access segment data services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $61.5 million, $63.9 million, and $71.4 million, respectively, or 9%, 11%, and 12% of our total revenues, respectively.

Data network services include multi-protocol label switching, frame relay, private line and dedicated Internet service.

Wireless Services and Products
Revenues derived from Network Access segment wireless services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $16.7 million, $8.4 million, and $2.7 million, respectively, or 3%, 1%, and 0% of our total revenues, respectively.  We provide roaming services on our wireless network within Alaska to other GSM and CDMA wireless carriers.

Sales and Marketing
Our Network Access segment sales and marketing efforts are primarily directed toward increasing the number of other common carriers we serve, the number of billable minutes of long-distance and wireless traffic we carry over our network and the number of voice and data transmission circuits leased. We sell our voice, data and wireless services primarily through direct contact marketing.

 
14

 
Facilities
Our Network Access segment shares common facilities used for voice, data and wireless services by other segments. You should refer to “Consumer Segment — Facilities” above for additional information.

Major Customer
We had no major customer in 2010.  During the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, Verizon was a major customer.  Revenues attributed to our major customer during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, totaled $64.5 million and $65.0 million, respectively, or 11% of total revenues for each year.

Competition
Our Network Access segment competes against AT&T Alascom, ACS, and certain smaller rural local telephone carriers. There is also the possibility that new competitors will enter the Alaska market.

Other common carrier traffic routed to us for termination in Alaska is largely dependent on traffic routed to our carrier customers by their customers. Pricing pressures, new program offerings, revised business plans, and market consolidation continue to evolve in the markets served by our carrier customers. If, as a result, their traffic is reduced, or if their competitors’ costs to terminate or originate traffic in Alaska are reduced, our traffic will also likely be reduced, and we may have to respond to competitive pressures. We are unable to predict the effect of such changes on our business.

Historically, we have competed in the Network Access segment market by offering rates comparable to or less than our competitors, by providing a comprehensive service model to meet the complete needs of our carrier customers, and by providing responsive customer service.

Seasonality
Network Access segment long-distance and wireless services revenues derived from our other common carrier customers have historically been highest in the summer months because of temporary population increases attributable to tourism and increased seasonal economic activity such as construction, commercial fishing, and oil and gas activities.  Our Network Access segment data services do not exhibit significant seasonality.

Commercial Segment
We offer a full range of communications services and products to commercial and governmental customers. Commercial segment revenues for 2010, 2009 and 2008 are summarized as follows:

 
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Total Commercial segment revenues1
  $ 128,458       110,135       114,660  


1  See “Part II — Item 7 — Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and note 10 included in “Part II — Item 8 — Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for more information regarding the financial performance of our Commercial segment.


Services and Products
Our Commercial segment offers a full range of voice, video, data, wireless and managed services and products to small businesses, local, national and global businesses, governmental entities, and public and private educational institutions.

Voice Services and Products
Revenues derived from Commercial segment voice services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $31.7 million, $30.8 million, and $29.4 million, respectively, or 5% of our total revenues for each year.

Long-Distance
We are engaged in the transmission of interstate and intrastate-switched message telephone service between the major communities in Alaska, the remaining 49 states, and foreign countries. Our message toll
 
 
15

 
services include intrastate, interstate and international direct dial, toll-free services, calling card, operator and enhanced conference calling services. Small business subscribers generally may cancel long-distance service at any time. Certain small business and most large business, governmental and educational institution customers generally contract with us for service over one to five year periods.

Local Access
We offer full featured local access service to our Commercial segment customers using our own fiber and coax facilities and collocated remote facilities that access the ILEC’s UNE loops and wholesale facilities. In areas where we do not have our own facilities or access to ILEC loop facilities, we offer service using total service resale of the ILEC’s local service or UNE platform.

Our package offerings are competitively priced and include popular features, including caller ID, voice messaging, three-way calling, call forwarding, and call waiting.  Small business subscribers generally may cancel local access service at any time. Certain small business and most large business, governmental and educational institution customers generally contract with us for service over one to five year periods.

Video Services and Products
Revenues derived from Commercial segment video services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $11.2 million, $9.2 million, and $9.6 million, respectively, or 2% of our total revenues for each year.

Commercial segment subscribers such as hospitals, hotels and motels are charged negotiated monthly service fees. Our video on demand platform is available to hotels in Anchorage that are connected using our fiber facilities. Programming services offered to our cable television systems subscribers differ by system as described in the Consumer segment Video Services and Products section above. You should refer to “Consumer Segment — Services and Products” above for additional information.

Data Services and Products
Revenues derived from Commercial segment data services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $76.8 million, $63.4 million, and $70.1 million, respectively, or 12%, 11%, and 12% of our total revenues, respectively.

Internet
We currently offer several Internet service packages for commercial use. Our business high-speed cable modem Internet service offers access of up to 22 Mbps download and upload speeds, and free 24-hour customer service and technical support.  We also provide dedicated access Internet service to commercial and public organizations in Alaska.

Data Networks
Data network services utilize voice and data transmission circuits, dedicated to particular subscribers, which link a device in one location to another in a different location. Private IP, private lines, metro Ethernet and frame relay offer a secure solution for frequent communication of large amounts of data between sites.

Managed Services
We design, sell, install, service and operate, on behalf of certain customers, communications and computer networking equipment and provide field/depot, third party, technical support, communications consulting and outsourcing services. We supply integrated voice and data communications systems incorporating private IP, interstate and intrastate digital data networks, point-to-point and multipoint data network and small earth station services.

Wireless Services and Products
Revenues derived from Commercial segment wireless services and products in 2010, 2009, and 2008 totaled $8.7 million, $6.7 million, and $5.6 million, respectively, or 1% of our total revenues for each year.

Wireless services and products offered to our Commercial segment customers are the same as those described in the Consumer Wireless Services and Products section above. You should refer to “Consumer Segment — Services and Products” above for additional information.

 
16

 
Bundled Services and Products
We combine one or more of our individual service or product offerings into bundles that we sell to our Commercial segment customers at attractive prices as described further in the Consumer segment Services and Products section above. You should refer to “Consumer Segment — Services and Products” above for additional information.  Additionally, we use master service agreements with larger enterprise customers to capture the overall relationship.

Sales and Marketing
Our Commercial segment sales and marketing efforts focus on increasing the number of subscribers we serve, selling bundled services, and generating incremental revenues through product and feature up-sell opportunities. We sell our Commercial segment services and products primarily through direct contact marketing.

Facilities
Our Commercial segment uses many facilities to provide services and products that are common to the Consumer segment. You should refer to “Consumer Segment — Facilities” above for additional information.

We provide our own facilities-based local access services to many of Anchorage’s larger business customers through expansion and deployment of SONET, optical ethernet, and gigabit passive optical network fiber transmission facilities, digital loop carrier facilities, and leased facilities.
 
 
Our dedicated Internet access and Internet protocol/Multi-Protocol Label Switching data services are delivered to an Ethernet port located at the service point. Our management platform constantly monitors this port and continual communications are maintained with all of the core and distribution elements in the network. The availability and quality of service, as well as statistical information on traffic loading, are continuously monitored for quality assurance. The manage­ment platform has the capability to remotely access routers, servers and layer two switches, permitting changes in configuration without the need to physically be at the service point. This management platform allows us to offer network monitoring and management services to businesses and governmental entities. Many of the largest commercial networks in Alaska use this service, including the State government.

Competition
Many of our Commercial segment voice, video, data and wireless services and products are also common to the Consumer segment. You should refer to “Consumer Segment — Competition” above for additional information.

We expect continued competition in commercial customer telephone access, Internet access, wireless and data markets. Competition is based upon price and pricing plans, the type of services offered, customer service, billing services, performance, and perceived quality, reliability and availability.

Presently, there are a number of competing companies in Alaska that actively sell and maintain data and voice communications systems. Our ability to integrate communications networks and data communications equipment has allowed us to maintain our market position based on customer support services rather than price competition alone. These services are blended with other transport products into unique customer solutions, including managed services and outsourcing.

Seasonality
Our Commercial segment voice, video, data and wireless services do not exhibit significant seasonality. Our ability to implement construction projects to expand our outside plant facilities is hampered during the winter months because of cold temperatures, snow and short daylight hours.

Managed Broadband Segment
Managed Broadband segment revenues for 2010, 2009 and 2008 are summarized as follows:

 
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Total Managed Broadband segment revenues1
  $ 49,962       44,875       37,047  


 
17

 



1  See “Part II — Item 7 — Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and note 10 included in “Part II — Item 8 — Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for more information regarding the financial performance of our Managed Broadband segment.
 
Services and Products
Our Managed Broadband segment offers Internet access, data network and managed services to rural schools and health organizations.

SchoolAccess® is a suite of services designed to advance the educational opportunities of students in underserved regions of the country. Our SchoolAccess® division provides Internet and distance learning services designed exclusively for the school environment. The Schools and Libraries Program of the Universal Service Fund ("USF") makes discounts available to eligible rural school districts for telecommunication services and monthly Internet service charges. The program is intended to ensure that rural school districts have access to affordable services.

Our network, Internet and software application services provided through our Managed Broadband segment’s Medical Services division are branded as ConnectMD®. Our ConnectMD® services are currently provided under contract to medical businesses in Alaska, Washington and Montana. The Rural Health Care Program of the USF makes discounts available to eligible rural health care providers for telecommunication services and monthly Internet service charges. The program is intended to ensure that rural health care providers pay no more for telecommunication services in the provision of health care services than their urban counterparts. Customers utilize ConnectMD® services to securely move data, images, voice traffic, and real time multipoint interactive video.

We offer a managed video conferencing product for use in distance learning, telemedicine and group communication and collaboration environments. The product is designed to offer customers enhanced communication services that support video, audio and data presentation. Our product benefits customers by reducing travel costs, improving course equity in education and increasing the quality of health services available to patients. The product bundles our data products, video conferencing services and optional rental of video conferencing endpoint equipment. Our video conferencing services include multipoint conferencing, integrated services digital network gateway and transcoding services, online scheduling and conference control, and videoconference recording, archiving and streaming. We provide 24-hour technical support via telephone or online.

Our videoconferencing network is the largest in Alaska, and network coverage includes parts of the states of Washington and Montana. The network supports all H.323 IP videoconferencing standards including the newer H.264 standard, and supports call data rates from 128 Kb per second up to and including multi-megabit high definition calls.  In 2010, 2009, and 2008, we terminated over 33,000, 32,000 and 30,000, respectively, videoconferencing endpoint connections amounting to over 2.5 million, 2.0 million and 1.8 million, respectively, videoconferencing minutes on our network.

Sales and Marketing
Our Managed Broadband segment sales and marketing efforts focus on increasing the number of subscribers we serve, selling bundled services, and generating incremental revenues through product and feature up-sell opportunities. We sell our Managed Broadband segment services and products primarily through direct contact marketing.

Facilities
Our Managed Broadband segment services and products are delivered using a platform including many of the latest advancements in technology through a locally available circuit, our existing lines, and/or satellite earth stations. Our Internet services are partially provisioned over a satellite based digital video broadcast carrier that reduces the requirement for new satellite transponder bandwidth to support growth in ConnectMD®, SchoolAccess® and other broadband services.

 
18

 
We employ a packet data satellite transmission technology for the efficient transport of broadband data in support of our ConnectMD® and SchoolAccess® initiatives. Our SchoolAccess® Internet service is delivered as follows:

·  
In communities where we have terrestrial interconnects or provide existing service over regional earth stations, we have configured intermediate distribution facilities. Schools that are within these service boundaries are connected locally to one of those facilities;
·  
In communities where we have extended communications services via our DAMA earth station program, SchoolAccess® is provided via a satellite circuit to an intermediate distribution facility at the Eagle River earth station; and
·  
In communities or remote locations to which we have not extended communications services, SchoolAccess® is provided via a dedicated (usually on premise) very small aperture terminal ("VSAT") satellite station. The VSAT connects to an intermediate distribution facility located in Anchorage.

Our facilities include DeltaNet, a long-haul broadband microwave network ringing the Yukon-Kuskokwim Delta – a region of approximately 50,000 square miles in western Alaska. DeltaNet links more than 30 villages to Bethel, the region’s hub.  We utilize DeltaNet to support growth in wireless and broadband services including ConnectMD®and SchoolAccess®.

You should refer to “Consumer Segment — Facilities” above for additional information.

Competition
There are several competing companies in Alaska that actively sell broadband services. Our ability to provide end-to-end broadband services solutions has allowed us to maintain our market position based on “value added” services and products rather than solely based on price competition. These services are blended with other transport and software products into unique customer solutions, including SchoolAccess® and ConnectMD® applications such as video conferencing and unique web content services.

Seasonality
Our Managed Broadband segment does not exhibit seasonality.

Regulated Operations Segment
We offer voice and data services and products to commercial and residential customers in 60 rural communities primarily in Southwest Alaska. Regulated Operations segment revenues were $22.7 million, $23.8 million, and $14.3 million in 2010, 2009, and from the June 1, 2008 date of acquisition of UUI and United-KUC, Inc. (“United-KUC”) through December 31, 2008, respectively.

Services and Products
Our Regulated Operations segment offers wireline communications services to our residential and commercial customers, including local access and Internet services and products.

Sales and Marketing
Our Regulated Operations segment sales efforts are primarily directed toward increasing the number of subscribers we serve. We sell our Regulated Operations segment services through local media advertising, retail stores, and through our website.

Facilities
Our Regulated Operations segment services are delivered by switching, outside plant, terrestrial microwave, and satellite facilities.  Our outside plant is primarily aerial and buried copper and fiber optic cables.

Competition
Our Regulated Operations segment has no competition for its local access services.

Seasonality
Our Regulated Operations segment services do not exhibit significant seasonality.

 
19

 
Sales and Marketing – Company-wide
Our sales and marketing strategy hinges on our ability to leverage (i) our unique position as an integrated provider of multiple communications, Internet and cable services, (ii) our well-recognized and respected brand names in the Alaskan marketplace and (iii) our leading market positions in the services and products we offer. By continuing to pursue a marketing strategy that takes advantage of these characteristics, we believe we can increase our customer market penetration and retention rates, increase our share of our customers’ aggregate voice, video, data and wireless services expenditures and achieve continued growth in revenues and operating cash flow.

Environmental Regulations
We may undertake activities that, under certain circumstances may affect the environment. Accordingly, they are subject to federal, state, and local regulations designed to preserve or protect the environment. The FCC, the Bureau of Land Management, the United States Forest Service, the United States Fish and Wildlife Service and the National Park Service are required by the National Environmental Policy Act of 1969 to consider the environmental impact before the commencement of facility construction.

We believe that compliance with such regulations has had no material effect on our consolidated operations. The principal effect of our facilities on the environment would be in the form of construction of facilities and networks at various locations in Alaska and between Alaska, Seattle, Washington, and Warrenton, Oregon. Our facilities have been constructed in accordance with federal, state and local building codes and zoning regulations whenever and wherever applicable. Some facilities may be on lands that may be subject to state and federal wetland regulation.

Uncertainty as to the applicability of environmental regulations is caused in major part by the federal government’s decision to consider a change in the definition of wetlands. Most of our facilities are on leased property, and, with respect to all of these facilities, we are unaware of any violations of lease terms or federal, state or local regulations pertaining to preservation or protection of the environment.

The engineered routes of our projects to construct terrestrial and undersea fiber optic cable facilities pass over wetlands and other environmentally sensitive areas. We believe our construction methods used for buried cable have a minimal impact on the environment. The agencies, among others, that are involved in permitting and oversight of our cable deployment efforts are the United States Army Corps of Engineers, National Marine Fisheries Service, United States Fish and Wildlife Service, United States Coast Guard, National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration, Alaska Department of Natural Resources, and the Alaska Office of the Governor-Governmental Coordination. We are unaware of any violations of federal, state or local regulations or permits pertaining to preservation or protection of the environment.

In the course of operating our cable television and communications systems, we have used various materials defined as hazardous by applicable governmental regulations. These materials have been used for insect repellent, paint used to mark the location of our facilities, and pole treatment, and as heating fuel, transformer oil, cable cleaner, batteries, diesel fuel, and in various other ways in the operation of those systems. We do not believe that these materials, when used in accordance with manufacturer instructions, pose an unreasonable hazard to those who use them or to the environment.

Patents, Trademarks, and Licenses
We do not hold patents, franchises or concessions for communications services or local access services. We do hold registered service marks for the letters GCI®, and for the terms SchoolAccess®, Alaska United Fiber Optic Cable System®, GCI ConnectMD®, ConnectMD®, GCI Hypernet®, My GCI®, MyGCI®, Keep Talking Alaska®, Digiminutes®, Unicom®, Cell-ID®, and United-KUC®.  The Communications Act of 1934, as amended, gives the FCC the authority to license and regulate the use of the electromagnetic spectrum for radio communications. We hold licenses through our subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. for our satellite and microwave transmission facilities for provision of long-distance services provided by our Consumer, Commercial and Network Access segments.

We hold the following licenses, among others:
·  
Two licenses for use of a 30 MHz block of spectrum, which together authorize provision of PCS services in Alaska. Both licenses have an expiration date of June 23, 2015.  Licenses may be revoked and license renewal applications may be denied for cause. We expect the PCS licenses will be renewed in due course when, at the end of the license period, a renewal application will be filed,
·  
A LMDS license which we acquired in 1998 for use of a 150 MHz block of spectrum in the 28 GHz Ka-band for providing wireless services. The LMDS license was renewed in 2008 for an additional 10-year term, following the grant of an extension until June 1, 2012 of the requirement to provide “substantial service” in the service region,
·  
A 25 MHz cellular A license for sites located in the Bethel AK-2 B2 portion of RSA 316, serving the Aleutians West Census Area, and
·  
Several 25 MHz cellular B licenses are held by our subsidiary Unicom for sites located in the Wade Hampton AK-1 portion of CMA 315 and the Bethel AK-2 portion of CMA 316, throughout the Yukon-Kuskokwim Delta.
 
 
 
20

 
Earth stations are licensed generally for fifteen years. The FCC also issues a single blanket license for a large number of technically identical earth stations (e.g., VSATs). Our operations may require additional licenses in the future.

We are certified through the Regulatory Commission of Alaska (“RCA”) to provide cable service by Certificates of Public Convenience and Necessity (“CPCN”). These CPCNs are nonexclusive certificates issued for each community.  Although CPCNs have no stated expiration date they may be revoked due to cause.

Regulation
Our businesses are subject to substantial government regulation and oversight. The following summary of regulatory issues does not purport to describe all existing and proposed federal, state, and local laws and regulations, or judicial and regulatory proceedings that affect our businesses. Existing laws and regulations are reviewed frequently by legislative bodies, regulatory agencies, and the courts and are subject to change. Any change in the Act that loosened regulatory oversight of ILECs’ control of bottleneck facilities could have an adverse impact on our businesses. We cannot predict at this time the outcome of any present or future consideration of proposed changes to governing laws and regulations.

Wireline Voice Services and Products
General. As an Interexchange carrier, we are subject to regulation by the FCC and the RCA as a non-dominant provider of interstate, international, and intrastate long-distance services. As a state-certificated competitive local exchange carrier, we are subject to regulation by the RCA and the FCC as a non-dominant provider of local communications services. Military franchise requirements also affect our ability to provide communications services to military bases.

Rural Exemption and Interconnection. A Rural Telephone Company is exempt from compliance with certain material interconnection requirements under Section 251(c) of the 1996 Telecom Act, including the obligation to negotiate Section 251(b) and (c) interconnection requirements in good faith, unless and until a state regulatory commission lifts such “rural exemption” or otherwise finds it not to apply.  All ILECs in Alaska are Rural Telephone Companies except ACS in its Anchorage study area.  We have had to participate in numerous proceedings regarding the rural exemptions of various ILECs, including ACS for its Fairbanks and Juneau operating companies, MTA and Ketchikan, in order to achieve the necessary Interconnection Agreements with the remaining ILECs. In other cases the Interconnection Agreements were reached by negotiation without regard to the implications of the ILEC’s rural exemption.

We have completed negotiation and/or arbitration of the necessary interconnection provisions and the RCA has approved current wireline Interconnection Agreements between GCI and all of the major ILECs.  We have entered all of the major Alaskan markets with local access services.

See “Description of Our Business by Reportable Segment — Consumer — Competition — Voice Services and Products Competition” for more information.

Access Charges and Other Regulated Fees. The FCC regulates the fees that local telephone companies charge long-distance companies for access to their local networks. On February 8, 2011, the FCC issued its most recent proposal to restructure and possibly reduce interstate access charges. Changes to the interstate access charge regime or introduction of new technologies not subject to access charges could fundamentally change the economics of some aspects of our business.  In addition, the RCA adopted intrastate access reform, which has not yet been promulgated as final rules.  We believe the proposed reduction of intrastate access rates will result in a cost savings to us and does not present a substantial risk.

Carriers also pay fees for switched wholesale transport services in and out of Alaska. The rates for such services offered by and to any provider were governed by a federal law that was effective through December 31, 2009.  The expiration of the applicable federal law is likely to result in a decrease in the rates for services, which would result in a reduction of revenues.

Access to Unbundled Network Elements. The ability to obtain UNEs is an important element of our local access services business. We cannot predict the extent to which existing FCC rules governing access to and pricing for UNEs will be sustained in the face of additional legal action and the impact of any further rules that are yet to be determined by the FCC. Moreover, the future regulatory classification of services that
 
 
21

 
are transmitted over facilities may impact the extent to which we will be permitted access to such facilities.  Changes to the applicable regulations could result in a change in our cost of serving new and existing markets.

Recurring and non-recurring charges for UNE-loops and other UNEs may increase based on the rates adopted in RCA proceedings to establish new Interconnection Agreements or renew existing agreements. These increases could have an adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Universal Service. The USF pays Eligible Telecommunications Carriers ("ETC") to support the provision of facilities-based wireline telephone service in high-cost areas. Under FCC regulations and RCA orders, we are an authorized ETC for purposes of providing wireline local exchange service in Anchorage, Juneau, Fairbanks, and the MTA study area (which includes the Matanuska-Susitna Valley) and other small areas throughout Alaska. Without ETC status, we would not qualify for USF support in these areas or other rural areas where we propose to offer facilities-based wireline telephone services, and our net cost of providing local telephone services in these areas would be materially adversely affected.

On May 1, 2008, the FCC issued an order adopting the recommendation of the Federal State Joint Board on Universal Service (“Joint Board”) to impose a state-by-state interim cap on high cost funds to be distributed to competitive ETCs.  As part of the revised policy, the FCC adopted a limited exception from the cap for competitive ETCs serving tribal lands or Alaska Native regions.  While the operation of the cap has generally reduced the high cost fund amounts available to competitive ETCs as new competitive ETCs are designated and as existing competitive ETCs acquire new customers, providers like us who serve tribal lands or Alaska Native regions were provided some relief.  On March 5, 2009, the FCC issued an additional order waiving a previously adopted limitation to the exception, the result of which was to provide uncapped support for all lines served by competitive ETCs for tribal lands or Alaska Native regions during the time the interim cap is in effect.  The uncapped support for tribal lands or Alaska Native regions and the cap for all other regions will be in place until the FCC takes action on proposals for long term reform.

On March 16, 2010, the FCC staff released the National Broadband Plan, including among its topics a proposal to transition existing USF high cost support from voice to broadband networks over a ten year period.  On April 21, 2010, the FCC initiated a proceeding to consider interim and long-term USF reforms, including a five year phase-out of support to competitive ETCs.  On February 8, 2011, the FCC issued a Notice of Proposed Rulemaking to consider adopting reforms to its high cost support program, including, among other things, the proposed competitive ETC phase-out and ways to fund and distribute support for broadband services.  We cannot predict at this time the outcome of this proceeding or its effect on high cost support available to us, but our revenue for providing local services in these areas would be materially adversely affected by the reduction of USF support. 

Local Regulation. We may be required to obtain local permits for street opening and construction permits to install and expand our networks. Local zoning authorities often regulate our use of towers for microwave and other communications sites. We also are subject to general regulations concerning building codes and local licensing. The 1996 Telecom Act requires that fees charged to communications carriers be applied in a competitively neutral manner, but there can be no assurance that ILECs and others with whom we will be competing will bear costs similar to those we will bear in this regard.

Video Services and Products
General. Because cable communications systems use local streets and rights-of-way, they generally are operated pursuant to franchises (which can take the form of certificates, permits or licenses) granted by a municipality or other state or local government entity. The RCA is the franchising authority for all of Alaska. We believe that we have generally met the terms of our franchises, which do not require periodic renewal,
 
 
22

 
and have provided quality levels of service. Military franchise requirements also affect our ability to provide video services to military bases.

The RCA is also certified under federal law to regulate rates for the Basic Service tier on our cable systems. Under state law, however, cable television service is exempt from regulation unless subscribers petition the RCA. At present, regulation of basic cable rates takes place only in Juneau. The RCA does not regulate rates for cable modem service.

Must Carry/Retransmission Consent. The 1992 Cable Act contains broadcast signal carriage requirements that allow local commercial television broadcast stations to elect once every three years to require a cable system to carry the station, subject to certain exceptions, or to negotiate for “retransmission consent” to carry the station.

The FCC has adopted rules to require cable operators to carry the digital programming streams of broadcast television stations. The FCC requirement that cable operators carry both the analog and digital programming streams of broadcast television stations while broadcasters are transitioning from analog to digital transmission does not apply to all-digital systems like ours.  Further, the FCC has declined to require any cable operator to carry multiple digital programming streams from a single broadcast television station, but should the FCC change this policy, we would be required to devote additional cable capacity to carrying broadcast television programming streams, a step that could require the removal of other programming services.

Cable System Delivery of Internet Service. The FCC has defined high-speed Internet over cable as an “information service” not subject to local cable-franchise fees, as cable service may be, or any explicit requirements for “open access.” The Supreme Court affirmed the FCC’s position in a decision issued in 2005.

Although there is at present no significant federal regulation of cable system delivery of Internet services, this situation may change as cable systems expand their broadband delivery of Internet services. Proposals have been advanced at the FCC and Congress to require cable operators to provide access to unaffiliated Internet service providers and online service providers and to govern the terms under which content providers and applications are delivered by all broadband network operators. If such requirements were imposed on cable operators, it could burden the capacity of cable systems and frustrate our plans for providing expanded Internet access services. These access obligations could adversely affect our financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Segregated Security for Set-top Devices. The FCC mandated, effective July 1, 2007, that all new set-top video navigation devices must segregate the security function from the navigation function. The new devices are more expensive than existing equipment, and compliance would increase our cost of providing cable services. Subject to a waiver granted by the FCC on May 4, 2007, we may continue providing low-cost integrated set-top boxes to consumers to facilitate our all-digital cable networks.

AllVid Proceeding. On April 21, 2010, the FCC adopted a Notice of Inquiry to consider ways to develop a standardized interface for accessing video content, as an alternative to set-top boxes.  Adoption of new rules or standards in this area could affect the manner in which we deliver video products to our customers.  We do not know if the FCC will propose rules for further consideration.

Pole Attachments. The Communications Act requires the FCC to regulate the rates, terms and conditions imposed by public utilities for cable systems’ use of utility pole and conduit space unless state authorities can demonstrate that they adequately regulate pole attachment rates. In the absence of state regulation, the FCC administers pole attachment rates on a formula basis. This formula governs the maximum rate certain utilities may charge for attachments to their poles and conduit by companies providing communications services, including cable operators. The RCA, however, does not use the federal formula and instead has adopted its own formula that has been in place since 1987. This formula could be subject to further revisions upon petition to the RCA and the FCC has an open rulemaking proceeding to consider application of the federal formula. We cannot predict at this time the outcome of any such proceedings.

Copyright. Cable television systems are subject to federal copyright licensing covering carriage of television and radio broadcast signals. In exchange for filing certain reports and contributing a percentage of their revenues to a federal copyright royalty pool that varies depending on the size of the system, the number of distant broadcast television signals carried, and the location of the cable system, cable operators can obtain blanket permission to retransmit copyrighted material included in broadcast signals. The possible modification or elimination of this compulsory copyright license is the subject of continuing legislative
 
 
23

 
review.  We cannot predict the outcome of this legislative review, which could adversely affect our ability to obtain desired broadcast program­ming. Copyright clearances for non-broadcast programming services are arranged through private negotiations.

Internet-based Services and Products
General. There is no one entity or organization that governs the Internet. Each facilities-based network provider that is interconnected with the global Internet controls operational aspects of their own network. Certain functions, such as IP addressing, domain name routing, and the definition of the TCP/IP protocol, are coordinated by an array of quasi-governmental, intergovernmental, and non-governmental bodies. The legal authority of these bodies is not precisely defined.

Although the FCC does not regulate the prices charged by Internet service providers or Internet backbone providers, the vast majority of users connect to the Internet over facilities of existing communications carriers. Those communications carriers are subject to varying levels of regulation at both the federal and the state level. Thus, non-Internet-specific regulatory decisions exercise a significant influence over the economics of the Internet market.

Many aspects of the coordination and regulation of Internet activities and the underlying networks over which those activities are conducted are evolving. Internet-specific and non-Internet-specific changes in the regulatory environment, including changes that affect communications costs or increase competition from ILECs or other communications services providers, could adversely affect the prices at which we sell Internet-based services.

Recently adopted net neutrality regulations have not yet gone into effect and are subject to court appeals.  We are currently assessing the steps required to satisfy the regulations as adopted by the FCC.  Further legislative proposals under the banner of “net neutrality”, if adopted, could interfere with our ability to reasonably manage and invest in our broadband network, and could adversely affect the manner and price of providing service.

Wireless Services and Products
General. The FCC regulates the licensing, construction, interconnection, operation, acquisition, and transfer of wireless network systems in the United States pursuant to the Communications Act.  As a licensee of PCS, LMDS, and other wireless services, we are subject to regulation by the FCC, and must comply with certain build-out and other license conditions, as well as with the FCC’s specific regulations governing the PCS and LMDS services (described above). The FCC does not currently regulate rates for services offered by commercial mobile radio service providers.

Commercial mobile radio service wireless systems are subject to Federal Aviation Administration and FCC regulations governing the location, lighting and construction of antenna structures on which our antennas and associated equipment are located and are also subject to regulation under federal environmental laws and the FCC’s environmental regulations, including limits on radio frequency radiation from wireless handsets and antennas on towers.

Interconnection.  We have completed negotiation and the RCA has approved current direct wireless Interconnection Agreements between GCI and all of the major Alaska ILECs.  These are in addition to indirect interconnection arrangements utilized elsewhere.

Universal Service. The USF pays ETCs to support the provision of facilities-based wireless telephone service in high-cost areas. A wireless carrier may seek ETC status so that it can receive support from the USF. Several wireless carriers, including us, have successfully applied to the RCA for ETC status in Alaska.  Under FCC regulations and RCA orders, we are an authorized ETC for purposes of providing wireless telephone service in Anchorage, Juneau, Fairbanks, and the MTA study area (which includes the Matanuska-Susitna Valley) and other small areas throughout Alaska. Without ETC status, we would not qualify for USF support in these areas or other rural areas where we propose to offer facilities-based wireless telephone services, and our net cost of providing wireless telephone services in these areas would be materially adversely affected.

See “Description of Our Business by Reportable Segment — Regulation — Wireline Voice Services and Products — Universal Service” for more information.

 
24

 
Emergency 911. The FCC has imposed rules requiring carriers to provide emergency 911 services, including enhanced 911 services that provide to local public safety dispatch agencies the caller’s communications number and approximate location. Providers are required to transmit the geographic coordinates of the customer’s location, either by means of network-based or handset-based technologies, within accuracy parameters recently revised by the FCC, to be implemented over a phase-in period.  We are assessing the application of such parameters in Alaska’s relatively low population and rural service areas.  Providers may not demand cost recovery as a condition of doing so, although they are permitted to negotiate cost recovery if it is not mandated by the state or local governments.

State and Local Regulation. While the Communications Act generally preempts state and local governments from regulating the entry of, or the rates charged by, wireless carriers, it also permits a state to petition the FCC to allow it to impose commercial mobile radio service rate regulation when market conditions fail to adequately protect customers and such service is a replacement for a substantial portion of the telephone wireline exchange service within a state. No state currently has such a petition on file, and all prior efforts have been rejected. In addition, the Communications Act does not expressly preempt the states from regulating the “terms and conditions” of wireless service.

Several states have invoked this “terms and conditions” authority to impose or propose various consumer protection regulations on the wireless industry. State attorneys general have also become more active in enforcing state consumer protection laws against sales practices and services of wireless carriers. States also may impose their own universal service support requirements on wireless and other communications carriers, similar to the contribution requirements that have been established by the FCC.

States have become more active in attempting to impose new taxes and fees on wireless carriers, such as gross receipts taxes. Where successful, these taxes and fees are generally passed through to our customers and result in higher costs to our customers.

At the local level, wireless facilities typically are subject to zoning and land use regulation. Neither local nor state governments may categorically prohibit the construction of wireless facilities in any community or take actions, such as indefinite moratoria, which have the effect of prohibiting construction. Nonetheless, securing state and local government approvals for new tower sites has been and is likely to continue to be difficult, lengthy and costly.

Financial Information about our Foreign and Domestic Operations and Export Sales
Although we have several agreements to help originate and terminate international toll traffic, we do not have foreign operations or export sales. We conduct our operations throughout the western contiguous United States and Alaska and believe that any subdivision of our operations into distinct geographic areas would not be meaningful.

Customer-Sponsored Research
We have not expended material amounts during the last three fiscal years on customer-sponsored research activities.

Geographic Concentration and the Alaska Economy
We offer voice, data and wireless telecommunication services and video services to customers primarily throughout Alaska. Because of this geographic concentration, growth of our business and operations depends upon economic conditions in Alaska. The economy of Alaska is dependent upon the natural resource industries, and in particular oil production, as well as investment earnings, tourism, government, and United States military spending. Any deterioration in these markets could have an adverse impact on us. A significant part of the Alaska economy is the state government.  All of the federal funding and the majority of investment revenues are dedicated for specific purposes, leaving oil revenues as the primary source of general operating revenues for the State of Alaska. The State of Alaska reported in fiscal 2010 that oil revenues supplied 89% of the State's unrestricted revenues. In fiscal 2011 state economists forecast that Alaska’s oil revenues will supply 87% of the State’s projected unrestricted revenues.

The volume of oil transported by the TransAlaska Oil Pipeline System over the past 20 years has been as high as 2.011 million barrels per day in fiscal 1988. Production has been declining over the last several years with an average of 0.644 million barrels produced per day in fiscal 2010. The State forecasts the production rate to decline from 0.616 million barrels produced per day in fiscal 2011 to 0.52 million barrels produced per day in fiscal 2020.

 
25

 
Market prices for North Slope oil averaged $74.90 in fiscal 2010 and are forecasted to average $77.96 in fiscal 2011. The closing price per barrel was $111.98 on March 1, 2011. To the extent that actual oil prices vary materially from the State’s projected prices, the State’s projected revenues and deficits will change. The production policy of the Organization of Petroleum Exporting Countries and its ability to continue to act in concert represents a key uncertainty in the State’s revenue forecast.

Should new oil discoveries or developments not materialize or the price of oil become depressed, the long term trend of continued decline in oil production from the Prudhoe Bay area is inevitable with a corresponding adverse impact on the economy of the State, in general, and on demand for telecommunications and cable television services, and, therefore, on us, in particular. Periodically there are renewed efforts to allow exploration and development in the Arctic National Wildlife Refuge (“ANWR”). The United States Energy Information Agency has estimated that it could take nine years to begin oil field drilling after approval of ANWR exploration.

No assurance can be given that the driving forces in the Alaska economy, and in particular, oil production, will continue at appropriate levels to provide an environment for expanded economic activity.  The governor of the State of Alaska and the Alaska legislature continue to evaluate the state’s oil tax structure which may also affect the oil production industry in Alaska.

No assurance can be given that oil companies doing business in Alaska will be successful in discovering new fields or further developing existing fields which are economic to develop and produce oil with access to the pipeline or other means of transport to market. We are not able to predict the effect of changes in the price and production volumes of North Slope oil on Alaska’s economy or on us.

Deployment of a natural gas pipeline from the State of Alaska’s North Slope to the lower 48 states has been proposed to supplement natural gas supplies. There are two competing companies that are studying the economic viability of a natural gas pipeline, which depends upon the price of and demand for natural gas.  Both of the companies completed an initial open season for shipping bids during 2010.  These open seasons were approved by government regulators and submissions are currently under evaluation by involved parties.

The State of Alaska maintains the Constitutional Budget Reserve Fund (“CBRF”) that is intended to fund budgetary shortfalls. If the State’s current projections are realized and no surpluses are deposited into the CBRF it is projected that the fund would not be depleted before 2020. The date the CBRF is depleted is highly influenced by the price of oil. If the fund is depleted, aggressive state action will be necessary to increase revenues and reduce spending in order to balance the budget. The governor of the State of Alaska and the Alaska legislature continue to evaluate cost cutting and revenue enhancing measures.

We have, since our entry into the telecommunication marketplace, aggressively marketed our services to seek a larger share of the available market. The customer base in Alaska is limited, however, with a population of approximately 710,000 people. The State of Alaska’s population is distributed as follows:

·  
42% are located in the Municipality of Anchorage,
·  
14% are located in the Fairbanks North Star Borough,
·  
12% are located in the Matanuska-Susitna Borough,
·  
8% are located in the Kenai Peninsula Borough,
·  
4% are located in the City and Borough of Juneau, and
·  
The remaining 20% are located in other communities across the State of Alaska.

Employees
We employed 1,655 persons as of December 31, 2010, and we are not subject to any collective bargaining agreements with our employees. We believe our future success will depend upon our continued ability to attract and retain highly skilled and qualified employees. We believe that relations with our employees are satisfactory.

Other
No material portion of our business is subject to renegotiation of profits or termination of contracts at the election of the federal government.

 
26

 
Item 1A. Risk Factors.

Factors That May Affect Our Business and Future Results

Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently deem to be immaterial may also materially and adversely affect our business operations. Any of the following risks could materially and adversely affect our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

We face competition that may reduce our market share and harm our financial performance.

There is substantial competition in the telecommunications industry.  The traditional dividing lines between long-distance, local access, wireless, Internet and video services are increasingly becoming blurred. Through mergers and various service integration strategies, major providers are striving to provide integrated communications services offerings within and across geographic markets. We face increasing video services competition from DBS providers.

We expect competition to increase as a result of the rapid development of new technologies, services and products. We cannot predict which of many possible future technologies, products or services will be important to maintain our competitive position or what expenditures will be required to develop and provide these technologies, products or services. Our ability to compete successfully will depend on marketing and on our ability to anticipate and respond to various competitive factors affecting the industry, including new services that may be introduced, changes in consumer preferences, economic conditions and pricing strategies by competitors. To the extent we do not keep pace with technological advances or fail to timely respond to changes in competitive factors in our industry and in our markets, we could lose market share or experience a decline in our revenue and net income. Competitive conditions create a risk of market share loss and the risk that customers shift to less profitable lower margin services. Competitive pressures also create challenges for our ability to grow new businesses or introduce new services successfully and execute our business plan. Each of our business segments also faces the risk of potential price cuts by our competitors that could materially adversely affect our market share and gross margins.

For more information about competition by segment, see the sections titled “Competition” included in “Item 1 — Business — Narrative Description of our Business — Description of our Business by Reportable Segment.”

Our business is subject to extensive governmental legislation and regulation. Applicable legislation and regulations and changes to them could adversely affect our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Wireless Services. The licensing, construction, operation, sale and interconnection arrangements of wireless communications systems are regulated by the FCC and, depending on the jurisdiction, state and local regulatory agencies. In particular, the FCC imposes significant regulation on licensees of wireless spectrum with respect to:
 
 
·  
How radio spectrum is used by licensees;
·  
The nature of the services that licensees may offer and how such services may be offered; and
·  
Resolution of issues of interference between spectrum bands.

The Communications Act of 1934, as amended, preempts state and local regulation of market entry by, and the rates charged by, commercial mobile radio service providers, except that states may exercise authority over such things as certain billing practices and consumer-related issues. These regulations could increase the costs of our wireless operations. The FCC grants wireless licenses for terms of generally ten years that are subject to renewal and revocation. FCC rules require all wireless licensees to meet certain build-out requirements and substantially comply with applicable FCC rules and policies and the Communications Act of 1934, as amended, in order to retain their licenses. Failure to comply with FCC requirements in a given license area could result in revocation of the license for that license area. There is no guarantee that our licenses will be renewed.

The FCC has initiated a number of proceedings to evaluate its rules and policies regarding spectrum licensing and usage. Changes proposed by the FCC could adversely impact our utilization of our licensed spectrum and our operation costs.

 
27

 
Commercial mobile radio service providers must implement enhanced 911 ("E911") capabilities in accordance with FCC rules. Failure to deploy E911 service consistent with FCC requirements could subject us to significant fines.

The FCC, together with the Federal Aviation Administration, also regulates tower marking and lighting. In addition, tower construction is affected by federal, state and local statutes addressing zoning, environmental protection and historic preservation. The FCC adopted significant changes to its rules governing historic preservation review of projects, which makes it more difficult and expensive to deploy antenna facilities. The FCC is also considering changes to its rules regarding environmental protection as related to tower construction, which, if adopted, could make it more difficult to deploy facilities.

Video Services. The cable television industry is subject to extensive regulation at various levels, and many aspects of such regulation are currently the subject of judicial proceedings and administrative or legislative proposals. The law permits certified local franchising authorities to order refunds of rates paid in the previous 12-month period determined to be in excess of the reasonable rates. It is possible that rate reductions or refunds of previously collected fees may be required of us in the future. Currently, pursuant to Alaska law, the basic cable rates in Juneau are the only rates in Alaska subject to regulation by the local franchising authority, and the rates in Juneau were reviewed and approved by the RCA in July 2010.

Proposals may be made before Congress and the FCC to mandate cable operators provide “open access” over their cable systems to Internet service providers. As of the date of this report, the FCC has declined to impose such requirements. If the FCC or other authorities mandate additional access to our cable systems, we cannot predict the effect that this would have on our Internet service offerings.

Other existing federal regulations, currently the subject of judicial, legislative, and administrative review, could change, in varying degrees, the manner in which cable television systems operate. Neither the outcome of these proceedings nor their impact upon the cable television industry in general, or on our activities and prospects in the cable television business in particular, can be predicted at this time. There can be no assurance that future regulatory actions taken by Congress, the FCC or other federal, state or local government authorities will not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Internet Services. Changes in the regulatory environment relating to the Internet access market, including changes in legislation, FCC regulation, judicial action or local regulation that affect communications costs or increase competition from the ILEC or other communications services providers, could adversely affect the prices at which we sell Internet services.

Local Access Services. Our success in the local telephone market depends on our continued ability to obtain interconnection, access and related services from local exchange carriers on terms that are reasonable and that are based on the cost of providing these services. Our local telephone services business faces the risk of the impact of the implementation of current regulations and legislation, unfavorable changes in regulation or legislation or the introduction of new regulations. Our ability to enter into the local telephone market depends on our negotiation or arbitration with local exchange carriers to allow interconnection to the carrier’s existing local telephone network, to establish dialing parity, to obtain access to rights-of-way, to resell services offered by the local exchange carrier, and in some cases, to allow the purchase, at cost-based rates, of access to UNEs. In some Alaska markets, it also depends on our ability to gain interconnection at economic costs. Future arbitration proceedings with respect to new or existing markets could result in a change in our cost of serving these markets via the facilities of the ILEC or via wholesale offerings.

For more information about Regulations affecting our operations, see “Competition” contained in “Item 1 — Business — Regulation.”

Loss of our ETC status would disqualify us for USF support.

The USF pays support to ETCs to support the provision of facilities-based wireline and wireless telephone service in high-cost areas. If we were to lose our ETC status in any of the study areas where we are currently an authorized ETC, we would be ineligible to receive USF support for providing service in that area. Loss of our ETC status could have an adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

 
28

 
Revenues and accounts receivable from USF support may be reduced or lost.

We receive support from each of the various USF programs: high-cost, low income, rural health care, and schools and libraries.  This support was 18%, 14%, and 10% of our revenue for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  The programs are subject to change by regulatory actions taken by the FCC or legislative actions.  The FCC has proposed phasing out support for voice services and targeting support to broadband services, as well as phasing out support for competitive ETCs.  In addition, members of Congress have indicated that they may seek enactment of legislation addressing universal service reform, including legislation to limit growth of explicit universal service support funds. Changes to any of the USF programs that we participate in could result in a material decrease in revenue and accounts receivable, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

See “Description of Our Business by Reportable Segment — Regulation — Wireline Voice Services and Products — Universal Service” for more information.

We may not be able to satisfy the requirements of the loan/grant we obtained to build TERRA-SW and/or we may have to spend considerably more than expected to complete the project.

The TERRA-SW project requires us to construct network facilities in rural areas of Alaska where extensive network facilities have never been built.  Our ability to complete the TERRA-SW project will require us to obtain permits from various government agencies as well as construct facilities in rural locations.  We will be unable to meet the requirements of the grant if we are unable to obtain necessary construction permits and if we are unable to construct the necessary facilities in the rural locations.  Additionally, we may be required to incur significant unplanned costs if we encounter unplanned construction challenges.  These additional unplanned costs may require us to modify our other network expansion plans so that we may meet the requirements of the grant.  Our inability to meet the requirements of the grant and/or significant cost overruns in the construction of TERRA-SW could have an adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Failure to complete development, testing and deployment of new technology that supports new services could affect our ability to compete in the industry.  In addition, the technology we use may place us at a competitive disadvantage.

We develop, test and deploy various new technologies and support systems intended to enhance our competitiveness by both supporting new services and features and reducing the costs associated with providing those services or features.  Successful development and implementation of technology upgrades depend, in part, on the willingness of third parties to develop new applications in a timely manner.  We may not successfully complete the development and rollout of new technology and related features or services in a timely manner, and they may not be widely accepted by our customers or may not be profitable, in which case we could not recover our investment in the technology.  Deployment of technology supporting new service offerings may also adversely affect the performance or reliability of our networks with respect to both the new and existing services.  Any resulting customer dissatisfaction could affect our ability to retain customers and may have an adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations, or liquidity.

Unfavorable general economic conditions in the United States could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and liquidity.

Unfavorable general economic conditions, including the current economic downturn in the United States, could negatively affect our business.  While it is often difficult for us to predict the impact of general economic conditions on our business, these conditions could adversely affect the affordability of and demand for some of our products and services and could cause customers to shift to lower priced products and services or to delay or forgo purchases of our products and services.  One or more of these circumstances could cause our revenue to decline.  Also, our customers may not be able to obtain adequate access to credit, which could affect their ability to make timely payments to us.  If that were to occur, we could be required to increase our allowance for doubtful accounts, and the number of days outstanding for our accounts receivable could increase.  The government has taken various measures in an attempt to help improve the economy, however, we are unable to predict the success or outcome of such programs.  For these reasons, among others, if the current economic conditions persist or decline, this could adversely affect our financial position, results of operations, or liquidity, as well as our ability to service debt, pay other obligations and enhance shareholder returns.

 
29

 
Our business is geographically concentrated in Alaska. Any deterioration in the economic conditions in Alaska could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and liquidity.

We offer voice, data and wireless communication and video services to customers primarily in Alaska. Because of this geographic concentration, our growth and operations depend upon economic conditions in Alaska. The economy of Alaska is dependent upon natural resource industries, in particular oil production, as well as tourism, and government spending, including substantial amounts for the United States military. Any deterioration in these markets could have an adverse impact on the demand for communication and cable television services and on our results of operations and financial condition. In addition, the customer base in Alaska is limited. Alaska has a population of approximately 710,000 people, 54% of whom are located in the Anchorage and Matanuska-Susitna Borough region. We have already achieved significant market penetration with respect to our service offerings in Anchorage and in other locations in Alaska.

We may not be able to continue to increase our market share of the existing markets for our services, and no assurance can be given that the Alaskan economy will continue to grow and increase the size of the markets we serve or increase the demand for the services we offer. As a result, the best opportunities for expanding our business may arise in other geographic areas such as the lower 49 states. There can be no assurance that we will find attractive opportunities to grow our businesses outside of Alaska or that we will have the necessary expertise to take advantage of such opportunities. The markets in Alaska for voice, data and wireless communications and video services are unique and distinct within the United States due to Alaska’s large geographical size, its sparse population located in a limited number of clusters, and its distance from the rest of the United States. The expertise we have developed in operating our businesses in Alaska may not provide us with the necessary expertise to successfully enter other geographic markets.

Prolonged service interruptions could affect our business.

We rely heavily on our network equipment, communications providers, data and software to support all of our functions. We rely on our networks and the networks of others for substantially all of our revenues. We are able to deliver services only to the extent that we can protect our network systems against damage from power or communication failures, computer viruses, natural disasters, unauthorized access and other disruptions. While we endeavor to provide for failures in the network by providing back-up systems and procedures, we cannot guarantee that these back-up systems and procedures will operate satisfactorily in an emergency. Should we experience a prolonged failure, it could seriously jeopardize our ability to continue operations. In particular, should a significant service interruption occur, our ongoing customers may choose a different provider, and our reputation may be damaged, reducing our attractiveness to new customers.

To the extent that any disruption or security breach results in a loss or damage to our customers’ data or applications, or inappropriate disclosure of confidential information, we may incur liability and suffer from adverse publicity. In addition, we may incur additional costs to remedy the damage caused by these disruptions or security breaches.

If failures occur in our undersea fiber optic cable systems, our ability to immediately restore the entirety of our service may be limited and we could incur significant costs, which could lead to a material adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

Our communications facilities include undersea fiber optic cable systems that carry a large portion of our traffic to and from the contiguous lower 48 states one of which provides an alternative geographically diverse backup communication facility to the other. If a failure of both sides of the ring of our undersea fiber optic facilities occurs and we are not able to secure alternative facilities, some of the communications services we offer to our customers could be interrupted which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.  Damage to an undersea fiber optic cable system can result in significant unplanned expense which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

If a failure occurs in our satellite communications systems, our ability to immediately restore the entirety of our service may be limited.

Our communications facilities include satellite transponders that we use to serve many rural and remote Alaska locations. Each of our C-band and Ku-band satellite transponders is backed up on the same
 
 
30

 
spacecraft with multiple backup transponders. If a failure of our satellite transponders occurs and we are not able to secure alternative facilities, some of the communications services we offer to our customers could be interrupted which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

We depend on a limited number of third-party vendors to supply communications equipment. If we do not obtain the necessary communications equipment, we will not be able to meet the needs of our customers.

We depend on a limited number of third-party vendors to supply cable, Internet, DLPS, wireless and other telephony-related equipment. If our providers of this equipment are unable to timely supply the equipment necessary to meet our needs or provide them at an acceptable cost, we may not be able to satisfy demand for our services and competitors may fulfill this demand. Due to the unique characteristics of the Alaska communications markets (i.e., remote locations, rural, satellite-served, low density populations, and our leading edge services and products), in many situations we deploy and utilize specialized, advanced technology and equipment that may not have a large market or demand. Our vendors may not succeed in developing sufficient market penetration to sustain continuing production and may fail. Vendor bankruptcy, or acquisition without continuing product support by the acquiring company, may require us to replace technology before its otherwise useful end of life due to lack of on-going vendor support and product development.

We do not have insurance to cover certain risks to which we are subject, which could lead to the incurrence of uninsured liabilities that adversely affect our financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

As is typical in the communications industry, we are self-insured for damage or loss to certain of our transmission facilities, including our buried, undersea and above-ground transmission lines. If we become subject to substantial uninsured liabilities due to damage or loss to such facilities, our financial position, results of operations or liquidity may be adversely affected.

Our significant debt could adversely affect our business and prevent us from fulfilling our obligations under our Senior Notes.

We have and will continue to have a significant amount of debt. On December 31, 2010, we had total debt of $786.7 million.  Our debt balance is expected to increase by $44.2 million with the construction of TERRA-SW between 2011 and 2012.  Our high level of debt could have important consequences, including the following:

·  
Use of a large portion of our cash flow to pay principal and interest on our Senior Notes and our other debt, which will reduce the availability of our cash flow to fund working capital, capital expenditures, research and development expenditures and other business activities;
·  
Increase our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions;
·  
Limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industry in which we operate;
·  
Restrict us from making strategic acquisitions or exploiting business opportunities;
·  
Make it more difficult for us to satisfy our obligations with respect to the Senior Notes and our other debt;
·  
Place us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors that have less debt; and
·  
Limit, along with the financial and other restrictive covenants in our debt, among other things, our ability to borrow additional funds, dispose of assets or pay cash dividends.

We will require a significant amount of cash to service our debt, complete our planned network expansion and to meet other obligations. Our ability to generate cash depends on many factors beyond our control. If we are unable to meet our future capital needs it may be necessary for us to curtail, delay or abandon our business growth plans.  If we incur significant additional indebtedness to fund our plans, it could cause a decline in our credit rating and could increase our borrowing costs or limit our ability to raise additional capital.

We will continue to require a significant amount of cash to satisfy our debt service requirements and to meet other obligations.  We expect to incur $44.2 million in additional debt for the construction of TERRA-SW in 2011-2012 and, to meet our capital needs, we may incur additional debt in the future.  Our ability to make payments on and to refinance our debt and to fund planned capital expenditures and acquisitions will depend on our ability to generate cash and to arrange additional financing in the future. These abilities are subject to, among other factors, our credit rating, our financial performance, general economic conditions,
 
 
31

 
prevailing market conditions, the state of competition in our market, the outcome of certain legislative and regulatory issues and other factors that may be beyond our control. Our business may not generate sufficient cash flow from operations and future borrowings may not be available to us in an amount sufficient to enable us to pay our debt or to fund our other liquidity needs.  We may need to refinance all or a portion of our debt on or before maturity.  We may not be able to refinance any of our debt on commercially reasonable terms or at all.

The terms of our debt impose restrictions on us that may affect our ability to successfully operate our business and our ability to make payments on the Senior Notes.

The indentures governing our Senior Notes and/or the credit agreements governing our Senior Credit Facility and other loans contain various covenants that could materially and adversely affect our ability to finance our future operations or capital needs and to engage in other business activities that may be in our best interest.

All of these covenants may restrict our ability to expand or to pursue our business strategies. Our ability to comply with these covenants may be affected by events beyond our control, such as prevailing economic conditions and changes in regulations, and if such events occur, we cannot be sure that we will be able to comply. A breach of these covenants could result in a default under the indentures governing our Senior Notes and/or the Senior Credit Facility. If there were an event of default under the indentures for the Senior Notes and/or the Senior Credit Facility, holders of such defaulted debt could cause all amounts borrowed under these instruments to be due and payable immediately. Additionally, if we fail to repay the debt under the Senior Credit Facility when it becomes due, the lenders under the Senior Credit Facility could proceed against certain of our assets and capital stock of our subsidiaries that we have pledged to them as security. Our assets or cash flow may not be sufficient to repay borrowings under our outstanding debt instruments in the event of a default thereunder.

Concerns about health risks associated with wireless equipment may reduce the demand for our wireless services.

Portable communications devices have been alleged to pose health risks, including cancer, due to radio frequency emissions from these devices.  Purported class actions and other lawsuits have been filed against numerous other wireless carriers seeking not only damages but also remedies that could increase the cost of doing business.  We cannot be sure of the outcome of those cases or that the industry will not be adversely affected by litigation of this nature or public perception about health risks.  The actual or perceived risk of mobile communications devices could adversely affect us through a reduction in subscribers.  Further research and studies are ongoing, and we cannot be sure that additional studies will not demonstrate a link between radio frequency emissions and health concerns.

Additionally, new government regulations on the use of a wireless device while driving may affect us through a reduction in subscribers.  Studies have indicated that using wireless devices while driving may impair a driver’s attention.  Many state and local legislative bodies have passed or proposed legislation to restrict the use of wireless telephones while driving vehicles.  Concerns over safety and the effect of future legislation, if adopted and enforced in the areas we serve, could limit our ability to market and sell our wireless services.  Litigation relating to accidents, deaths or serious bodily injuries allegedly incurred as a result of wireless telephone use while driving could result in adverse publicity and further governmental regulation.  Any of these results could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

A significant percentage of our voting securities are owned by a small number of shareholders and these shareholders can control shareholder decisions on very important matters.

As of December 31, 2010, our executive officers and directors and their affiliates owned 9% of our combined outstanding Class A and class B common stock, representing 20% of the combined voting power of that stock. These shareholders can significantly influence, if not control, our management policy and all fundamental corporate actions, including mergers, substantial acquisitions and dispositions, and election of directors to the Board.

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments.
None.

 
32

 
Item 2. Properties
Our properties do not lend themselves to description by location of principal units.  The majority of our properties are located in Alaska.  It is not practicable to allocate our properties to our reportable segments since many of our properties are employed by more than one segment to provide common services and products.  Additionally our properties are managed at the consolidated company level rather than at the segment level.

We lease our executive, corporate and administrative facilities and business offices. Our operating, executive, corporate and administrative properties are in good condition. We consider our properties suitable and adequate for our present needs and they are being fully utilized.

Our properties consist primarily of undersea and terrestrial fiber optic cable networks, switching equipment, satellite transponders and earth stations, microwave radio, cable and wire facilities, cable head-end equipment, wireless towers and equipment, coaxial distribution networks, connecting lines (aerial, underground and buried cable), routers, servers, transportation equipment, computer equipment, general office equipment, land, land improvements, landing stations and other buildings. Substantially all of our properties are located on or in leased real property or facilities.  Substantially all of our properties secure our Senior Credit Facility. See note 6 included in “Part II — Item 8 — Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for more information.

 
Item 3. Legal Proceedings
Except as set forth in this item, neither the Company, its property nor any of its subsidiaries or their property is a party to or subject to any material pending legal proceedings. We are parties to various claims and pending litigation as part of the normal course of business. We are also involved in several administrative proceedings and filings with the FCC and state regulatory authorities. In the opinion of management, the nature and disposition of these matters are considered routine and arising in the ordinary course of business.  In addition we are involved in the following matters:

·  
In September 2008, the FCC’s Office of Inspector General ("OIG") initiated an investigation regarding Alaska DigiTel LLC’s (“Alaska DigiTel”) compliance with program rules and requirements under the Lifeline Program. The request covered the period beginning January 1, 2004 through August 31, 2008 and related to amounts received for Lifeline service.  Alaska DigiTel was an Alaska based wireless communications company of which we acquired an 81.9% equity interest on January 2, 2007 and the remaining 18.1% equity interest on August 18, 2008 and was subsequently merged with one of our wholly owned subsidiaries in April 2009. Prior to August 18, 2008, our control over the operations of Alaska DigiTel was limited as required by the FCC upon its approval of our initial acquisition completed in January 2007. We responded to this request on behalf of Alaska DigiTel and the GCI companies as affiliates.   On January 18, 2011, we reached an agreement with the FCC and the Department of Justice to settle the matter, which required us to contribute $1.6 million to the United States Treasury and grants us a broad release of claims including those under the False Claims Act. The $1.6 million contribution, of which $154,000, $661,000 and $741,000 was recognized in selling, general and administrative expense in the Statement of Operations in the years ending December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, was paid in January 2011; and
·  
In August 2010, a GCI-owned aircraft was involved in an accident resulting in five fatalities and injuries to the remaining four passengers on board.  We had aircraft and liability insurance coverage in effect at the time of the accident.  We cannot predict the likelihood or nature of any potential claims related to the accident.

 
Item 4. Submissions of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders
(Removed and Reserved)
 
 
33

 

Part II

Item 5. Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Market Information for Common Stock
Shares of GCI’s Class A common stock are traded on the Nasdaq Global Select MarketSM under the symbol GNCMA.

Shares of GCI’s Class B common stock are traded through the Over-The-Counter Bulletin Board service offered by the National Association of Securities Dealers. Each share of Class B common stock is convertible, at the option of the holder, into one share of Class A common stock.

The following table sets forth the high and low sales price for our common stock for the periods indicated. Market price data for Class A shares was obtained from the Nasdaq Stock Market System quotation system. Market price data for Class B shares was obtained from reported Over-the-Counter Bulletin Board service market transactions. The prices represent prices between dealers, do not include retail markups, markdowns, or commissions, and do not necessarily represent actual transactions.

 
 
Class A
   
Class B
 
 
 
High
   
Low
   
High
   
Low
 
2010 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
First Quarter
  $ 6.65       5.32       6.05       6.05  
Second Quarter
  $ 7.62       5.73       7.00       7.00  
Third Quarter
  $ 10.21       7.64       9.00       7.50  
Fourth Quarter
  $ 13.37       9.92       11.50       10.00  
2009 
                               
First Quarter
  $ 8.61       3.78       6.00       6.00  
Second Quarter
  $ 8.06       6.32       6.75       2.00  
Third Quarter
  $ 7.21       6.41       7.00       6.40  
Fourth Quarter
  $ 6.82       5.87       5.00       5.00  

Holders
As of December 31, 2010 there were 2,407 holders of record of our Class A common stock and 373 holders of record of our Class B common stock (amounts do not include the number of shareholders whose shares are held of record by brokers, but do include the brokerage house as one shareholder).

Dividends
We have never paid cash dividends on our common stock, and we have no present intention of doing so. Payment of cash dividends in the future, if any, will be determined by our Board of Directors in light of our earnings, financial condition and other relevant considerations. Our existing debt agreements contain provisions that limit payment of dividends on common stock, other than stock dividends (see note 6 included in “Part II — Item 8 — Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for more information).

Stock Transfer Agent and Registrar
BNY Mellon Shareowner Services is our stock transfer agent and registrar.

Performance Graph
The following graph includes a line graph comparing the yearly percentage change in our cumulative total shareholder return on our Class A common stock during the five-year period 2006 through 2010. This return is measured by dividing (1) the sum of (a) the cumulative amount of dividends for the measurement period (assuming dividend reinvestment, if any) and (b) the difference between our share price at the end and the beginning of the measurement period, by (2) the share price at the beginning of that measurement period. This line graph is compared in the following graph with two other line graphs during that five-year period, i.e., a market index and a peer index.

 
34

 
The market index is the Center for Research in Securities Price Index for the Nasdaq Stock Market for United States companies. It presents cumulative total returns for a broad based equity market assuming reinvestment of dividends and is based upon companies whose equity securities are traded on the Nasdaq Stock Market. The peer index is the Center for Research in Securities Price Index for Nasdaq Telecommunications Stock. It presents cumulative total returns for the equity market in the telecommunications industry segment assuming reinvestment of dividends and is based upon companies whose equity securities are traded on the Nasdaq Stock Market. The line graphs represent annual index levels derived from compounding daily returns.

In constructing each of the line graphs in the following graph, the closing price at the beginning point of the five-year measurement period has been converted into a fixed investment, stated in dollars, in our Class A common stock (or in the stock represented by a given index, in the cases of the two comparison indexes), with cumulative returns for each subsequent fiscal year measured as a change from that investment. Data for each succeeding fiscal year during the five-year measurement period are plotted with points showing the cumulative total return as of that point. The value of a shareholder’s investment as of each point plotted on a given line graph is the number of shares held at that point multiplied by the then prevailing share price.

Our Class B common stock is traded through the Over-The-Counter Bulletin Board service on a more limited basis. Therefore, comparisons similar to those previously described for the Class A common stock are not directly available. However, the performance of Class B common stock may be analogized to that of the Class A common stock in that the Class B common stock is readily convertible into Class A common stock by request to us.



Prepared by Zacks Investment Research Inc. All indexes used with permission. All rights reserved.

COMPARISON OF FIVE-YEAR CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURNS PERFORMANCE GRAPH FOR GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC., NASDAQ STOCK MARKET INDEX FOR UNITED STATES COMPANIES, AND NASDAQ TELECOMMUNICATIONS STOCK1,2,3,4
Measurement Period (Fiscal Year Covered)
Company ($)
Nasdaq Stock Market Index for U.S. Companies ($)
Nasdaq Telecommunications Stock ($)
 
 
 
 
FYE 12/31/05
 100.00 
 100.00 
 100.00 
FYE 12/31/06
 152.28 
 109.84 
 131.49 
FYE 12/31/07
 84.69 
 119.14 
 116.96 
FYE 12/31/08
 78.30 
 57.41 
 67.20 
FYE 12/31/09
 61.75 
 82.53 
 100.77 
FYE 12/31/10
 122.53 
 97.95 
 130.11 

1
The lines represent annual index levels derived from compounded daily returns that include all dividends.
2
The indexes are reweighted daily, using the market capitalization on the previous trading day.
3
If the annual interval, based on the fiscal year-end, is not a trading day, the preceding trading day is used.
4
The index level for all series was set to $100.00 on December 31, 2005.

 
35

 

Issuers Purchases of Equity Securities

(a) Not applicable.
 
(b) Not applicable.
 
(c) The following table provides information about repurchases of shares of our Class A common stock during the quarter ended December 31, 2010:
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
(d) Maximum
   
 
 
 
 
(c) Total
Number (or
   
 
 
 
 
Number of
approximate
   
 
 
 
 
Shares
Dollar Value) of
   
 
 
 
 
Purchased as
Shares that May
   
 
 
(a) Total
 
Part of Publicly
Yet Be
   
 
 
Number of
(b) Average
Announced
Purchased Under
   
 
 
Shares
Price Paid per
Plans or
the Plan or
   
Purchased1 
Share
Programs
Programs3 
 
 October 1, 2010 to
 
 
   
 
 October 31, 2010
 7,486,281 
$10.16
7,486,281 
$122,057,841
 
 November 1, 2010 to
 
 
   
 
 November 30, 2010
 105,946
$10.96
 105,946 
$123,219,019
 
 December 1, 2010 to
 
 
   
 
 December 31, 2010
 195,747 
$11.72
 195,747
$125,512,824
   
 
Total
 7,787,974 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
Private purchases made under our publicly announced repurchase plan.
 
The repurchase plan was publicly announced on November 3, 2004.  Our plan does not have an expiration date, however transactions pursuant to the plan are subject to periodic approval by our Board of Directors. We expect to continue the repurchases for an indefinite period dependent on leverage, liquidity, company performance, market conditions and subject to continued oversight by our Board of Directors.
 
The total amount approved by our Board of Directors for repurchase under our publicly announced repurchase plan was $275.2 million through December 31, 2010 consisting of $135.0 million through September 30, 2010 and an additional $140.2 million during the three months ended December 31, 2010.  We have made total repurchases under the program of $149.7 million through December 31, 2010.  If stock repurchases are less than the total approved quarterly amount the difference may be carried forward and used to repurchase additional shares in future quarters, subject to board approval.
   
 
 
 
 
 
     
 
 
 
36

 
Item 6. Selected Financial Data
The following table presents selected historical information relating to financial condition and results of operations over the past five years.

 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
   
2006
 
(Amounts in thousands except per share amounts)
 
Revenues
  $ 651,250       595,811       575,442       520,311       477,482  
Income (loss) before income tax
  expense and cumulative effect of a
  change in accounting principle
  $ 18,443       7,452       (2,295 )     25,859       34,253  
Cumulative effect of a change in
  accounting principal, net of income
  tax expense of $44 in 2006
  $ -       -       -       -       64  
Net income (loss)
  $ 8,955       3,516       (3,372 )     13,697       18,520  
Net loss attributable to the
  non-controlling interest
  $ -       -       1,503       36       -  
Net income (loss) attributable to GCI
  common stockholders
  $ 8,955       3,516       (1,869 )     13,733       18,520  
Basic net income (loss) attributable to
  GCI per common share
  $ 0.17       0.07       (0.04 )     0.26       0.34  
Diluted net income (loss) attributable
  to GCI per common share
  $ 0.17       0.06       (0.04 )     0.23       0.33  
Total assets
  $ 1,351,760       1,418,397       1,335,301       984,233       914,659  
Long-term debt, including current
  portion and net of unamortized
  discount
  $ 781,717       776,380       716,831       538,398       489,462  
Obligations under capital leases,
  including current portion
  $ 91,165       95,914       100,329       2,851       2,857  
Redeemable preferred stock
                                       
   Series B
  $ -       -       -       -       -  
   Series C
  $ -       -       -       -       -  
Total GCI stockholders’ equity
  $ 200,506       266,317       258,915       259,433       246,278  
Dividends declared per common share
  $ 0.00       0.00       0.00       0.00       0.00  

The Selected Financial Data should be read in conjunction with “Part II — Item 7 — Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
In the following discussion, General Communication, Inc. and its direct and indirect subsidiaries are referred to as “we,” “us” and “our.”
 
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations discusses our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. The preparation of these financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. On an on-going basis, we evaluate our estimates and judgments, including those related to the allowance for doubtful
 
 
37

 
receivables, unbilled revenues, accrual of the USF high-cost area program subsidy, share-based compensation, reserve for future customer credits, valuation allowances for deferred income tax assets, depreciable and amortizable lives of assets, the carrying value of long-lived assets including goodwill, cable certificates and wireless licenses, our effective tax rate, purchase price allocations, the accrual of cost of goods sold (exclusive of depreciation and amortization expense ("Cost of Goods Sold")), depreciation, and contingencies and litigation. We base our estimates and judgments on historical experience and on various other factors that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions. See also our “Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.”

The following discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and supplementary data as presented in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

General Overview
Through our focus on long-term results, acquisitions, and strategic capital investments, we strive to consistently grow our revenues and expand our margins. We have historically met our cash needs for operations, regular capital expenditures and maintenance capital expenditures through our cash flows from operating activities. Historically, cash requirements for significant acquisitions and major capital expenditures have been provided largely through our financing activities.

The weakness in the national economy has negatively impacted consumer confidence and spending.  There are some indicators that consumer confidence might be improving; however, there is no clear indication that the economy is in a recovery.  Continued stress in the economy could lead to reductions in consumer spending which could impact our revenue growth.  We believe the Alaska economy continues to perform well compared to most other states at the current time.  Mortgage foreclosure rates in Alaska are among the lowest in the nation and the commercial real estate market is steady.  The State of Alaska has large cash reserves that should enable it to maintain its budget for at least the short-term.  This is important for Alaska’s economy as the State is the largest employer and second largest source of gross state product. The majority of our revenue is driven by the strength of the Alaska economy which appears to have weathered the recessionary pressures relatively well to date.  Nonetheless we cannot predict the impact the nation’s economic changes may have on us in the future.

Effective June 1, 2008, we purchased 100% of the outstanding stock of UUI and Unicom.  The financial results of the long-distance, local access and Internet services sold to consumer and commercial customers of certain of these acquired companies are reported in the Regulated Operations segment.  The financial results of the long-distance services sold to other common carrier customers and the managed broadband services components of certain of these acquired companies are included in the Network Access and Managed Broadband Services segments, respectively.  Effective July 1, 2008, we closed on our purchase of 100% of the ownership interests of Alaska Wireless whose results are included in the Consumer segment.

Results of Operations
The following table sets forth selected Statements of Operations data as a percentage of total revenues for the periods indicated (underlying data rounded to the nearest thousands):

 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
Percentage
   
Percentage
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
Change1
   
Change1
 
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
   
2010
   
2009
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
vs. 2009
   
vs. 2008
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
             
Statements of Operations Data:
   
 
   
 
             
Revenues:
 
 
   
 
   
 
             
 Consumer segment
    53 %     49 %     45 %     16 %     15 %
 Network Access segment
    16 %     21 %     27 %     (12 %)     (20 %)
 Commercial segment
    20 %     18 %     20 %     17 %     (4 %)
 Managed Broadband segment
    8 %     8 %     6 %     11 %     21 %
 Regulated Operations segment
    3 %     4 %     2 %     (5 %)     68 %
Total revenues
    100 %     100 %     100 %     9 %     4 %
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    35 %     36 %     37 %     8 %     1 %
 
 
 
38

 
 
Depreciation and amortization expense
    19 %     21 %     20 %     2 %     8 %
Operating income
    14 %     11 %     8 %     34 %     39 %
Other expense, net
    11 %     10 %     9 %     19 %     17 %
Income before income tax expense
    3 %     1 %     0 %     147 %     425 %
Net income (loss)
    1 %     1 %     (1 %)     155 %     204 %
Net loss attributable to the non-controlling interest
    0 %     0 %     0 %     0 %     100 %
Net income attributable to GCI
    1 %     1 %     0 %     155 %     288 %
 
                                       
Percentage change in underlying data
                                 

We evaluate performance and allocate resources based on earnings before depreciation and amortization expense, net interest expense, income taxes, share-based compensation expense, accretion expense and non-cash contribution adjustment (“Adjusted EBITDA”).  Management believes that this measure is useful to investors and other users of our financial information in evaluating operating profitability as an analytical indicator of income generated to service debt and fund capital expenditures.  In addition, multiples of current or projected EBITDA are used to estimate current or prospective enterprise value.  See note 10 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements for a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA to Consolidated Income (Loss) Before Income Tax Expense.

Year Ended December 31, 2010 (“2010”) Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2009 (“2009”)

Overview of Revenues and Cost of Goods Sold
Total revenues increased 9% from $595.8 million in 2009 to $651.3 million in 2010.  Revenue increases in our Consumer, Commercial and Managed Broadband segments were partially off-set by decreased revenue in our Network Access and Regulated Operations segments.  See the discussion below for more information by segment.

Total Cost of Goods Sold increased 7% from $193.7 million in 2009 to $207.8 million in 2010. Cost of Goods Sold increases in our Consumer, Commercial and Managed Broadband segments were partially off-set by decreases in our Network Access and Regulated Operations segments.  See the discussion below for more information by segment.

Consumer Segment Overview
Consumer segment revenue represented 53% of 2010 consolidated revenues. The components of Consumer segment revenue are as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 57,317       52,654       9 %
Video
    118,475       110,986       7 %
Data
    61,364       50,327       22 %
Wireless
    105,742       80,958       31 %
Total Consumer segment revenue
  $ 342,898       294,925       16 %

Consumer segment Cost of Goods Sold represented 50% of 2010 consolidated Cost of Goods Sold. The components of Consumer segment Cost of Goods Sold are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
39

 


 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 12,042       14,952       (19 %)
Video
    51,246       45,350       13 %
Data
    3,781       4,367       (13 %)
Wireless
    37,412       32,225       16 %
Total Consumer segment Cost of Goods Sold
  $ 104,481       96,894       8 %

Consumer segment Adjusted EBITDA, representing 52% of 2010 consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Consumer segment Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 114,716       86,587       32 %

Selected key performance indicators for our Consumer segment follow:

 
   
 
December 31,
 
Percentage
 
 
   
 
2010 
 
2009 
 
Change
 
 
 Voice:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long-distance subscribers
 
 88,200
 
 90,500
 
(3%)
 
 
 
Long-distance minutes carried (in millions)
 
 106.9
 
 114.7
 
(7%)
 
 
 
Total local access lines in service
 
 84,800
 
 84,200
 
1%
 
 
 
Local access lines in service on GCI facilities
 
 77,400
 
 75,200
 
3%
 
 
 Video:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic subscribers
 
 130,000
 
 130,500
 
0%
 
 
 
Digital programming tier subscribers
 
 81,800
 
 79,600
 
3%
 
 
 
HD/DVR converter boxes
 
 88,100
 
 81,500
 
8%
 
 
 
Homes passed
 
238,500
 
 232,400
 
3%
 
 
 
Average monthly gross revenue per subscriber
 
$ 75.83
 
$ 70.36
 
8%
 
 
 Data:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cable modem subscribers
 
 105,700
 
 100,200
 
6%
 
 
 Wireless:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wireless lines in service
 
 124,900
 
 115,100
 
9%
 
 
 
Average monthly gross revenue per subscriber
 
$ 63.96
 
$ 58.23
 
21%
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A long-distance subscriber is defined as a customer account that is invoiced a monthly long-distance plan fee or has made a long-distance call during the month.
 
A local access line in service is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network.
 
A basic cable subscriber is defined as one basic tier of service delivered to an address or separate subunits thereof regardless of the number of outlets purchased.
 
A digital programming tier subscriber is defined as one digital programming tier of service delivered to an address or separate subunits thereof regardless of the number of outlets or digital programming tiers purchased. Digital programming tier subscribers are a subset of basic subscribers.
 
A HD/DVR converter box is defined as one box rented by a digital programming or basic tier subscriber. A digital programming or basic tier subscriber is not required to rent an HD/DVR converter box to receive service.
 
Year-to-date average monthly consumer video revenues divided by the average of consumer video basic subscribers at the beginning and end of each month in the period.
 
A cable modem subscriber is defined by the purchase of cable modem service regardless of the level of service purchased. If one entity purchases multiple cable modem service access points, each access point is counted as a subscriber. Cable modem subscribers may also be video basic subscribers though basic cable service is not required to receive cable modem service.
 
A wireless line in service is defined as a revenue generating wireless device.
 
Year-to-date average monthly consumer wireless revenues divided by the average of consumer wireless subscribers at the beginning and end of each month in the period.
   
 

 
 
40

 
Consumer Segment Revenues
The increase in voice revenue is primarily due to a $4.4 million or 54% increase in USAC support. We accrue estimated high cost support revenue quarterly and adjust our revenue as we obtain new information that changes the variables used to calculate our estimate.  The increase in USF high cost support is primarily due to changes in the variables used to calculate our estimate and an increase in the number of local subscribers.  This increase was partially off-set by an absence of $674,000 in support in 2009 related to services provided during the year ended December 31, 2008.  In March 2009, the FCC issued an order which provided uncapped support for all lines served by competitive ETCs for tribal lands in Alaska Native regions retroactive to August 2008.  This revenue was for the additional support for the period August to December 2008.

The increase in video revenue is primarily due to the following:

·  
A 6% increase in programming services revenue to $93.9 million in 2010 primarily resulting from an increase in digital programming tier subscribers in 2010 and a rate increase on certain cable service offerings beginning in August 2009, and
·  
An 8% increase in equipment rental revenue to $23.4 million in 2010 primarily resulting from our customers’ increased use of our HD/DVR converter boxes.

The increase in data revenue is primarily due to a 23% increase in cable modem revenue to $53.4 million due to increased subscribers, rate increases in May and August 2010, our subscribers’ selection of plans that offer higher speeds, and an increase in charges for usage above plan limits.

The increase in wireless revenue is primarily due to the following:

·  
A $19.8 million increase in USAC support to $51.4 million. This increase includes a $16.3 million increase in USF high cost support and a $3.5 million increase in USF low income support. We accrue estimated USF high cost support revenue quarterly and adjust our revenue as we obtain new information that changes the variables used to calculate our estimate. The increase in USF high cost support is primarily due to changes in the variables used to calculate our estimate, an increase in the number of wireless subscribers and $1.0 million for amended line count filings for which the revenue recognition criteria was met in the third quarter of 2010.  The increase in USF low income support is due to an increase in the number of wireless subscribers who qualify under this program; and
·  
A $7.3 million increase in plan fee revenue to $37.8 million due to an increase in the number of wireless subscribers.

These increases were partially off-set by the following:

·  
An absence of $1.7 million in support recorded in 2009 related to services provided during the year ended December 31, 2008.  The support was for a new local access area for which we received ETC status in May 2009.  Collectability was not reasonably assured until we were awarded ETC status, therefore we deferred revenue recognition until such status was confirmed, and
·  
An absence of $810,000 recorded in 2009 related to services provided during the year ended December 31, 2008.  In March 2009, the FCC issued an order which provided uncapped support for all lines served by competitive ETCs for tribal lands in Alaska Native regions retroactive to August 2008.  This revenue was for the additional support for the period August to December 2008.

Consumer Segment Cost of Goods Sold
The decrease in voice Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to decreased voice minutes carried, cost savings resulting from the increased deployment of local access services lines on our own facilities during 2010, and a $392,000 favorable adjustment based upon refunds from several vendors.  In the course of business we estimate unbilled long-distance services Cost of Goods Sold based upon minutes of use processed
 
 
41

 
through our network and established rates.  Such estimates are revised when subsequent billings are received, payments are made, billing matters are researched and resolved, tariffed billing periods lapse, or when disputed charges are resolved.

The increase in video Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to increased channels offered to our subscribers, increased rates paid to programmers, increased costs associated with delivery of digital services offered through our HD/DVR converter boxes due to the increased number of boxes in service, and an increase in digital programming tier subscribers.  The increases were partially offset by the absence of a $594,000 charge in 2009 to settle a billing issue with a cable programmer.

The decrease in data Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to the transition of traffic to our own facilities from leased facilities.

The increase in wireless Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to increased costs for wireless handset equipment sales associated with the increased number of wireless subscribers and an increased number of premium wireless handsets which have higher costs.  As part of an agreement signed in December 2007 with AT&T Mobility, AT&T Mobility has provided to us a large block of wireless network usage at no charge that we use for roaming.  We expect this block of minutes to expire in the first half of 2012 at which time we expect a material increase to our wireless Cost of Goods Sold estimated at $8.0 million to $10.0 million annually.

Consumer Segment Adjusted EBITDA
The Adjusted EBITDA increase is primarily due to increased revenue as described above in "Consumer Segment Revenues.” The increase was partially offset by increased Cost of Goods Sold as described above in “Consumer Segment Cost of Goods Sold” and an increase in the selling, general and administrative expense that was allocated to our Consumer segment. The increase in allocated selling, general and administrative expense is due primarily to an increase in the 2009 segment margin upon which the selling, general and administrative expense allocation is based and an increase in consolidated selling, general and administrative expense.

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.

Network Access Segment Overview
Network access segment revenue represented 16% of 2010 consolidated revenues. The components of Network Access segment revenue are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 29,032       49,837       (42 %)
Data
    61,494       63,862       (4 %)
Wireless
    16,701       8,373       99 %
Total Network Access segment revenue
  $ 107,227       122,072       (12 %)

Network Access segment Cost of Goods Sold represented 12% of 2010 consolidated Cost of Goods Sold. The components of Network Access segment Cost of Goods Sold are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 15,383       16,522       (7 %)
Data
    8,234       9,444       (13 %)
Wireless
    1,413       1,287       10 %
Total Network Access segment Cost of Goods Sold
  $ 25,030       27,253       (8 %)

Network Access segment Adjusted EBITDA, representing 23% of 2010 consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, is as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
 
42

 

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Network Access segment Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 50,259       57,563       (13 %)

Selected key performance indicators for our Network Access segment follow:

 
   
 
December 31,
 
Percentage
 
 
   
 
2010 
 
2009 
 
Change
 
 
 Voice:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long-distance minutes carried (in millions)
 
 785.4 
 
 840.0 
 
(7%)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 Data:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Internet service provider access lines in service
 
 1,700 
 
 1,700 
 
0%
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
An Internet service provider access line is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network

Network Access Segment Revenues
The decrease in voice revenue is due to decreases in our average rate per minute on billable minutes carried for our common carrier customers and the transition of voice traffic to dedicated networks. Voice revenue continues to decline as expected due to increased competition in the Network Access business. The increased competition will continue to compress the rates we may charge our customers and, therefore, we expect a continued decline in Network Access segment voice revenue.  The decrease is partially offset by a $3.4 million increase from growth of services sold.

The decrease in data revenue is primarily due to decreased rates for capacity purchased by our common carrier customers.

The increase in wireless revenue is due to increased roaming revenue in 2010 primarily due to improved coverage and new roaming partners.

Network Access Segment Cost of Goods Sold
The decrease in voice Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to decreased long-distance minutes carried, the movement of more traffic onto our network in lieu of carrying traffic on third party networks, and a $771,000 favorable adjustment based upon refunds from several vendors.  In the course of business we estimate unbilled long-distance services Cost of Goods Sold based upon minutes of use processed through our network and established rates.  Such estimates are revised when subsequent billings are received, payments are made, billing matters are researched and resolved, tariffed billing periods lapse, or when disputed charges are resolved.  The decreases were partially offset by a $2.3 million increase from growth of services sold.

The decrease in data Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to the transition of traffic to our own facilities from leased facilities and a $724,000 favorable adjustment based upon refunds from several vendors.  In the course of business we estimate unbilled data services Cost of Goods Sold based upon minutes of use processed through our network and established rates.  Such estimates are revised when subsequent billings are received, payments are made, billing matters are researched and resolved, tariffed billing periods lapse, or when disputed charges are resolved.  The decreases were partially offset by the absence of a $585,000 favorable adjustment in 2009 resulting from a refund of fiber repair costs.  The fiber repair costs were originally recognized in the first quarter of 2008.  Due to the uncertainty surrounding the refund of the fiber repair costs, we deferred recognition until collection of the refund was reasonably assured.

Network Access Segment Adjusted EBITDA
The Adjusted EBITDA decrease is primarily due to decreased revenue as described in “Network Access Segment Revenues.”  This decrease is partially off-set by decreased Cost of Goods Sold as described in “Network Access Segment Cost of Goods Sold” and a decrease in the selling, general and administrative expense that was allocated to our Network Access segment primarily due to a decrease in the 2009 segment margin upon which the selling, general and administrative expense allocation is based.

 
43

 
See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.

Commercial Segment Overview
Commercial segment revenue represented 20% of 2010 consolidated revenues. Commercial segment data revenue is comprised of monthly recurring charges for data services and charges billed on a time and materials basis largely for personnel providing on-site customer support.  This latter category can vary significantly based on project activity.  The components of Commercial segment revenue are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 31,720       30,830       3 %
Video
    11,178       9,175       22 %
Data
    76,823       63,383       21 %
Wireless
    8,737       6,747       29 %
Total Commercial segment revenue
  $ 128,458       110,135       17 %

Commercial segment Cost of Goods Sold represented 29% of 2010 consolidated Cost of Goods Sold. The components of Commercial segment Cost of Goods Sold are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 15,212       18,563       (18 %)
Video
    2,140       1,956       9 %
Data
    38,586       28,661       35 %
Wireless
    3,947       3,065       29 %
Total Commercial segment Cost of Goods Sold
  $ 59,885       52,245       15 %

Commercial segment Adjusted EBITDA, representing 14% of 2010 consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
Commercial segment Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 30,871       23,174       33 %

Selected key performance indicators for our Commercial segment follow:

   
December 31,
   
Percentage
 
   
2010
   
2009
   
Change
 
 Voice:
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
Long-distance subscribers
    9,100       9,500       (4 %)
Total local access lines in service
    48,300       47,700       1 %
Local access lines in service on GCI facilities
    21,200       19,600       8 %
Long-distance minutes carried (in millions)
    116.0       123.2       (6 %)
 
                       
 Data:
                       
Cable modem subscribers
    10,700       10,500       2 %
 
                       
 Wireless:
                       
Wireless lines in service
    13,800       10,300       34 %
                         
A long-distance customer is defined as a customer account that is invoiced a monthly long-distance plan fee or has made a long-distance call during the month.
 
A local access line in service is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network.
 
A cable modem subscriber is defined by the purchase of cable modem service regardless of the level of service purchased. If one entity purchases multiple cable modem service access points, each access point is counted as a subscriber.
 
A wireless line in service is defined as a revenue generating wireless device.
 
   

 
 
44

 
Commercial Segment Revenues
The increase in voice revenue is primarily due to the following:

·  
A $799,000 or 32% increase in USAC support. We accrue estimated USF high cost support revenue quarterly and adjust our revenue as we obtain new information that changes the variables used to calculate our estimate.  The increase in USF high cost support is primarily due to changes in the variables used to calculate our estimate and an increase in the number of local subscribers, and
·  
A $493,000 or 3% increase in local plan fee revenue due to an increase in the number of lines in service.

These increases in voice revenue were partially offset by an $822,000 or 6% decrease in long-distance plan fee revenue due to a decrease in subscribers and minutes carried.

The increase in video revenue is primarily due to an increase in sales of cable advertising services due to state and federal political advertising and the return of seasonal tourism advertising which was negatively affected in 2009 by the general economic slowdown.

The increase in data revenue is primarily due to a $12.1 million or 42% increase in managed services project revenue due to special project work.

The increase in wireless revenue is primarily due to the following:

·  
A $995,000 or 90% increase in USAC support.  We accrue estimated USF high cost support revenue quarterly and adjust our revenue as we obtain new information that changes the variables used to calculate our estimate.  The increase in USF high cost support is primarily due to changes in the variables used to calculate our estimate and an increase in the number of wireless subscribers; and
·  
An $812,000 or 54% increase in plan fee revenue mainly due to an increase in the number of wireless subscribers.

Commercial Segment Cost of Goods Sold
The decrease in voice Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to the following:

·  
A $1.2 million cost saving from increased deployment of local access services lines on our own facilities during 2010,
·  
A $1.0 million favorable adjustment based upon refunds from several vendors.  In the course of business we estimate unbilled long-distance services Cost of Goods Sold based upon minutes of use processed through our network and established rates.  Such estimates are revised when subsequent billings are received, payments are made, billing matters are researched and resolved, tariffed billing periods lapse, or when disputed charges are resolved; and
·  
A $700,000 or 7% decrease in long-distance costs related to the decrease in minutes carried.

The increase in data Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to an $11.1 million or 57% increase in managed services project Cost of Goods Sold related to the increased revenue described above in “Commercial Segment Revenues.”

The increase in wireless Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to increased costs for wireless handset equipment sales associated with the increased number of wireless subscribers.

 
45

 
Commercial Segment Adjusted EBITDA
The Adjusted EBITDA increase was primarily due to increased revenue as described in “Commercial Segment Revenues.” This increase was partially off-set by increased Cost of Goods Sold as described in “Commercial Segment Cost of Goods Sold,” and an increase in the selling, general and administrative expense that was allocated to our Commercial segment primarily due to an increase in consolidated selling, general and administrative expense.

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.

Managed Broadband Segment Overview
Managed Broadband segment revenue, Cost of Goods sold and Adjusted EBITDA represented 8%, 7% and 8% of 2010 consolidated revenues, Cost of Goods Sold and Adjusted EBITDA, respectively.

Managed Broadband Segment Revenues
Managed Broadband segment revenue, which includes data products only, increased 11% to $50.0 million in 2010 as compared to 2009. The increase is primarily due to:

·  
A $3.8 million or 9% increase in monthly contract revenue due to increased data network capacity purchased by our ConnectMD® and SchoolAccess® customers, and
·  
A $1.2 million or 143% increase in product sales to our customers.

These increases are partially off-set by the $1.7 million in denied funding from the USAC for one ConnectMD® customer for the funding year July 2008 to June 2009. We received the funding commitment letter, which outlined the denied portion, in the second quarter of 2010.  This denial is under appeal to the FCC.

Managed Broadband Segment Cost of Goods Sold
Managed Broadband segment Cost of Goods Sold increased from $11.1 million in 2009 to $14.0 million in 2010.  The increase is primarily due to the increase in data network capacity described above in “Managed Broadband Segment Revenues.”  In addition, the product sales described above in “Managed Broadband Segment Revenues” resulted in a $756,000 or 99% increase in product sales Cost of Goods Sold.

Managed Broadband Segment Adjusted EBITDA
Managed Broadband segment Adjusted EBITDA decreased 1% to $19.3 million in 2010 primarily due to an increase in the Cost of Goods Sold as described above in “Managed Broadband Segment Cost of Goods Sold,” and an increase in the selling, general and administrative expense that was allocated to our Managed Broadband segment primarily due to an increase in the consolidated selling, general and administrative expense.  These increases were partially off-set by an increase in revenue as described above in "Managed Broadband Segment Revenues."

See note 10 in the "Condensed Notes to Interim Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part I of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income before income tax expense.

Regulated Operations Segment Overview
Regulated Operations segment revenue, Cost of Goods Sold and Adjusted EBITDA represented 3%, 2% and 3% of 2010 consolidated revenues, Cost of Goods Sold and Adjusted EBITDA, respectively.

A selected key performance indicator for our Regulated Operations segment follows:

 
   
 
December 31,
 
Percentage
 
 
   
 
2010 
 
2009 
 
Change
 
 
 Voice:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total local access lines in service on GCI facilities
 
 10,000 
 
 11,100 
 
(10%)
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A local access line in service is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network.
 

 
46

 
Regulated Operations Segment Revenues
Regulated Operations segment revenues decreased from $23.8 million in 2009 to $22.7 million in 2010 primarily due to projected lower levels of eligible cost recovery resulting from changes in lines in service, traffic sensitive activity levels and reserve adjustments.

Regulated Operations Segment Cost of Goods Sold
Regulated Operations segment Cost of Goods Sold decreased from $6.1 million in 2009 to $4.4 million in 2010 primarily due to a change in allocation of network maintenance costs which resulted in a decrease to our Regulated Operations segment and an increase to our Consumer, Network Access, Commercial and Managed Broadband segments.

Regulated Operations Segment Adjusted EBITDA
Regulated Operations segment Adjusted EBITDA increased 6% to $6.4 million in 2010.

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part I of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income before income tax expense.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses
Selling, general and administrative expenses increased $16.3 million to $228.8 million in 2010 primarily due to the following:

·  
A $4.7 million increase in health benefit costs,
·  
A $4.5 million increase in labor costs,
·  
A $3.8 million increase in share-based compensation expense primarily due to the absence of a $2.4 million reversal of expense in 2009.  The expense had been properly recognized in previous periods for certain performance-based stock options and restricted stock awards but in the third quarter of 2009 we determined they were not expected to vest,
·  
$2.0 million in costs, including workers compensation expense, related to an accident involving our company-owned aircraft in August 2010, and
·  
A $913,000 increase in our company-wide success sharing bonus accrual.

The increases were partially off-set by the following:

·  
A $2.4 million decrease in sales expense,
·  
The absence of $1.2 million in costs for the conversion of our customers’ wireless phones to our facilities in 2009, and
·  
The absence of a $640,000 contribution expense recognized upon the gift of an IRU to the University of Alaska that was recorded in 2009.

As a percentage of total revenues, selling, general and administrative expenses decreased to 35% in 2010 from 36% in 2009, primarily due to increasing revenues.

Depreciation and Amortization Expense
Depreciation and amortization expense increased $2.8 million to $126.1 million in 2010 primarily due to new assets placed in service in 2010 partially offset by assets which became fully depreciated during 2010.

Other Expense, Net
Other expense, net of other income, increased 19% to $70.1 million in 2010 primarily due to a $13.2 million increase in interest expense to $69.4 million in 2010.  The interest expense increase is due to the issuance of the 2019 Notes in November 2009, which have a higher interest rate than the interest rate paid on our amended Senior Credit Facility, and a higher average outstanding debt balance during 2010 than 2009.  The proceeds from the issuance of the 2019 Notes were primarily used to repay and retire the outstanding amount due on our amended Senior Credit Facility.

Income Tax Expense
Income tax expense totaled $9.5 million and $3.9 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively. Our effective income tax rate decreased from 53% in 2009 to 51% in 2010.

 
47

 
At December 31, 2010, we have tax net operating loss carryforwards of $226.4 million that will begin expiring in 2011 if not utilized, and alternative minimum tax credit carryforwards of $1.9 million available to offset regular income taxes payable in future years.

We have recorded deferred tax assets of $89.0 million associated with income tax net operating losses that were generated from 1996 to 2010 and that expire from 2011 to 2030, and with charitable contributions that were converted to net operating losses in 2004 through 2010, and that expire in 2024 through 2030, respectively.

Tax benefits associated with recorded deferred tax assets are considered to be more likely than not realizable through future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences and future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards. The amount of deferred tax asset considered realizable, however, could be reduced if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced which would result in additional income tax expense. We estimate that our effective annual income tax rate for financial statement purposes will be 50% to 54% in the year ended December 31, 2011, primarily due to the large amount of permanent differences in 2011 as compared to our net income before income tax expense.

Year Ended December 31, 2009 (“2009”) Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2008 (“2008”)
 
Overview of Revenues and Cost of Goods Sold
 
Total revenues increased 4% from $575.4 million in 2008 to $595.8 million in 2009.  Revenue increases in our Consumer, Managed Broadband and Regulated Operations segments were partially off-set by decreases in our Network Access and Commercial segments.  See the discussion below for more information by segment.

Total Cost of Goods Sold decreased 5% from $203.1 million in 2008 to $193.7 million in 2009. Cost of Goods Sold increases in our Consumer, Managed Broadband and Regulated Operations segments were partially off-set by decreases in our Network Access and Commercial segments.  See the discussion below for more information by segment.
 
Consumer Segment Overview
 
Consumer segment revenue represented 49% of 2009 consolidated revenues. The components of Consumer segment revenue are as follow (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 52,654       47,042       12 %
Video
    110,986       105,238       5 %
Data
    50,327       42,692       18 %
Wireless
    80,958       60,660       33 %
Total Consumer segment revenue
  $ 294,925       255,632       15 %

Consumer segment Cost of Goods Sold represented 50% of 2009 consolidated Cost of Goods Sold. The components of Consumer segment Cost of Goods Sold are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 14,952       18,121       (17 %)
Video
    45,350       40,279       13 %
Data
    4,367       6,554       (33 %)
Wireless
    32,225       24,899       29 %
Total Consumer segment Cost of Goods Sold
  $ 96,894       89,853       8 %

Consumer segment adjusted EBITDA, representing 45% of 2009 consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
48

 


 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Consumer segment Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 86,587       58,949       47 %

Selected key performance indicators for our Consumer segment follow:

   
December 31,
   
Percentage
 
   
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
 Voice:
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
Long-distance subscribers
    90,500       88,600       2 %
Long-distance minutes carried (in millions)
    114.7       128.6       (11 %)
Total local access lines in service
    84,200       80,700       4 %
Local access lines in service on GCI facilities
    75,200       68,700       9 %
 Video:
                       
Basic subscribers
    130,500       132,500       (2 %)
Digital programming tier subscribers
    79,600       71,900       11 %
HD/DVR converter boxes
    81,500       67,800       20 %
Homes passed
    232,400       229,300       1 %
Average monthly gross revenue per subscriber
  $ 70.36     $ 67.40       4 %
 Data:
                       
Cable modem subscribers
    100,200       94,400       6 %
 Wireless:
                       
Wireless lines in service
    115,100       88,700       30 %
Average monthly gross revenue per subscriber
  $ 61.54     $ 57.77       7 %
                         
A long-distance customer is defined as a customer account that is invoiced a monthly long-distance plan fee or has made a long-distance call during the month.
 
A local access line in service is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network.
 
A basic cable subscriber is defined as one basic tier of service delivered to an address or separate subunits thereof regardless of the number of outlets purchased. On January 1, 2009, our Consumer segment transferred 2,900 basic cable subscribers to our Commercial segment.
 
A digital programming tier subscriber is defined as one digital programming tier of service delivered to an address or separate subunits thereof regardless of the number of outlets or digital programming tiers purchased. Digital programming tier subscribers are a subset of basic subscribers.
 
A HD/DVR converter box is defined as one box rented by a digital programming or basic tier subscriber. A digital programming or basic tier subscriber is not required to rent an HD/DVR converter box to receive service.
 
Year-to-date average monthly consumer video revenues divided by the average of consumer video basic subscribers at the beginning and end of each month in the period.
 
A cable modem subscriber is defined by the purchase of cable modem service regardless of the level of service purchased. If one entity purchases multiple cable modem service access points, each access point is counted as a subscriber. Cable modem subscribers may also be video basic subscribers though basic cable service is not required to receive cable modem service.
 
A wireless line in service is defined as a revenue generating wireless device.
 
Year-to-date average monthly consumer wireless revenues divided by the average of consumer wireless subscribers at the beginning and end of each month in the period.
 
 
Consumer Segment Revenues
The increase in voice revenue is primarily due to a $3.7 million or 82% increase in recognized support from the USAC and an increase in monthly recurring local service fee revenue.  The increase in USAC support is primarily due to an FCC order issued in March 2009, the result of which provided uncapped support for all lines served by competitive ETCs for tribal lands or Alaska Native regions retroactive to August 2008.  The
 
 
49

 
issuance of this order allowed us to recognize in 2009 $674,000 in additional USAC support for services provided from August 2008 to December 2008 that is included in the revenue increase discussed above, and the removal of the cap allowed us to increase the USAC support revenue that we recognized in 2009.

The increase in monthly recurring local service fee revenue is due to increased subscribers.  The increase in voice revenue was partially offset by decreased long-distance billable minutes carried.

The increase in video revenue is primarily due to the following:

·  
A 4% increase in programming services revenue to $88.1 million in 2009 primarily resulting from an increase in digital programming tier subscribers in 2009 and a rate increase on certain cable service offerings beginning in August 2009, and
·  
A 12% increase in equipment rental revenue to $21.6 million in 2009 primarily resulting from our customers’ increased use of our HD/DVR converter boxes.

The increase in data revenue is primarily due to a 19% increase in cable modem revenue to $43.4 million due to increased subscribers and their selection of more value-added features.

The increase in wireless revenue is primarily due to the following:

·  
An $11.9 million or 162% increase in recognized support from the USAC primarily due to the following:
o  
Increased wireless subscribers in areas that receive USAC support,
o  
Recognition of $3.1 million to be received from the USAC for interstate common line support for a new local access area for which we received ETC status in May 2009 of which $1.7 million was related to services provided during 2008.  Collectability was not reasonably assured until we were awarded ETC status, therefore, we deferred revenue recognition until such status was confirmed,
o  
Recognition of $1.1 million upon a change in our estimate of support to be received from the USAC for interstate common line support of which $77,000 was related to 2008.  We accrue estimated program revenue quarterly and adjust our revenue as we obtain new information that changes the variables used to calculate our estimate, and
o  
The FCC order issued in March 2009, the result of which provides uncapped support for all lines served by competitive ETCs for tribal lands or Alaska Native regions retroactive to August 2008.  The issuance of this order allowed us to recognize $810,000 in additional USAC support from August 2008 to December 2008 in 2009 that is included in the revenue increase discussed above.
·  
An increase in the number of wireless subscribers.

The increase in wireless revenue was partially off-set by receipt of $2.8 million in July 2008 from the USAC for retroactive interstate common line support at Alaska DigiTel for which revenue was recognized in 2008.
 
Consumer Segment Cost of Goods Sold
 
The decrease in voice Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to cost savings resulting from the increased deployment of local access services DLPS lines on our own facilities during 2009 and decreased voice minutes carried.

The video Cost of Goods Sold increase is primarily due to increased channels offered to our subscribers, increased rates paid to programmers, increased costs associated with delivery of digital services offered over our HD/DVR converter boxes due to the increased number of boxes in service, an increase in digital programming tier subscribers, and the recognition of a $594,000 charge in 2009 to settle a billing issue with a cable programmer.

The decrease in data Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to the transition of traffic to our own facilities from leased facilities and the addition of more peering partners for Internet traffic, which was partially offset by an increase in costs due to an increased number of cable modem subscribers.

The increase in wireless Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to increased costs for wireless handset equipment sales associated with the increased number of wireless subscribers and the inclusion in certain 2009
 
 
50

 
promotions of premium wireless handsets which have higher costs.  The increase was partially offset by decreased costs due to the June 4, 2008 implementation of the new distribution agreement with AT&T Mobility.

AT&T Mobility acquired Dobson, including its Alaska properties, on November 15, 2007. In December 2007 we signed an agreement with AT&T Mobility that provided for an orderly transition of our wireless customers from the Dobson/AT&T network in Alaska to our wireless facilities that we began building in 2008 and substantially completed in 2010.  The agreement required our customers to be on our wireless network by June 30, 2009, but allowed our customers to use the AT&T Mobility network for roaming during the transition period.  We started transitioning our customers to our wireless facilities in November 2008.  We successfully migrated all but 200 customers from the AT&T Mobility network to our network by the required transition date of June 30, 2009.  The four-year transition period, which expires June 30, 2012, provides us adequate time to replace the Dobson/AT&T network in Alaska with our own wireless facilities. Under the agreement, AT&T Mobility’s obligation to purchase network services from us terminated as of July 1, 2008. AT&T Mobility provided us with a large block of wireless network usage at no charge to facilitate the transition of our customers to our facilities.  We will pay for usage in excess of that base transitional amount.  Under the previous agreement with Dobson, our margin was fixed.  Under the new agreement with AT&T Mobility, we will pay for usage in excess of the block of no charge minutes on a per minute basis.  The block of wireless network usage at no charge has substantially reduced our wireless product Cost of Goods Sold beginning June 4, 2008 through December 31, 2009.  We expect this block of minutes to expire in the first half of 2012 at which time we expect a material increase to our wireless Cost of Goods Sold estimated at $8.0 million to $10.0 million annually.

Consumer Segment Adjusted EBITDA
The increase in Adjusted EBITDA is primarily due to increased revenue as described above in "Consumer Segment Revenues," which was partially offset by increased Cost of Goods Sold as described above in "Consumer Segment Cost of Goods Sold" and an increase in the selling, general and administrative expense that was allocated to our Consumer segment primarily due to an increase in the 2008 segment margin upon which the allocation is based.

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.
 
Network Access Segment Overview
 
Network access segment revenue represented 21% of 2009 consolidated revenues. The components of Network Access segment revenue are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 49,837       79,744       (38 %)
Data
    63,862       71,414       (11 %)
Wireless
    8,373       2,663       214 %
Total Network Access segment revenue
  $ 122,072       153,821       (21 %)

Network Access segment Cost of Goods Sold represented 14% of 2009 consolidated Cost of Goods Sold. The components of Network Access segment Cost of Goods Sold are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 16,522       27,149       (39 %)
Data
    9,444       11,539       (18 %)
Wireless
    1,287       1,638       (21 %)
Total Network Access segment Cost of Goods Sold
  $ 27,253       40,326       (32 %)

Network Access segment Adjusted EBITDA, representing 30% of 2009 consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, is as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
 
51

 

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Network Access segment Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 57,563       73,647       (22 %)

Selected key performance indicators for our Network Access segment follow:

   
December 31,
   
Percentage
 
   
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
 Voice:
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
Long-distance minutes carried (in millions)
    840       1,094       (23 %)
 
                       
 Data:
                       
Total Internet service provider access lines in service
    1,700       1,800       (6 %)
                         
An Internet service provider access line is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network
 

Network Access Segment Revenues
The decrease in voice revenue is due in part to the June 4, 2008 implementation of the new distribution agreement with AT&T Mobility as described in "Part II – Item VII – Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Consumer Segment Cost of Goods Sold” for 2009 compared to 2008.  The voice revenue decrease also resulted from a decrease in our average rate per minute on billable minutes carried for our common carrier customers and the transition of voice traffic to dedicated networks.  The average rate per minute decrease is primarily due to a change in the composition of traffic and a 3.0% interstate rate decrease mandated by federal law.

The decrease in data revenue is primarily due to a change in the composition of traffic resulting in IRU operating leases and service agreements replacing data network service agreements.

The increase in wireless revenue is primarily due to increased roaming revenue in 2009 primarily due to the construction of our state-wide GSM network starting in 2008 and the 2008 expansion of our CDMA network.
 
Network Access Segment Cost of Goods Sold
 
The decrease in voice Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to decreased long-distance minutes carried and the movement of more traffic onto our network in lieu of carrying traffic on third party networks.

The decrease in data Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to a change in the composition of traffic resulting in IRU operating leases and service agreements replacing data network service agreements and a $585,000 favorable adjustment resulting from a refund of fiber repair costs.  The fiber repair costs were originally recognized in the first quarter of 2008.  Due to the uncertainty surrounding the recovery of the fiber repair costs, we deferred recognition until collection of the refund was reasonably assured.

Network Access Segment Adjusted EBITDA
The Adjusted EBITDA decrease is primarily due to decreased revenue as described above in "Network Access Segment Revenues," which is partially off-set by decreased Cost of Goods Sold as described above in “Network Access Segment Cost of Goods Sold” and a decrease in the selling, general and administrative expense that was allocated to our Network Access segment primarily due to a decrease in the 2008 segment margin upon which the allocation is based.

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.
 
 
52

 
Commercial Segment Overview
 
Commercial segment revenue represented 18% of 2009 consolidated revenues.  Commercial segment data revenue is comprised of monthly recurring charges for data services and charges billed on a time and materials basis largely for personnel providing on-site customer support.  This latter category can vary significantly based on project activity.  The components of Commercial segment revenue are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 30,830       29,398       5 %
Video
    9,175       9,604       (4 %)
Data
    63,383       70,068       (10 %)
Wireless
    6,747       5,590       21 %
Total Commercial segment revenue
  $ 110,135       114,660       (4 %)

Commercial segment Cost of Goods Sold represented 27% of 2009 consolidated Cost of Goods Sold. The components of Commercial segment Cost of Goods Sold are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Voice
  $ 18,563       19,581       (5 %)
Video
    1,956       1,551       26 %
Data
    28,661       34,391       (17 %)
Wireless
    3,065       3,957       (23 %)
Total Commercial segment Cost of Goods Sold
  $ 52,245       59,480       (12 %)

Commercial segment Adjusted EBITDA, representing 12% of 2009 consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Percentage
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
Commercial segment Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 23,174       20,710       12 %

Selected key performance indicators for our Commercial segment follow:

   
December 31,
   
Percentage
 
   
2009
   
2008
   
Change
 
 Voice:
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
Long-distance subscribers
    9,500       9,700       (2 %)
Total local access lines in service
    47,700       46,200       3 %
Local access lines in service on GCI facilities
    19,600       18,700       5 %
Long-distance minutes carried (in millions)
    123.2       129.5       (5 %)
 
                       
 Data:
                       
Cable modem subscribers
    10,500       8,900       18 %
 
                       
 Wireless:
                       
Wireless lines in service
    10,300       7,600       36 %
A long-distance subscriber is defined as a customer account that is invoiced a monthly long-distance plan fee or has made a long-distance call during the month.
 
A local access line in service is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network.
 
A cable modem subscriber is defined by the purchase of cable modem service regardless of the level of service purchased. If one entity purchases multiple cable modem service access points, each access point is counted as a subscriber.
 
A wireless line in service is defined as a revenue generating wireless device.
 

 
 
53

 
Commercial Segment Revenues
The increase in voice revenue is primarily due to increased local access lines in service and a $1.3 million or 109% increase in recognized support from the USAC primarily due to increased local subscribers and the FCC order issued in March 2009, the result of which provides uncapped support for all lines served by competitive ETCs for tribal lands or Alaska Native regions retroactive to August 2008.  The issuance of this order allowed us to recognize $386,000 in additional USAC support from August 2008 to December 2008 in 2009 that is included in the revenue increase discussed above.  The increase in voice revenue was partially off-set by decreased long-distance subscribers and decreased voice minutes carried.

The decrease in data revenue is primarily due to a $7.2 million or 19% decrease in managed services project revenue partially off-set by a $1.0 million or 6% increase in Internet revenue primarily due to an increase in cable modem subscribers.

The increase in wireless revenue is primarily due to an increase in the number of wireless subscribers.
 
Commercial Segment Cost of Goods Sold
 
The decrease in voice Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to cost savings resulting from an increase in local access lines in service on our own facilities during 2009 and decreased long-distance billable minutes carried.

The decrease in data Cost of Goods Sold is primarily due to a $5.7 million or 22% decrease in managed services project Cost of Goods Sold.

Commercial Segment Adjusted EBITDA
The Adjusted EBITDA increase was primarily due to decreased Cost of Goods Sold as described above in “Commercial Segment Cost of Goods Sold” that was partially offset by a decrease in revenue as described above in "Commercial Segment Revenues."

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.

Managed Broadband Segment Overview
Managed Broadband segment revenue, Cost of Goods Sold and adjusted EBITDA represented 8%, 6% and 10% of 2009 consolidated revenues, Cost of Goods Sold and adjusted EBITDA, respectively.
 
Managed Broadband Segment Revenues
 
Managed Broadband segment revenue, which includes data products only, increased 21% to $44.9 million in 2009 as compared to 2008. The increase is primarily due to increased circuits purchased by our ConnectMD® customers and a $5.3 million increase from our acquisition of Unicom effective June 1, 2008.  The increase is partially off-set by a decrease in revenue associated with product sales.
 
Managed Broadband Segment Cost of Goods Sold
 
Managed Broadband segment Cost of Goods Sold increased from $10.3 million in 2008 to $11.1 million in 2009 primarily due to an increase in costs associated with the increased revenue partially off-set by a decrease in costs associated with product sales.

Managed Broadband Segment Adjusted EBITDA
Managed Broadband segment Adjusted EBITDA increased 37% to $19.6 million in 2009 primarily due to an increase in revenue as described above in "Managed Broadband Segment Revenues."

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.
 
 
54

 
Regulated Operations Segment Overview
 
Regulated Operations segment revenue, Cost of Goods Sold and Adjusted EBITDA represented 4%, 3% and 3% of 2009 consolidated revenues, Cost of Goods Sold and Adjusted EBITDA, respectively.

A selected key performance indicator for our Regulated Operations segment follows:

 
   
 
December 31,
 
Percentage
 
 
   
 
2009 
 
2008 
 
Change
 
 
 Voice:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total local access lines in service
 
 11,100 
 
 12,100 
 
(8%)
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A local access line in service is defined as a revenue generating circuit or channel connecting a customer to the public switched telephone network.
 
Regulated Operations Segment Revenues
Regulated Operations segment revenues increased from $14.3 million in 2008 to $23.8 million in 2009 primarily due to our acquisition of UUI effective June 1, 2008.
 
Regulated Operations Segment Cost of Goods Sold
 
Regulated Operations segment Cost of Goods Sold increased from $3.1 million in 2008 to $6.1 million in 2009 primarily due to our acquisition of UUI effective June 1, 2008.

Regulated Operations Segment Adjusted EBITDA
Regulated Operations segment Adjusted EBITDA was $6.0 million in 2009 and $3.6 million in 2008 primarily due to our acquisition of UUI effective June 1, 2008.

See note 10 in the "Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements" included in Part II of this annual report on Form 10-K for a reconciliation of consolidated Adjusted EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to consolidated income (loss) before income taxes.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses
Selling, general and administrative expenses increased from $210.3 million in 2008 to $212.7 million in 2009 primarily due to the following:
·  
A $4.5 million increase in labor costs,
·  
$4.1 million in additional expense resulting from our June 1, 2008, acquisition of UUI and Unicom,
·  
A $1.4 million increase in our company-wide success sharing bonus accrual in 2009,
·  
$1.1 million in additional expense incurred in 2009 for the conversion of our customers' wireless phones to our facilities, and
·  
A $1.1 million increase in lease related expense.

The increases were partially off-set by the following:
·  
A $4.9 million decrease in contract labor costs,
·  
A $4.5 million decrease in share-based compensation expense primarily due to the reversal of expense properly recognized in previous periods for certain performance-based stock options and restricted stock awards that were ultimately not expected to vest, and
·  
The absence of $1.8 million to terminate a management agreement that was paid in 2008 upon the acquisition of our non-controlling interest in Alaska DigiTel.

As a percentage of total revenues, selling, general and administrative expenses decreased to 36% in 2009 from 37% in 2008, primarily due to increasing revenue.


 
55

 

Depreciation and Amortization Expense
Depreciation and amortization expense increased 8% to $123.4 million in 2009. The increase is primarily due to our $322.3 million investment in equipment and facilities placed into service during 2008 for which a full year of depreciation was recorded in 2009, and the $182.4 million investment in equipment and facilities placed into service during the year ended December 31, 2009 for which a partial year of depreciation was recorded in 2009.  The increase is partially off-set by a $12.0 million depreciation charge in 2008 to reflect a reduction of the estimated useful life of certain assets that were decommissioned at the end of 2008.

Other Expense, Net
Other expense, net of other income, increased 17% to $58.7 million in 2009 primarily due to the following:

·  
A $3.7 million decrease in capitalized interest in 2009 compared to 2008,
·  
$2.7 million in additional interest expense resulting from the Galaxy 18 capital lease commencing in May 2008, and
·  
A $1.9 million increase in interest expense resulting from the 2009 write-off of the original issue discount on our Senior Credit Facility.

The interest expense increase is partially off-set by the absence of a $921,000 loss that was recorded in 2008 relating to the fair value change on a derivative instrument.

Income Tax Expense
Income tax expense totaled $3.9 million and $1.1 million in 2009 and 2008, respectively. Our effective income tax rate increased from 47% in 2008 to 53% in 2009 primarily due to the increase in the amount of permanent differences in 2009 as compared to our pretax net income before income tax expense.
 
Multiple System Operator (“MSO”) Operating Statistics
 
Our operating statistics include capital expenditures and customer information from our Consumer and Commercial segments which offer services utilizing our cable services’ facilities.

The standardized definition of a customer relationship is the number of customers that receive at least one level of service utilizing our cable service facilities, encompassing voice, video, and data services, without regard to which services customers purchase. At December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 we had 134,400, 133,900 and 133,400 customer relationships, respectively.

The standardized definition of a revenue generating unit is the sum of all primary analog video, digital video, high-speed data, and telephony customers, not counting additional outlets. At December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 we had 350,100, 343,200 and 327,200 revenue generating units, respectively.

Liquidity and Capital Resources
Our principal sources of current liquidity are cash and cash equivalents. We believe, but can provide no assurances, that we will be able to meet our current and long-term liquidity, capital requirements and fixed charges through our cash flows from operating activities, existing cash, cash equivalents, credit facilities, and other external financing and equity sources. Should operating cash flows be insufficient to support additional borrowings and principal payments scheduled under our existing credit facilities, capital expenditures will likely be reduced.

In January 2010 the U.S. Department of Agriculture’s RUS approved our wholly-owned subsidiary, UUI's application for an $88.2 million loan/grant combination to extend terrestrial broadband service for the first time to Bristol Bay and the Yukon-Kuskokwim Delta, an area in Alaska roughly the size of the state of North Dakota. Upon completion, TERRA-SW will be able to serve over 9,000 households and over 700 businesses in the 65 covered communities. The project will also be able to serve numerous public/nonprofit/private community anchor institutions and entities, such as regional health care providers, school districts, and other regional and Alaska Native organizations. The RUS award, consisting of a $44.2 million loan and a $44.0 million grant, will be made under the RUS Broadband Initiatives Program established pursuant to the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act. The award will fund backbone network facilities that we would not otherwise be able to construct within our return-on-investment requirements. UUI began construction on TERRA-SW in 2010 and expects to complete the project in 2012 or earlier if possible.

While our short-term and long-term financing abilities are believed to be adequate as a supplement to internally generated cash flows to fund capital expenditures and acquisitions as opportunities arise, the state of
 
 
56

 
the global financial markets may negatively impact our ability to further access the capital markets in a timely manner and on attractive terms, which may have a negative impact on our ability to grow our business.

We monitor the third-party depository institutions that hold our cash and cash equivalents. Our emphasis is primarily on safety of principal and secondarily on maximizing yield on those funds.

Our net cash flows provided by and (used for) operating, investing and financing activities, as reflected in the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for 2010 and 2009, are summarized as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
2010
   
2009
 
Operating activities
  $ 171,259       100,919  
Investing activities
    (104,722 )     (125,877 )
Financing activities
    (82,243 )     43,830  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
  $ (15,706 )     18,872  

Operating Activities
The increase in cash flows provided by operating activities is due primarily to an increase in operating income in 2010 as compared to 2009, a $12.3 million decrease in accounts receivable that is due to timing of receipt of payments and a $15.0 million contractually required payment made in 2009.

Investing Activities
Net cash used in investing activities consists primarily of cash paid for capital expenditures.  Our most significant recurring investing activity has been capital expenditures and we expect that this will continue in the future.  A significant portion of our capital expenditures is based on the level of customer growth and the technology being deployed.  The decrease in cash flows used for investing activities is due primarily to a decrease in spending for property and equipment, including construction in progress in 2010 partially off-set by the final contingent payment of $5.2 million for the Alaska Wireless acquisition.

Our cash expenditures for property and equipment, including construction in progress, totaled $96.2 million and $121.0 million during the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Our capital expenditures decreased in 2010 primarily due to the decreased pace of our wireless network expansion.  We expect our 2011 expenditures for property and equipment for our core operations, including construction in progress, to total $145.0 million to $155.0 million, depending on available opportunities and the amount of cash flow we generate during 2011, and excluding grant funded capital expenditures related to our TERRA-SW project.

Financing Activities
Net cash used in financing activities consists primarily of our proceeds from borrowings off-set by our debt repayments, payment of debt issuance costs and repurchases of our common stock.  Proceeds from borrowings fluctuate from year to year based on our liquidity needs.  We may use excess cash to make optional repayments on our debt or repurchase our common stock depending on various factors, such as market conditions.  The decrease in cash flows provided by financing activities is due to a decrease in long-term debt borrowings in 2010 compared to 2009 and an increase in repurchases of our common stock in 2010 compared to 2009.

Available Borrowings Under Senior Credit Facility
On January 29, 2010, we replaced our then existing Senior Credit Facility with a new amended Senior Credit Facility that provides a $75.0 million revolving credit facility and that extends the maturity through January 29, 2015.  We have a $75.0 million revolving Senior Credit Facility with a $25.0 million sublimit for letters of credit.  We have $20.0 million in long-term debt and $2.7 million of letters of credit outstanding, which leaves $52.3 million available for borrowing under the revolving credit facility as of December 31, 2010.

On January 18, 2011, we repaid $5.0 million of our outstanding long-term debt.  On February 15, 2011, and February 25, 2011, we borrowed $8.0 million and $5.0 million, respectively, under our amended Senior Credit Facility.  After consideration of these transactions, we have $44.3 million available for borrowing under our revolving credit facility.

 
57

 
Debt Covenants
We are subject to covenants and restrictions set forth in the indentures governing our 2014 and 2019 Notes, amended Senior Credit Facility, RUS loans, and CoBank loans.  We are in compliance with the covenants, and we believe that neither the covenants nor the restrictions in our indentures or loan documents will limit our ability to operate our business.

Share Repurchases
GCI’s Board of Directors has authorized a common stock buyback program for the repurchase of GCI Class A and Class B common stock in order to reduce the outstanding shares of Class A and Class B common stock. Under this program, we are currently authorized to make up to $125.5 million of repurchases as of December 31, 2010. We are authorized to increase our repurchase limit $5.0 million per quarter indefinitely and to use stock option exercise proceeds to repurchase additional shares. If stock repurchases are less than the total approved quarterly amount the difference may be carried forward and applied against future stock repurchases. During the year ended December 31, 2010 we repurchased 8.0 million shares of GCI common stock at a cost of $80.8 million. All of the shares were retired in 2010. The common stock buyback program is expected to continue for an indefinite period dependent on leverage, liquidity, company performance, market conditions and subject to continued oversight by GCI’s Board of Directors. The repurchases have and will continue to comply with the restrictions of SEC Rule 10b-18.

Schedule of Certain Known Contractual Obligations
The following table details future projected payments associated with certain known contractual obligations as of December 31, 2010:
 

 
 
Payments Due by Period
 
 
 
Total
   
Less than 1 Year
   
1 to 3
   
4 to 5
   
More Than 5 Years
 
 
Years
   
Years
 
 
 
(Amounts in thousands)
 
Long-term debt
  $ 786,676       2,516       5,073       344,247       434,840  
Interest on long-term debt
    432,399       62,860       125,123       90,040       154,376  
Capital lease obligations, including interest
    137,130       11,672       23,474       23,513       78,471  
Operating lease commitments
    151,401       21,495       33,924       28,467       67,515  
Purchase obligations
    30,939       18,554       9,143       3,242       -  
Total contractual obligations
  $ 1,538,545       117,097       196,737       489,509       735,202  

Long-term debt listed in the table above includes principal payments on our amended Senior Credit Facility, 2014 and 2019 Notes, Rural Utilities Services debt and CoBank Mortgage note payable.  Interest on the amount outstanding under our amended Senior Credit Facility is based on variable rates. We used the current rate paid on the amended Senior Credit Facility to estimate our future interest payments. Our 2014 Notes require semi-annual interest payments of $11.6 million through February 2014 and our 2019 Notes require semi-annual interest payments of $18.3 million through November 2019. Our Rural Utilities Services debt and CoBank Mortgage note payable have fixed interest rates ranging from 2.0% to 6.8%.  For a discussion of our 2014 and 2019 Notes, amended Senior Credit Facility, Rural Utilities Services debt and CoBank Mortgage note payable see note 6 in the accompanying “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.”
Capital lease obligations include our obligation to lease transponder capacity on Galaxy 18.  For a discussion of our capital and operating leases, see note 12 in the accompanying “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.”

Purchase obligations include the following:

·  
A non-cancelable commitment to purchase hardware and software capable of providing wireless service to small markets in rural Alaska of $4.8 million, and
·  
Cancelable open purchase orders for goods and services for capital projects and normal operations totaling $15.0 million which are not included in our Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2010, because the goods had not been received or the services had not been performed at December 31, 2010.
 
 
 
58

 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
We have not created, and are not party to, any special-purpose or off-balance sheet entities for the purpose of raising capital, incurring debt or operating parts of our business that are not consolidated into our financial statements. We do not have any arrangements or relationships with entities that are not consolidated into our financial statements that are reasonably likely to materially affect our liquidity or the availability of our capital resources.

New Accounting Standards
Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2009-13 addresses the accounting for multiple deliverable arrangements to enable vendors to account for products or services (“deliverables”) separately rather than as a combined unit. Specifically, this guidance amends the criteria in Subtopic 605-25, “Revenue Recognition - Multiple-Element Arrangements”, for separating consideration in multiple-deliverable arrangements. This guidance establishes a selling price hierarchy for determining the selling price of a deliverable, which is based on: (a) vendor-specific objective evidence; (b) third-party evidence; or (c) estimates. This guidance also eliminates the residual method of allocation and requires that arrangement consideration be allocated at the inception of the arrangement to all deliverables using the relative selling price method. In addition, this guidance significantly expands required disclosures related to a vendor's multiple-deliverable revenue arrangements. ASU 2009-13 is effective prospectively for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010. The adoption of ASU 2009-13 is not expected to have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flows.

In December 2010, the FASB issued ASU 2010-28 “Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): When to Perform Step 2 of the Goodwill Impairment Test for Reporting Units with Zero or Negative Carrying Amounts”.  Under ASU 2010-28, if the carrying amount of a reporting unit is zero or negative, an entity must assess whether it is more likely than not that goodwill impairment exists. To make that determination, an entity should consider whether there are adverse qualitative factors that could impact the amount of goodwill, including those listed in ASC 350-20-35-30. As a result of the new guidance, an entity can no longer assert that a reporting unit is not required to perform the second step of the goodwill impairment test because the carrying amount of the reporting unit is zero or negative, despite the existence of qualitative factors that indicate goodwill is more likely than not impaired. ASU 2010-28 is effective for public entities for fiscal years, and for interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2010, with early adoption prohibited.  The adoption of ASU 2009-28 is not expected to have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flows.

In December 2010, the FASB issued the ASU 2010-29 “Business Combinations (Topic 805): Disclosure of Supplementary Pro Forma Information for Business Combinations”.  ASU 2010-29 specifies that if a public entity presents comparative financial statements, the entity should disclose revenue and earnings of the combined entity as though the business combination(s) that occurred during the current year had occurred as of the beginning of the comparable prior annual reporting period only. The amendments in this Update also expand the supplemental pro forma disclosures under Topic 805 to include a description of the nature and amount of material, nonrecurring pro forma adjustments directly attributable to the business combination included in the reported pro forma revenue and earnings. The amended guidance is effective prospectively for business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2010. Early adoption is permitted.  The adoption of ASU 2009-29 is not expected to have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flows.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates
Our accounting and reporting policies comply with GAAP. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions. The financial position and results of operations can be affected by these estimates and assumptions, which are integral to understanding reported results. Critical accounting policies and estimates are those policies and estimates that management believes are the most important to the portrayal of our financial condition and results, and require management to make estimates that are difficult, subjective or complex.  Most accounting policies and
 
 
59

 
estimates are not considered by management to be critical. Several factors are considered in determining whether or not a policy or estimate is critical in the preparation of financial statements. These factors include, among other things, whether the estimates are significant to the financial statements, the nature of the estimates, the ability to readily validate the estimates with other information including third parties or available prices, and sensitivity of the estimates to changes in economic conditions and whether alternative accounting methods may be utilized under GAAP. For all of these policies and estimates, management cautions that future events rarely develop exactly as forecast, and the best estimates routinely require adjustment. Management has discussed the development and the selection of critical accounting policies and estimates with our Audit Committee.

Those policies and estimates considered to be critical for the years ended December 31, 2010 are described below.

Revenue Recognition
The accounting estimates related to revenues from the high cost, rural health and schools and libraries USF programs are dependent on various inputs including current line counts, the most current rates paid to us, and our assessment of the impact of new FCC regulations, the potential outcome of FCC proceedings and the potential outcome of USAC contract reviews.  Some of the inputs are subjective and based on our judgment regarding the outcome of certain variables and are subject to upward or downward adjustment in subsequent periods.  Significant changes to our estimates could result in material changes to the revenues we have recorded and could have a material effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Allowance for Doubtful Receivables
We maintain allowances for doubtful receivables for estimated losses resulting from the inability of our customers to make required payments. We also maintain an allowance for doubtful receivables based on notification that a customer may not have satisfactorily complied with rules necessary to obtain supplemental funding from the USAC for services provided by us under our packaged communications offerings to rural hospitals, health clinics and school districts. We base our estimates on the aging of our accounts receivable balances, financial health of specific customers, regional economic data, changes in our collections process, regulatory requirements, and our customers’ compliance with USAC rules. If the financial condition of our customers were to deteriorate or if they are unable to emerge from reorganization proceedings, resulting in an impairment of their ability to make payments, additional allowances may be required. If their financial condition improves or they emerge successfully from reorganization proceedings, allowances may be reduced. Such allowance changes could have a material effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Impairment and Useful Lives of Intangible Assets
We had $291.5 million of indefinite-lived intangible assets at December 31, 2010 consisting of cable certificates of $191.6 million, goodwill of $73.9 million and wireless licenses of $26.0 million.  Our indefinite-lived intangible assets are tested annually for impairment during the fourth quarter and at any time upon the occurrence of certain events or substantive changes in circumstances.

We are required to determine goodwill impairment using a two-step process.  The first step of the goodwill impairment test is used to identify potential impairment by comparing the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount.  If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied fair value of the reporting unit's goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill.  If the carrying amount of the reporting unit's goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.  The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill that would be recognized in a business combination.

The impairment test for identifiable indefinite-lived intangible assets consists of a comparison of the estimated fair value of the intangible asset with its carrying value.  If the carrying value of the intangible asset exceeds its fair value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.

Our cable certificates are our largest indefinite-lived intangible asset and represent agreements with government entities to construct and operate a cable business.  The value of our cable certificates is derived from the economic benefits we receive from the right to solicit new customers and to market new services.  The amount we have recorded for cable certificates is primarily from cable system acquisitions.  The cable certificates are valued under a direct discounted cash flow method whereby the cash flow associated with existing customers is isolated after appropriate contributory asset charges and then projected based on an analysis of customer churn and attrition characteristics.

 
60

 
Our wireless licenses are from the FCC and give us the right to provide wireless service within a certain geographical area.  The amount we have recorded is from acquisitions of wireless companies and auctions of wireless spectrum.  We use comparable market transactions from recent FCC auctions, as appropriate, and a hypothetical build-up method to value our wireless licenses.

Goodwill represents the excess of cost over fair value of net assets acquired in connection with a business acquisition.  We use an income approach to determine the fair value of our reporting units for purposes of our goodwill impairment test.  In addition, a market-based approach is used where possible to corroborate the fair values determined by the income approach.

The direct discounted cash flow, hypothetical build-up, and income approach valuation methods require us to make estimates and assumptions including projected cash flows, discount rate, customer churn, and customer behaviors and attrition.  These estimates and assumptions could have a significant impact on whether an impairment charge is recognized and the magnitude of any such impairment charge.  Fair value estimates are made at a specific point in time, based on relevant information.  These estimates are subjective in nature and involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment and therefore cannot be determined with precision.  Changes in assumptions could significantly affect the estimates.  Events and factors that may be out of our control that could affect the estimates include such things as competitive forces, customer behaviors, change in revenue growth trends, cost structures and technology, and changes in discount rates, performance compared to peers, material and ongoing negative economic trends, and specific industry or market sector conditions.  Our company is operated and managed with two balance sheets, however, our impairment tests must be performed at the reporting unit level, which requires us to allocate our balance sheet.  These allocations are subjective and require a significant amount of judgment.  Changes to the assumptions and allocation methodologies could significantly change our estimates.  We may also record impairments in the future if there are changes in long-term market conditions, expected future operating results, or laws and regulations that may prevent us from recovering the carrying value of our goodwill, cable certificates, and wireless licenses.

We have allocated all of the goodwill to our reporting units and based on our annual impairment test as of October 31, 2010, the fair value of each reporting unit exceeded the book value by a range between 60% and 853%.  The reporting unit that exceeded the book value by 60% passed the goodwill impairment test by $21.4 million, which we believe is a large margin.  We believe none of our reporting units were close to failing step one of the goodwill impairment test.

Based on our annual impairment test as of October 31, 2010, the fair value of our wireless licenses exceeded the book value by 204%.  The fair value of our cable certificates exceeded the book value by 22% and $42.4 million as of October 31, 2010, which we believe is a large margin.  We believe that none of our indefinite lived intangible assets were close to failing the impairment test.

Accruals for Unbilled Costs
We estimate unbilled long-distance and wireless services Cost of Goods Sold based upon minutes of use carried through our network and established rates. We estimate unbilled costs for new circuits and services, and network changes that result in traffic routing changes or a change in carriers. Carriers that provide service to us regularly make network changes that can lead to new, revised or corrected billings. Such estimates are revised or removed when subsequent billings are received, payments are made, billing matters are researched and resolved, tariffed billing periods lapse, or when disputed charges are resolved. Revisions to previous estimates could either increase or decrease costs in the year in which the estimate is revised which could have a material effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Valuation Allowance for Net Operating Loss Deferred Tax Assets
Our income tax policy provides for deferred income taxes to show the effect of temporary differences between the recognition of revenue and expenses for financial and income tax reporting purposes and between the tax basis of assets and liabilities and their reported amounts in the financial statements.  We have recorded deferred tax assets of $89.0 million associated with income tax net operating losses that were generated from 1996 to 2010, and that primarily expire from 2011 to 2030, and with charitable contributions that were converted to net operating losses in 2004 to 2010, and that expire in 2024 to 2030, respectively.  Pre-acquisition income tax net operating losses associated with acquired companies are subject to additional deductibility limits. We have recorded deferred tax assets of $1.9 million associated
 
 
61

 
with alternative minimum tax credits that do not expire. Significant management judgment is required in developing our provision for income taxes, including the determination of deferred tax assets and liabilities and any valuation allowances that may be required against the deferred tax assets. We have not recorded a valuation allowance on the deferred tax assets as of December 31, 2010 based on management’s belief that future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences and estimated future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards will, more likely than not, be sufficient to realize the benefit of these assets over time. In the event that actual results differ from these estimates or if our historical trends change, we may be required to record a valuation allowance on deferred tax assets, which could have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position or results of operations.

Other significant accounting policies, not involving the same level of measurement uncertainties as those discussed above, are nevertheless important to an understanding of the financial statements. A complete discussion of our significant accounting policies can be found in note 1 in the accompanying “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.”

Regulatory Developments
See “Part I — Item 1 — Business — Regulation” for more information about regulatory developments affecting us.

Inflation
We do not believe that inflation has a significant effect on our operations.

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
We are exposed to various types of market risk in the normal course of business, including the impact of interest rate changes.  We do not hold derivatives for trading purposes.  Our amended Senior Credit Facility carries interest rate risk.  Amounts borrowed under this Agreement bear interest at LIBOR plus 4.00% or less depending upon our Total Leverage Ratio (as defined).  Should the LIBOR rate change, our interest expense will increase or decrease accordingly.  As of December 31, 2010, we have borrowed $20.0 million subject to interest rate risk.  On this amount, each 1% increase in the LIBOR interest rate would result in $200,000 of additional gross interest cost on an annualized basis.

Item 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Our consolidated financial statements are filed under this Item, beginning on page 100. Our supplementary data is filed under Item 7, beginning on page 37.

Item 9. Changes In and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
None.
 
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
We maintain disclosure controls and procedures that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in reports that we file or submit under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (“Exchange Act”) is recorded, processed, summarized, accumulated and communicated to our management, including our principal executive and financial officers, to allow timely decisions regarding required financial disclosure, and reported as specified in the SEC’s rules and forms.  As of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K, we carried out an evaluation of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our “disclosure controls and procedures” (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a - 15(e)) under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer.  Based on that evaluation and as described below under “Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting", our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were not effective as of December 31, 2010.

The certifications attached as Exhibits 31 and 32 to this report should be read in conjunction with the disclosures set forth herein.

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f). Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, we conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting based on the
 
 
62

 
framework in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations (COSO).

Based on our evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, our management concluded that as of December 31, 2010, we did not maintain effective internal control over financial reporting due to a material weakness associated with inadequately designed internal controls in our financial reporting process related to the USF high cost program support revenue accrual.  Our revenue and accounts receivable were corrected prior to the issuance of our consolidated financial statements included in Part I, Item I of our June 30, 2010 quarterly report. The impact of this error was deemed to be immaterial in the prior periods.

Grant Thornton LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm, has issued an audit report on our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, which is included in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Management’s Plan for Remediation of Material Weakness
In the third quarter of 2010, we began remediation of our inadequately designed internal controls in our financial reporting process related to the USF high cost program support revenue accrual by strengthening the design and operation of our controls over the preparation and review of the accrual.  Specifically, we have replaced and reorganized the staff responsible for the USF high cost support revenue to ensure more focus on our USF high cost support revenue.  We have reviewed and, as appropriate, changed the accrual preparation and review process for USF high cost support revenue.  Additionally, the updated process has been documented to ensure consistent application.  Our remediation efforts continued in the fourth quarter of 2010 and will continue in 2011.

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
As described above in the second quarter of 2010 we identified a material weakness associated with inadequately designed internal controls in our financial reporting process related to the USF high cost program support revenue accrual.  We began remediation in the third quarter of 2010 by strengthening the design and operation of our controls over the preparation and review of the USF high cost program support revenue accrual.  Our remediation efforts continued in the fourth quarter of 2010 and will continue in 2011.

On November 4, 2010 we implemented a new cable video billing system.  The implementation of the new system has resulted in certain changes to our processes and procedures affecting internal control over financial reporting during the fourth quarter of 2010.  We have documented processes and tested internal controls over the new billing system.  Due to the complexities of implementing a new billing system we expect to continue to monitor and evaluate the new system for several months.  We believe we have the processes and appropriate management in place to effectively perform the monitoring and evaluation duties.

Except as described above there were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-13(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act) identified in connection with the evaluation of our controls performed during the quarter ended December 31, 2010 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP.  A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Internal control over financial reporting has inherent limitations. Internal control over financial reporting is a process that involves human diligence and compliance and is subject to lapses in judgment and breakdowns resulting from human failures.  Internal control over financial reporting also can be circumvented by collusion or improper management override.  Because of such limitations, there is a risk that material
 
 
63

 
misstatements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis by internal control over financial reporting.  However, these inherent limitations are known features of the financial reporting process.  Therefore, it is possible to design into the process safeguards to reduce, though not eliminate, this risk.

We may enhance, modify, and supplement internal controls and disclosure controls and procedures based on experience.

Item 9B. Other Information
None.
 

Part III

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Identification

As of December 31, 2010, our board consisted of eight director positions, divided into three classes of directors serving staggered three-year terms.

A director on our board is elected at an annual meeting of shareholders and serves until the earlier of his or her resignation or removal, or his or her successor is elected and qualified.  Our executive officers generally are appointed at our board's first meeting after each annual meeting of shareholders and serve at the discretion of the board.

The following table sets forth certain information about our directors and executive officers as of December 31, 2010:

Name
Age
Position
Stephen M. Brett1
70
Chairman, Director
 
Ronald A. Duncan1
58
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
 
John M. Lowber
61
 
Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer, Secretary, and Treasurer
G. Wilson Hughes
65
 
Executive Vice President and General Manager
William C. Behnke
53
 
Senior Vice President
Martin E. Cary
46
 
Vice President – General Manager, Managed Broadband Services
Gregory F. Chapados
53
 
Senior Vice President
Richard P. Dowling
67
 
Senior Vice President
Paul E. Landes
52
 
Senior Vice President and General Manager, Consumer Services
Gregory W. Pearce
47
 
Vice President and General Manager, Business Services
Tina M. Pidgeon
42
Senior Vice President
 
Jerry A. Edgerton1
68
 
Director
Scott M. Fisher1
44
Director
 
William P. Glasgow1
52
 
Director
Mark W. Kroloff1
53
Director
 
Stephen R. Mooney1
51
 
Director
James M. Schneider1
58
Director
 


1
The present classification of our board is as follows: (1) Class I – Messrs. Edgerton and Kroloff, whose present terms expire at the time of our 2011 annual meeting; (2) Class II – Messrs. Brett, Duncan and Mooney whose present terms expire at the time of our 2012 annual meeting; and (3) Class III – Messrs. Fisher, Glasgow, and Schneider, whose present terms expire at the time of our 2013 annual meeting.
 
 
 
64

 


The board, when considering whether directors have the experience, qualifications, attributes or skills, taken as a whole, to enable the board to satisfy its oversight responsibilities effectively in light of the Company's business and structure, focused primarily on each person's background and experience.  We believe that the Company's directors have backgrounds that, when combined, provide us with a board equipped to direct us through an ever challenging course in the segments of the telecommunication business in which we are involved.  Attributes of members of our board include experience in entrepreneurial, cable service, telecommunication, technological and financial aspects of companies similar to, as well as much larger than, us.

In particular, our board considered important the following regarding its members.  With regard to Mr. Brett, our board considered his telecommunications and cable experience, as well as his over 40 year experience as a corporate lawyer.  With regards to Messrs. Fisher and Glasgow, our board considered the broad backgrounds of these individuals in finance and their operational experience with cable companies.  With regards to Messrs. Edgerton and Mooney, our board considered the extensive experience and expertise of these individuals in business development in the telecommunications industry.  Our board also considered the broad perspective brought by Mr. Kroloff's experience in operating diverse businesses throughout Alaska as well as his experience as a lawyer.  With regard to Mr. Schneider, our board considered his significant financial and accounting experience including his time spent as Chief Financial Officer of a large public company.

Our board also considered the many years of experience with the Company represented by Mr. Duncan, our President and Chief Executive Officer.  He has been with the Company since he co-founded it.

Many of our directors, including Messrs. Edgerton, Glasgow, Kroloff, Mooney and Schneider, were initially proposed for nomination by (or, in the case of Mr. Kroloff, through a request from Mr. Duncan to) holders of significant amounts of Company shares.  Our board has retained each of these directors, even after the shareholders have exited the Company or no longer have retained a right to nominate a director, due to the valued expertise our board feels they provide as members.

Stephen M. Brett.  Mr. Brett has served as Chairman of our board since June 2005 and as a director on our board since January 2001.  He has been of counsel to Sherman and Howard, a law firm, since January 2001.  He was Senior Executive Vice President for AT&T Broadband from March 1999 to April 2000.  His present term as a director on our board expires at the time of our 2012 annual meeting.

Ronald A. Duncan.  Mr. Duncan is a co-founder of the Company and has served as a director on our board since 1979.  Mr. Duncan has served as our President and Chief Executive Officer since January 1989.  His present term as director on the board expires at the time of our 2012 annual meeting.

John M. Lowber.  Mr. Lowber has served as our Chief Financial Officer since January 1987, as our Secretary and Treasurer since July 1988 and as one of our Senior Vice Presidents since December 1989.

G. Wilson Hughes.  Mr. Hughes has served as our Executive Vice President and General Manager since June 1991.

William C. Behnke.  Mr. Behnke has served as one of our Senior Vice Presidents since January 2001.  Prior to that, he served as our Senior Vice President – Marketing and Sales from January 1994.

Martin E. Cary.  Mr. Cary has served as our Vice President – General Manager, Managed Broadband Services since September 2004.  Prior to that, he served as our Vice President – Broadband Services from June 1999 to September 2004.

Gregory F. Chapados.  Mr. Chapados has served as one of our Senior Vice Presidents since June 2006.  Prior to that, he was the Managing Director of Integrated Strategies Initiatives LLC from August 2004 to May 2006.  Integrated Strategies was at the time a boutique investment bank serving middle-market companies in defense and other areas of federal contracting.  Prior to that, Mr. Chapados was a Managing Director at the investment bank, Hoak Breedlove Wesneski & Co. from February 1995 to July 2004.

 
65

 
Richard P. Dowling.  Mr. Dowling has served as one of our Senior Vice Presidents since December 1990.

Paul E. Landes.  Mr. Landes has served as one of our Senior Vice Presidents and as General Manager, Consumer Services since December 2010.  Prior to that, he served as our Vice President and General Manager Consumer Services from September 2005 to December 2010.  Prior to that, Mr. Landes served as our Vice President – Marketing and Sales, and Chief Marketing Officer beginning in 2002.  Prior to that, he was our Vice President – Marketing from 1999 to 2002.

Gregory W. Pearce.  Mr. Pearce has served as our Vice President and General Manager, Business Services since June 2010.  Prior to that, he served as our Vice President and General Manager, Commercial Services beginning in September 2005.  Prior to that, he served as our Vice President /Director of Long Distance Products beginning in January 1998.

Tina M. Pidgeon.  Ms. Pidgeon has served as one of our Senior Vice Presidents since September 2010.  Prior to that, she served as our Vice President, Federal Regulatory Affairs from January 2003 to September 2010.

Jerry A. Edgerton.  Mr. Edgerton has served as a director on our board since June 2004.  Since July 2009, he has been President of Government Markets for Core 180, a network integrator for large governmental and commercial customers.  From November 2007 to May 2009, he was Chief Executive Officer for Command Information, Inc., a next generation Internet service company.  From April 2007 to October 2007, Mr. Edgerton was an advisor on matters affecting the telecommunications industry as well as the U.S. government.  Prior to that and from January 2006 to April 2007, he was Group President of Verizon Federal.  Prior to that and from November 1996, he was Senior Vice President – Government Markets for MCI Communications Corporation, an affiliate of MCI, which was later acquired by Verizon Communications, Inc.  His present term as a director on our board expires at the time of our 2011 annual meeting.

Scott M. Fisher.  Mr. Fisher was appointed to our board in December 2005.  From 1998 to the present, he has been a partner of Fisher Capital Partners, Ltd., a private equity and real estate investment company located in Denver, Colorado.  During that time, Fisher Capital owned and operated Peak Cablevision, a multiple system cable television operator with approximately 120,000 subscribers.  At Peak Cablevision, Mr. Fisher was responsible for television programming and corporate development.  From June 1990 to April 1998, he was Vice President at The Bank of New York and BNY Capital Resources Corporation, an affiliate of The Bank of New York, where he worked in the corporate lending and commercial leasing departments.  Mr. Fisher serves on the advisory boards of several private companies.  His present term as director on our board expires at the time of our 2013 annual meeting.

William P. Glasgow.  Mr. Glasgow has served as a director on our board since 1996.  From 2005 to the present, Mr. Glasgow has been Chief Executive Officer of AmericanWay Education.  From 1999 to December 2004, he was President/CEO of Security Broadband Corp.  From 2000 to the present Mr. Glasgow has been President of Diamond Ventures, L.L.C., a Texas limited liability company and sole general partner of Prime II Management, L.P., and Prime II Investments, L.P., both of which are Delaware limited partnerships.  Since 1996, he has been President of Prime II Management, Inc., a Delaware corporation, which was formerly the sole general partner of Prime II Management, L.P.  His present term as a director on our board expires at the time of our 2013 annual meeting.

Mark W. Kroloff.  Mr. Kroloff has served as a director on our board since February 2009.  Since January 2010, he has been a principal at First Alaskan Capital Partners, LLC, an investment firm.  From May 2005 to December 2009, he was Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of Arctic Slope Regional Corporation ("ASRC"), an Alaska Native regional corporation formed pursuant to the Alaska Native Claims Settlement Act.  From 2001 to April 2005, Mr. Kroloff was Chief Operating Officer of Cook Inlet Region, Inc., also an Alaska Native regional corporation.  Prior to that, from 1989 to 2001 he was Vice President and General Counsel of Cook Inlet Region, Inc.  Mr. Kroloff's present term as a director on our board expires at the time of our 2011 annual meeting.

Stephen R. Mooney.  Mr. Mooney has served as a director on our board since January 1999.  He has been a Managing Director with the McClean Group, LLC, a national financial advisory services firm based in Washington, D.C. since April 2010.  From February 2008 to November 2009, Mr. Mooney was Vice President, Business Development for Affiliated Computer Services, Inc., a global information technology and business process outsourcing company.  From January 2006 to September 2007, he was Executive Director, Business Development of VerizonBusiness, a unit of Verizon.  Prior to that, he was Vice President,
 
 
66

 
Corporate Development and Treasury Services at MCI beginning in 2002.  From 1999 to 2002, he was Vice President of WorldCom Ventures Fund, Inc.  His present term as a director on our board expires at the time of our 2012 annual meeting.

James M. Schneider.  Mr. Schneider has served as a director on our board since July 1994.  He has been Chairman of Frontier Bancshares, Inc. since February 2007.  Prior to that, Mr. Schneider had been Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer for Dell, Inc. from March 2000 to February 2007.  Prior to that, he was Senior Vice President – Finance for Dell Computer Corporation from September 1998 to March 2000.  He served on the board of directors of GAP, Inc. from September 2003 to October 2010.  Mr. Schneider also served on the board of directors of Lockheed Martin Corporation from December 2005 to August 2010.  His present term as a director on our board expires at the time of our 2013 annual meeting.

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance

During 2010, four of our executive officers (Messrs. Duncan (also a director), Lowber, Behnke and Chapados) inadvertently failed to file with the SEC, in each case, a Form 4 (Change in Beneficial Ownership Report) on a timely basis as required under Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act.  That is, they failed to file respective Forms 4 on the due date of February 8, 2010, but all of the filings were made by February 16, 2010.

Also during 2010, one or our executive officers (Ms. Tarbath) inadvertently failed to file with the SEC a Form 4 on a timely basis.  That is, she failed to file the form on February 19, 2010, but the filing was made by March 8, 2010.  Furthermore, during 2010, three of the executive officers at the time (Messrs. Hughes and Chapados, and Ms. Dana Tindall (who is now deceased)) failed to file with the SEC in each case a Form 4 on a timely basis.  That is, in each case the individual failed to file the form on April 1, 2010, but all of the filings were later made by May 6, 2010.  Another two of our executive officers (Messrs. Cary and Pearce) and one of our directors (Mr. Schneider) each inadvertently failed to file with the SEC a Form 4 on a timely basis.  That is, Mr. Cary failed to file the form on December 10, 2010 (but the filing was later made by December 22, 2010), Mr. Pearce failed to file the form on March 31, 2009 (but the filing was later made by January 27, 2010), and Mr. Schneider failed to file the form on December 30, 2010 (but the filing was later made by January 4, 2011).

Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

Our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics ("Ethics Code"), was adopted by our board in 2003.  It applies to all of our officers, directors and employees.  The Ethics Code takes as its basis a set of business principles adopted by our board several years ago.  It also builds upon the basic requirements for a code of ethics as required by federal securities law and rules adopted by the SEC.

Through our Ethics Code, we reaffirm our course of business conduct and ethics as based upon key values and characteristics and through adherence to a clear code of ethical conduct.  Our Ethics Code promotes honest and ethical conduct, including ethical handling of actual or apparent conflicts of interest between personal and professional relationships of our employees.  It also promotes full, fair, accurate, timely and understandable disclosure in our reports and documents filed with, or submitted to, the SEC and other public communications made by us.  Our Ethics Code further promotes compliance with applicable governmental laws, rules and regulations, internal reporting of violations of the code to appropriate persons as identified in the code and accountability for adherence to the code.

A copy of our Ethics Code is displayed on our Internet website at www.gci.com  (click on "About GCI," then click on "For Investors," and then click on "Code of Business Conduct and Ethics").

No Change in Nominating Procedure

There were no changes made during 2010 to the procedure by which our shareholders may recommend nominees to our board.

Litigation and Regulatory Matters

We were, as of December 31, 2010, involved in several administrative and civil action matters primarily related to our telecommunications markets in Alaska and the remaining 49 states and other regulatory matters.  These actions are discussed in more detail elsewhere in this report.  See "Part I – Item 3 – Legal Proceedings."  However, as of that date, our board was unaware of any legal proceedings in which one or
 
 
67

 
more of our directors, officers, affiliates or owners of record or beneficially of more than 5% of any class of our voting securities, or any associates of the previously listed persons were parties adverse to us or any of our subsidiaries.

In December 2010, Mr. Schneider settled charges brought against him by the SEC for actions that allegedly took place when he was the chief financial officer at Dell, Inc.  Mr. Schneider is no longer employed by Dell, Inc..  He settled the charges and consented to the issuance of an SEC administrative order without admitting or denying the SEC's findings, with limited exceptions.  The limited exceptions are acknowledgment of the SEC's jurisdiction over Mr. Schneider and the subject matter of the SEC proceedings brought against him, and the SEC findings with respect to litigation involving that company and certain of its senior executive officers including Mr. Schneider.  The court in that litigation entered an order permanently enjoining Mr. Schneider, by consent, from future violations of specified provisions of federal securities law.  Mr. Schneider agreed to pay, as specified in the court's order, $3 million as a civil money penalty and $83,096 in disgorgement of ill-gotten gains, as well as $38,640 in prejudgment interest.  In the settlement with the SEC, Mr. Schneider has further consented to his suspension from appearing or practicing before the SEC as an accountant for at least five years, after which time he may request reinstatement by application to the SEC.  As of December 31, 2010, Mr. Schneider was making payments in accordance with the terms of the court order.  Our board has concluded that the SEC charges and SEC administrative order, and Mr. Schneider's settlement of those charges and consent to that order do not limit his ability to serve on our board.

Audit Committee, Audit Committee Financial Expert

We have a board audit committee ("Audit Committee") comprised of several members of our board, i.e., Messrs. Schneider (Chair), Mooney, and Glasgow.

Our Audit Committee is governed by, and carries out its responsibilities under, an Audit Committee Charter, as adopted and amended from time to time by our board ("Audit Committee Charter").  The charter sets forth the purpose of the Audit Committee and its membership prerequisites and operating principles.  It also requires our Audit Committee to select our independent, registered, public accounting firm to provide for us accounting and audit services ("External Accountant") and sets forth other primary responsibilities.  A copy of our Audit Committee Charter is available to our shareholders on our Internet website: www.gci.com (click on "About GCI," then click on "For Investors," and then click on "Audit Committee Charter").

The Nasdaq corporate governance listing standards require that at least one member of our Audit Committee must have past employment experience in finance or accounting, requisite professional certification in accounting, or comparable experience or background which results in the individual's "financial sophistication."  This financial sophistication may derive from the person being or having been a chief executive officer, chief financial officer or other senior officer with financial oversight responsibilities.

Our board believes that Messrs. Glasgow, Mooney and Schneider, are audit committee financial experts ("Audit Committee Financial Experts") and also meet the Nasdaq requirements for financial sophistication.  Our board further believes these individuals are each an independent director as the term is defined in the Nasdaq Stock Market corporate listing standards (to which the Company is subject), i.e., an individual other than one of our executive officers or employees or any other individual having a relationship which in the opinion of our board would interfere in carrying out the responsibilities of a director ("Independent Director").

Under the SEC's rules, an Audit Committee Financial Expert is defined as a person who has all of the following attributes:

·  
Understanding of GAAP and financial statements.

·  
Ability to assess the general application of GAAP in connection with accounting for estimates, accruals and reserves.

·  
Experience in preparing, auditing, analyzing or evaluating financial statements that present a breadth and level of complexity of accounting issues that are generally comparable to the breadth and complexity of issues that can reasonably be expected to be raised by our financial statements, or experience actively supervising one or more persons engaged in such activities.

·  
Understanding of internal control over financial reporting.
 
 
 
68

 

 
·  
Understanding of audit committee functions.

The Audit Committee Charter specifies how one may determine whether a person has acquired the attributes of an Audit Committee Financial Expert.  They are one or more of the following:

·  
Education and experience as a principal financial officer, principal accounting officer, controller, public accountant or auditor or experience in one or more positions that involved the performance of similar functions.

·  
Experience actively supervising a principal financial officer, principal accounting officer, controller, public accountant, auditor or person performing similar functions.

·  
Experience overseeing or assessing the performance of companies or public accountants with respect to the preparation, auditing or evaluation of financial statements.

·  
Other relevant experience.

Our Audit Committee acts on behalf of our board and generally carries out specific duties including the following, all of which are described in detail in our Audit Committee Charter:

·  
Principal Accountant Selection, Qualification Is directly responsible for appointment, compensation, retention, oversight, qualifications and independence of our External Accountant.

·  
Financial StatementsAssists in our board's oversight of integrity of the Company financial statements.

·  
Financial Reports, Internal Control Is directly responsible for oversight of the audit by our External Accountant of our financial reports and reports on internal control.

·  
Annual Reports Prepares reports required to be included in our annual proxy statement.

·  
Complaints Receives and responds to certain complaints relating to internal accounting controls, and auditing matters, confidential, anonymous submissions by our employees regarding questionable accounting or auditing matters, and certain alleged illegal acts or behavior-related conduct in violation of our Ethics Code.  See "Part III – Item 10 – Code of Business Conduct and Ethics."

·  
Principal Accountant Disagreements Resolves disagreements, if any, between our External Accountant and us regarding financial reporting.

·  
Non-Audit Services Reviews and pre-approves any non-audit services (audit-related, tax and other non-audit related services) offered to us by our External Accountant ("Non-Audit Services").

·  
Attorney ReportsAddresses certain attorney reports, if any, relating to violation of securities law or fiduciary duty by one of our officers, directors, employees or agents.

·  
Related Party Transactions Reviews certain related party transactions as described elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 13 – Certain Transactions."

·  
Other Carries out other assignments as designated by our board.

ITEM 11. Executive Compensation

Compensation Discussion and Analysis

Overview –

Compensation of our executive officers and directors during 2010 was subject to processes and procedures carried out through our Compensation Committee ("Compensation Program").  This compensation discussion and analysis ("Compensation Discussion and Analysis") addresses the material elements of our Compensation Program as applied to our chief executive officer, our chief financial officer, and to each of
 
 
69

 
our three other most highly compensated executive officers other than the chief executive officer and chief financial officer who were serving as executive officers as of December 31, 2010.  All five of these officers are identified in the Summary Compensation Table ("Named Executive Officers").  See "Part III – Item 11 – Executive Compensation:  Summary Compensation Table."

Both the Compensation Committee and the Company believe that the compensation paid to the Named Executive Officers under our Compensation Program is fair, reasonable, competitive and consistent with our Compensation Principles.

Our Compensation Committee is composed of Messrs. Brett (Chair), Edgerton, Fisher, Glasgow, Kroloff, Mooney, and Schneider.  All of the members of the committee are considered by our board to be Independent Directors.

Our board had not as of December 31, 2010 adopted a charter for the Compensation Committee.  However, consideration and determination of compensation of our executive officers and directors during 2010 was subject to our Compensation Program, the aspects of which are described elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Process."

Our Compensation Program sets forth the scope of authority of our Compensation Committee and requires the committee to carry out the following:

·  
Review, on an annual basis, plans and targets for executive officer and board member compensation, if any –

·  
Review is specifically to address expected performance and compensation of, and the criteria on which compensation is based for, the chief executive officer and such other of our executive officers as our board may designate for this purpose.

·  
Monitor the effect of ongoing events on, and the effectiveness of, existing compensation policies, goals, and plans –

·  
Events specifically include but are not limited to the status of the premise that all pay systems correlate with our compensation goals and policies.

·  
Report from time to time, its findings to our board.

·  
Administer our Amended and Restated 1986 Stock Option Plan ("Stock Option Plan") and approve grants of options and awards pursuant to the plan.

·  
Monitor compensation-related publicity and public and private sector developments on executive compensation.

·  
Familiarize itself with, and monitor the tax, accounting, corporate, and securities law ramifications of, our compensation policies, including but not limited to –

·  
Comprehending a senior executive officer's total compensation package.

·  
Comprehending the package's total cost to us and its total value to the recipient.

·  
Paying close attention to salary, bonuses, individual insurance and health benefits, perquisites, special benefits to specific executive officers, and other retirement benefits.

·  
Establish the overall cap on executive compensation and the measure of performance for executive officers, either by predetermined measurement or by a subjective evaluation.

·  
Strive to make our compensation plans simple, fair, and structured so as to maximize shareholder value.

 
 
70

 
In carrying out its duties, our Compensation Committee may accept for review and inclusion in its annual review with our board, recommendations from our chief executive officer as to expected performance and compensation of, and the criteria on which compensation is based for, executive officers.  However, our Compensation Committee, in being established as a committee of the board under our Bylaws, was not specifically authorized to delegate any of its duties to another person.  Our Compensation Committee has in the past retained and made use of compensation consultants in determining or recommending the amount or form of executive compensation as further discussed elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Process."

Principles of the Compensation Program –

Our Compensation Program is based upon the following principles ("Compensation Principles"):

·  
Compensation is related to performance and must cause alignment of interests of executive officers with the long term interests of our shareholders.

·  
Compensation targets must take into consideration competitive market conditions and provide incentives for superior performance by the Company.

·  
Actual compensation must take into consideration the Company's and the executive officer's performance over the prior year and the long term, and the Company's resources.

·  
Compensation is based upon both qualitative and quantitative factors.

·  
Compensation must enable the Company to attract and retain management necessary to cause the Company to succeed.

Process –

Overview.  Our Compensation Committee reviews annually and recommends to our board for approval the base salary, incentive and other compensation of our chief executive officer and senior executive officers, including the Named Executive Officers.  These reviews are performed and recommendations are made in executive session that excludes all members of management.  The analyses and recommendations of the Chief Executive Officer on these matters may be considered by our Compensation Committee in its deliberations and recommendations to our board.  Board action on the recommendations is done by vote of our Independent Directors.

Other elements of executive compensation and benefits as described in this section are also reviewed by our Compensation Committee on a regular basis.

Compensation Committee and Compensation Consultant Interaction.  Our Compensation Committee evaluates and analyzes the Compensation Program, its principles and objectives, and the specific compensation element recommendations presented by our Chief Executive Officer on an annual basis.  In October 2005, our Compensation Committee selected, retained and commenced a process of working with an outside compensation consultant (Towers Perrin, which subsequently merged with another entity and became Towers Watson, hereafter "Compensation Consultant") to assist the Compensation Committee with its compensation reviews on an annual basis.   The Compensation Consultant reported directly to our Compensation Committee and assisted the Compensation Committee in evaluating and analyzing the compensation levels and targets for the senior executive officers during 2010, including the Named Executive Officers.

Implementation.  Discussions on executive compensation and benefits made by the Compensation Committee have been guided by our Compensation Principles.  The elements of compensation as described later in this section are believed by the Compensation Committee to be integral and necessary parts of the Compensation Program.

Our Compensation Committee has concluded that each individual segment of each element of executive compensation continues generally to be consistent with one or more of our Compensation Principles.  Our Compensation Committee has further concluded the amount of compensation provided by the segment is reasonable, primarily based upon a comparison of the compensation amounts and segments we provide when compared to those offered by other similar companies in our industry and in our market.

 
71

 
Our process for determining executive compensation and benefits does not involve a precise and identifiable formula or link between each element and our Compensation Principles.  However, it takes into consideration market practice and information provided by our Compensation Consultant and management.  Furthermore, it is based upon the relationship of compensation as shall be paid and financial performance of the Company.  It is also the result of discussion among our Compensation Committee members and management.  Ultimately it is based upon the judgment of our Compensation Committee.

Each year our Compensation Committee reviews elements of compensation for each of our senior executive officers including, for 2010, the Named Executive Officers.

In 2010, base salary and incentive stock targets were compared to survey data and amounts offered by a group of similar companies.  The Company's relative financial performance was reviewed in order to determine what a reasonable amount of compensation might be in relation to its peer group.  The compensation peer group is principally made up of the following:

·  
Companies in industries similar to our Company.

·  
Companies with which our Company competes for executive talent.

·  
Our Company's direct business competitors.

·  
Companies that compete with our Company for investment dollars.

The compensation peer group list used in determining the reasonableness of our Compensation Program consisted of 16 companies as follows:
 
 
Alaska Communications Systems Group, Inc.
Knology, Inc.
C Beyond, Inc.
Mediacom Communications Corp.
Cincinnati Bell, Inc.
Premiere Global Services, Inc.
Consolidated Communications Holdings, Inc.
RCN Corp
Crown Media Holdings, Inc.
SureWest Communications
Equinix, Inc.
Time Warner Telecom, Inc.
Grande Communications
Wave Broadband
Iowa Telecommunications Services, Inc.
XO Holdings, Inc.

Individual levels of base compensation were generally targeted to be set within a range of between the 50th and 75th percentile, based upon the executive's individual performance in the prior year relative to his or her peers, the executive's future potential, and the scope of the executive's responsibilities and experience.  Input from the individual executives in terms of their expectation and requirements were considered as well.

We believe this method of setting compensation enables the Company to attract and retain individuals who are necessary to lead and manage the Company while enabling the Company to differentiate between executives and performance levels and responsibility.  The comparison to other companies also allowed the Compensation Committee to determine the reasonableness of the balance between long-term incentive and annual compensation.

Based upon the information received from its Compensation Consultant, the Compensation Committee determined that, in general, base compensation levels for the Company's senior officers were reasonable and within the 50th and 75th percentile when compared to officers of companies in our peer group having comparable financial performance.  As a result, with one exception, the Compensation Committee made no adjustments to base compensation for senior executive officers in 2010 as further described below.  See "Part III – Item 11– Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Performance Rewarded."

In establishing 2010 base salary and incentive compensation targets, the Compensation Committee, although it did review the information and, except for grants that vested over multiple years, concluded it was not
 
 
72

 
appropriate to take into account payments or compensation earned by executive officers as a result of options or awards granted in prior years.

Other compensation elements as discussed in this section were periodically reviewed to ensure that they continued to remain both competitive and reasonable based upon market survey data obtained from various sources at the time of review.  While such data were typically not customized to the Company, they were used by our Compensation Committee as a guide for overall reasonableness and competitiveness of the benefits.  

Elements of Compensation –

Overview.  For 2010, the elements of compensation in our Compensation Program were as follows:

·  
Base Salary.

·  
Incentive Compensation Bonus Plan ("Incentive Compensation Plan").

·  
Stock Option Plan.

·  
Perquisites.

·  
Retirement and Welfare Benefits.

As of December 31, 2010, there were no compensatory plans or arrangements providing for payments to any of the Named Executive Officers in conjunction with any termination of employment or other working relationship of such an officer with us (including without limitation, resignation, severance, retirement or constructive termination of employment of the officer).  Furthermore, as of that date, there were no such plans or arrangements providing for payments to any of the Named Executive Officers in conjunction with a change of control of us or a change in such an officer's responsibilities to us.  However, in the event of a change in control, all options and restricted stock of our Named Executive Officers will vest.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Executive Compensation:  Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control."

The Company has no requirements with respect to security ownership by its officers or directors, and it has no policies regarding hedging the economic risk of ownership of Company equity.  Executive officers are invited to provide their input with respect to their compensation to the Compensation Committee primarily through our Chief Executive Officer.

A Named Executive Officer participating in the Compensation Program could, under terms of the corresponding Incentive Compensation Plan agreement with us and pursuant to our Deferred Compensation Plan, elect to defer a significant portion of that compensation.  In this instance, the Named Executive Officer becomes our unsecured creditor.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Nonqualified Deferred Compensation."

Base Salary.  Effective January 1, 2010, based upon the process previously described in this section, the base salaries reported in the Summary Compensation Table (see "Part III – Item 11 – Executive Compensation:  Summary Compensation Table") were approved by the Compensation Committee.

Mr. Duncan's base salary reflects cash compensation of $600,000 per year until adjusted by our Compensation Committee.  Mr. Duncan's duties remained unchanged during 2010.

Mr. Hughes' base salary reflects cash compensation of $362,500 per year and $125,000 credited to his Deferred Compensation Arrangement account with us.  His duties remained unchanged during 2010.   

Mr. Lowber's base salary reflects cash compensation of $260,000, $65,000 credited to his Deferred Compensation Arrangement account with us and in 2010 Mr. Lowber’s salary included $403,709 that reflects the vesting of a multi-year retention agreement.  His duties remained unchanged during 2010.   

Mr. Chapados' base salary reflects cash compensation of $270,000 representing his annual salary of $240,000 through June 30, 2010 and his annual salary of $300,000 beginning July 1, 2010.  His duties remained unchanged during 2010.   

 
73

 
Mr. Landes' base salary reflects cash compensation of $150,000.  His duties remained unchanged during 2010.

Incentive Compensation Plan.  Overview – A portion of the Company's compensation to each Named Executive Officer relates to, and is contingent upon, the officer's performance and our financial performance and resources.  Annual cash bonuses are intended to reward short-term performance and to make our senior executive compensation packages competitive with comparable executive positions in other companies.   

Messrs. Duncan, Hughes, Lowber and Chapados – Overview.  In October 2010, our board approved changes to our Incentive Compensation Plan for four of our Named Executive Officers (Messrs. Duncan, Hughes, Lowber and Chapados, collectively "Four Named Executive Officers").  The changes resulted from ongoing discussions during 2009 and 2010 and form a plan that is expected to be in place for those Four Named Executive Officers from 2010 through 2013.  These revisions to the Incentive Compensation Plan do not apply to the fifth Named Executive Officer, Mr. Landes.

In the context of the Four Named Executive Officers, the Compensation Committee first determined the targeted annual incentive compensation for each of them.  After setting these targets, the Compensation Committee then split that amount between short-term and long-term incentive compensation.  Both short-term and long-term incentive compensation is paid out in the form of 50% cash and 50% restricted stock grants that vest in three years.  Therefore, even the short-term incentive compensation is designed to encourage the focus of these executives on long-term performance.

The following table shows the short-term, long-term and total annual target incentive plan compensation for the Four Named Executive Officers under this plan for each of the four plan years:

Name
 
Short-Term Incentive
Compensation – Target
($)
   
Long-Term Incentive
Compensation – Target
($)
   
Total Annual Target –Incentive Compensation Plan
($)
 
Ronald A. Duncan
    1,450,000       350,000       1,800,000  
G. Wilson Hughes
    466,667       333,333       800,000  
John M. Lowber
    350,000       200,000       550,000  
Gregory F. Chapados
    350,000       200,000       550,000  

Short-Term Incentive Compensation.  The components of the short-term portion of the Incentive Compensation Plan are expected to remain the same for the duration of the plan.  However, the allocation between the components will likely change on an annual basis at the discretion of the Compensation Committee.  The following table provides a summary of the 2010 short-term incentive compensation targets for the Four Named Executive Officers:

Name
 
Free Cash Flow Goal
($)
   
Capex Spending
($)
   
Discretionary
($)
   
2010 Short-Term
Incentive Compensation Plan Target
($)
 
Ronald A. Duncan
    500,000       200,000       750,000       1,450,000  
G. Wilson Hughes
    200,000       100,000       166,667       466,667  
John M. Lowber
    150,000       50,000       150,000       350,000  
Gregory F. Chapados
    100,000       25,000       225,000       350,000  

The following is a description of what each of these short-term incentive compensation targets are and how they are measured.

Free Cash Flow Goal.  The Free Cash Flow Goal is intended to focus the Four Named Executive Officers on increasing the Free Cash Flow of the Company by increasing Adjusted EBITDA, managing capital expenditures and reducing working capital requirements. The target is based upon achieving the sum of planned year over year increases in the following three metrics:
 
 
74

 

 
(1)  
Cash Adjusted EBITDA – Adjusted EBITDA, plus IRU sales, less non-cash items and adjusted for new businesses.  The target for year over year growth in this metric was $14.6 million in 2010.

(2)  
Free Cash Flow – Cash Adjusted EBITDA, less capital expenditure spending ("Capex Spending"), less interest expense and less cash taxes.  The target for year over year growth in this metric was $25.1 million in 2010.

(3)  
Increase in Cash Balance - Targeted Free Cash Flow, plus acquisition payments, plus net principal payments, plus stock repurchases and dividends, if any.  The target for this component was $18.5 million in 2010.

The Free Cash Flow Goal is the sum of the three metrics above.  The combined metric was $58.2 million in 2010.  If the actual performance generated twice the performance ($116.4 million), the payout would be twice the targeted amount.  Conversely, the payout would be half of the targeted amount if the metric was half of the targeted amount ($29.1 million).  This target is to be reviewed and reset annually by the Compensation Committee.

Capex Spending.  The Capex Spending target is based on Capex Spending not exceeding the goal set forth by our board.  The goal was $100 million in 2010, but that amount is to be reviewed and may be reset annually for future years.  In 2010 the targeted incentive for Capex Spending will be paid out at 100% if the total cash adjusted Capex Spending for the year is $102 million or less.  If cash adjusted Capex Spending exceeds $102 million, the payout would reduce in a linear fashion to zero at $106 million.  For 2010, the cash adjusted Capex Spending was $97.6 million.
 
 
Discretionary.   The board will take various factors into account when deciding on the payout of the discretionary portion of the plan applying to the Four Named Executive Officers.  These factors include, but are not limited to, leadership, crisis management, succession planning, strategic planning, risk management, special projects, financial reporting, and compliance with our debt covenants.  The discretionary achievement for 2010 was based upon subjective levels of achievement by the individual officer, including the factors stated above, and was heavily influenced by our financial performance against our business plan.

The following table summarizes the 2010 short-term incentive compensation, a portion of which were paid in 2010 with the remainder paid in 2011, of which 50% will be in cash and 50% in the form of restricted stock grants, achieved by the Four Named Executive Officers, each of whom participated in this plan:
 
 
75

 

 
Goals
 
Ronald A. Duncan
   
G. Wilson Hughes
   
John M. Lowber
   
Gregory F. Chapados
 
Free Cash Flow Goal – Target Incentive Compensation
  $ 500,000     $ 200,000     $ 150,000     $ 100,000  
                                 
Targeted Free Cash Flow Goal
    58,221,000       58,221,000       58,221,000       58,221,000  
Actual Free Cash Flow
    153,854,000       153,854,000       153,854,000       153,854,000  
Free Cash Flow Goal Achievement
    264 %     264 %     264 %     264 %
2010 Free Cash Flow Incentive Compensation Earned
  $ 1,321,293     $ 528,517     $ 396,388     $ 264,259  
                                 
Capex Spending – Target Incentive Compensation
    200,000       100,000       50,000       25,000  
Capex Spending Achievement
    100 %     100 %     100 %     100 %
2010 Capex Spending Incentive Compensation Earned
  $ 200,000     $ 100,000     $ 50,000     $ 25,000  
                                 
Discretionary – Target Incentive Compensation
    750,000       166,667       150,000       225,000  
Discretionary Achievement
    112 %     126 %     92 %     112 %
2010 Discretionary Incentive Compensation Earned
  $ 837,500     $ 209,584     $ 137,500     $ 251,250  
                                 
2010 Short-Term Incentive Compensation Earned
  $ 2,358,793     $ 838,101     $ 583,888     $ 540,509  

2011 Short-Term Incentive Compensation Targets.  The following table summarizes the short-term incentive compensation targets established by our Compensation Committee for our Four Named Executive Officers for 2011:

Name
 
Free Cash Flow Goal
($)
   
Capex Spending
($)
   
Discretionary
($)
   
2011 Short-Term
Incentive Compensation Plan Target
($)
 
Ronald A. Duncan
    350,000       200,000       900,000       1,450,000  
G. Wilson Hughes
    200,000       100,000       166,667       466,667  
John M. Lowber
    125,000       50,000       175,000       350,000  
Gregory F. Chapados
    100,000       25,000       225,000       350,000  

 For 2011, the Compensation Committee will evaluate the metric upon which the Free Cash Flow Goal will be based.  The Capex Spending goal for that year will be based upon $150 million in cash adjusted Capex Spending.

Long-Term Incentive Compensation.  $290 million Adjusted EBITDA Plan.  The goal of this portion of the Incentive Compensation Plan for the Four Named Executive Officers is to drive long-term Adjusted EBITDA growth.  To achieve the target level of payments under the plan, it would be necessary to have $225 million in Adjusted EBITDA in 2011 and $250 million in Adjusted EBITDA in 2013.  The maximum payout would require Adjusted EBITDA to be in excess of $250 million in 2011, $250 million in 2012 and $290 million in 2013.

The following table outlines the minimum, target and maximum payouts under the $290 million Adjusted EBITDA plan.  The target payments are for a four-year plan.  Hence, the target amount is four times the amount shown above for Messrs. Duncan and Lowber in the summary table of short-term and long-term compensation targets.  For example, Mr. Duncan will receive a targeted incentive of $350,000 per year for the $290 million plan which over a four year period amounts to the $1,400,000 which is shown below.  The target payments are only three times the amount for Mr. Hughes as he is eligible to receive the payment regardless of whether he is employed by the Company in year four of the incentive plan, 2013.
 
 
76

 

 
Name
 
Minimum Payments
($)
   
Target Payments
($)
   
Maximum Payments
($)
 
Ronald A. Duncan
    0       1,400,000       2,800,000  
G. Wilson Hughes
    0       1,000,000       2,000,000  
John M. Lowber
    0       800,000       1,600,000  
Gregory F. Chapados
    0       800,000       1,600,000  

There was no incentive compensation earned during 2010 pursuant to the long-term Incentive compensation portion of the plan.  The following table shows the potential payments pursuant to this plan in 2011:

Name
 
If 2011 Adjusted EBITDA is below $225 million
($)
   
If 2011 Adjusted EBITDA is above $225 million but below $250 million
($)
   
If 2011 Adjusted EBITDA is above $250 million
($)
 
Ronald A. Duncan
    0       700,000       1,050,000  
G. Wilson Hughes
    0       500,000       750,000  
John M. Lowber
    0       400,000       600,000  
Gregory F. Chapados
    0       400,000       600,000  

Despite establishment of these performance goals and targeted incentive compensation amounts, the Compensation Committee retains complete discretionary authority to adjust the amount of incentive compensation paid.

Mr. Landes – Mr. Landes' incentive compensation was paid in accordance with the targeted incentive compensation of 1.67% of the growth of Adjusted EBITDA in the Company's consumer line of business compared to the prior year.  The Compensation Committee believed that such a payment was appropriate given the strong 2010 performance of the Company's consumer segment.  The incentive plan for Mr. Landes for 2011 will be the same as his 2010 incentive plan.

Stock Option Plan.  Options and awards, if granted to the Named Executive Officers, were granted pursuant to terms of our Stock Option Plan.  In particular, the exercise price for options in each instance was the closing price for our Class A common stock on the Nasdaq Global Select Market on the day of the grant of the option.  Options or awards, if granted, were granted contemporaneously with the approval of the Compensation Committee, typically early in the year in question or late in the previous year as described above.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Elements of Compensation – Incentive Compensation Plan."

We adopted our stock option plan in 1986.  It has been subsequently amended from time to time and presently is our Stock Option Plan, i.e., our Amended and Restated 1986 Stock Option Plan.  Under our Stock Option Plan, we are authorized to grant awards and options to purchase shares of Class A common stock to selected officers, directors and other employees of, and consultants or advisors to, the Company and its subsidiaries.  The options are more specifically referred to as nonstatutory stock options or incentive stock options within Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended ("Internal Revenue Code").  In addition, under the Stock Option Plan restricted stock awards may be granted as further described below.  The selection of grantees for options and awards under the plan is made by our Compensation Committee.

The number of shares of Class A common stock allocated to the Stock Option Plan is 15.7 million shares.  The number of shares for which options or awards may be granted is subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of stock dividends, stock splits, mergers, consolidations and certain other changes in corporate structure or capitalization.  As of December 31, 2010, there were 1,249,050 shares subject to outstanding options under the Stock Option Plan, 2,309,947 shares granted subject to vesting, 8,441,745 shares issued upon the exercise of options or vesting of awards under the plan, 480,968 share options repurchased by the plan and 4,180,226 shares remained available for additional grants under the plan.

 
77

 
Restricted stock awards granted under the Stock Option Plan may be subject to vesting conditions based upon service or performance criteria as the Compensation Committee may specify.  These specifications may include attainment of one or more performance targets.  Shares acquired pursuant to such an award may not be transferred by the participant until vested.  Unless otherwise provided by the Compensation Committee, a participant will forfeit any shares of restricted stock where the restrictions have not lapsed prior to the participant's termination of service with us.  Participants holding restricted stock will have the right to vote the shares and to receive dividends paid, if any.  However, those dividends or other distributions paid in shares will be subject to the same restrictions as the original award.

Our Compensation Committee selects each grantee and the time of grant of an option or award and determines the terms of each grant, including the number of shares covered by each grant and the exercise price.  In selecting a participant, as well as in determining these other terms and conditions of each grant, our Compensation Committee takes into consideration such factors as it deems, in its sole discretion, relevant in connection with accomplishing the purpose of the plan.

Under the Stock Option Plan, an option becomes vested and exercisable at such time or upon such event and subject to such terms, conditions, performance criteria or restrictions as specified by the Compensation Committee.  The maximum term of any option granted under the plan is 10 years, provided that an incentive stock option granted to a person who at the time of grant owns stock possessing more than 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock of the Company or any subsidiary corporation of the Company ("Ten Percent Shareholder") must have a term not exceeding five years.  Unless otherwise permitted by the Compensation Committee, an option generally remains exercisable for 30 days following the participant's termination of service, with limited exception.  The exception arises if service terminates as a result of the participant's death or disability, in which case the option generally remains exercisable for 12 months.  In any event, the option must be exercised no later than its expiration date.

In particular, under the present Stock Option Plan, the Compensation Committee may set an option exercise price not less than the fair market value of the stock on the effective date of grant of the option.  However, in the case of an incentive stock option granted to a Ten Percent Shareholder, the exercise price must equal at least 110% of the fair market value of the stock on the date of grant.

Our Compensation Committee may, subject to certain limitations on the exercise of its discretion required by Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code, amend, cancel or renew any option granted under the Stock Option Plan, waive any restrictions or conditions applicable to any option under the plan, and accelerate, continue, extend or defer the vesting of any option under the plan.  The Stock Option Plan provides, subject to certain limitations, for indemnification by the Company of any director, officer, or employee against all reasonable expenses incurred in connection with any legal action arising from that person's action or failure to act in administering the plan.  All grants of options under the Stock Option Plan are to be evidenced by a written agreement between the Company and the optionee specifying the terms and conditions of the grant.

Options granted that have not become exercisable terminate upon the termination of the employment or directorship of the optionholder.  Exercisable options terminate from one month to one year after such termination, depending upon the cause of such termination.  If an option expires or terminates, the shares subject to such option become available for subsequent grants under the Stock Option Plan.

Incentive stock options are nontransferable by the participant other than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution, and are exercisable during the participant's lifetime only by the participant.  However, a nonstatutory stock option may be assigned or transferred to members of the optionholder's immediate family, to the extent permitted by the Compensation Committee in its sole discretion.

Our Stock Option Plan provides that payment upon exercise of an option may be in the form of money or shares of our Class A common stock.  If the optionee chooses the latter form of payment, the shares must have a fair market value not less than the exercise price.  The plan further provides, notwithstanding other restrictions on transferability of options, that an optionee, with approval of our Compensation Committee, may transfer an option for no consideration to, or for the benefit of, the optionee's immediate family.  There is no restriction in the Stock Option Plan that an option granted under the plan must be held by the optionee for a minimum period of time.

Under our Stock Option Plan, our authority to modify or amend the plan is subject to prior approval of our shareholders only in cases of increasing the number of shares of our stock allocated to, and available and
 
 
78

 
reserved for, issuance under the plan, changing the class of persons eligible to receive incentive stock options or where shareholder approval is required under applicable law, regulation or rule.  One such law requiring shareholder approval before the Company may rely on it is Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code.

Subject to these limitations, the Company may terminate or amend the Stock Option Plan at any time.  However, no termination or amendment may affect any outstanding option or award unless expressly provided by the Compensation Committee.  In any event, no termination or amendment of the plan may adversely affect an outstanding option or award without the consent of the participant unless necessary to comply with applicable law, regulation or rule.

With limited exception, no maximum or minimum exists with regard to the amount, either in dollars or in numbers, of options that may be exercised in any year, either by a single optionee or by all optionees under our Stock Option Plan.  At the 2002 annual meeting, our shareholders approved an amendment to the plan placing a limitation on accumulated grants of options of not more than 500,000 shares of Class A common stock per optionee per year.

With these exceptions, there are no fixed limitations on the number or amount of securities being offered, other than the practical limitations imposed by the number of employees eligible to participate in the plan and the total number of shares of stock authorized and available for granting under the plan.   Shares covered by options which have terminated or expired for any reason prior to their exercise are available for grant of new options pursuant to the plan.

In the past, the Company has used the Stock Option Plan to motivate our employees with compensation that is tied to the Company's stock performance.  However, many employees do not recognize the tangible benefits of holding stock options.  The Black-Scholes Merton Model, although elegant and deterministic, is at its core very complex.  A much simpler calculation that is often used by employees is to multiply the number of options by the amount that the options are in the money to calculate the current "value" of those options.  Unfortunately, this simpler calculation effectively ignores the remaining term of the option and drastically reduces its value in motivating and retaining option holders.

With limited exceptions (one involving Mr. Duncan, a Named Executive Officer), since mid-2009 we have used restricted stock in place of options.  That is, on February 8, 2010, we granted an option for 150,000 shares of Class A common stock to Mr. Duncan.  That option vests on February 8, 2012.

Perquisites.  The Company provides certain perquisites to its Named Executive Officers.  The Compensation Committee believes these perquisites are reasonable and appropriate and consistent with our awareness of perquisites offered by similar publicly traded companies.  The perquisites assist in attracting and retaining the Named Executive Officers and, in the case of certain perquisites, promote health, safety and efficiency of our Named Executive Officers.  These perquisites are as follows:

·  
Use of Company Leased Aircraft – The Company permits employees, including the Named Executive Officers, to use Company aircraft for personal travel for themselves and their guests.  Such travel generally is limited to a space available basis on flights that are otherwise business-related.  Where a Named Executive Officer, or a guest of that officer, flies on a space available basis, the additional variable cost to the Company (such as fuel, catering, and landing fees) is de minimus.  As a result, no amount is reflected in the Summary Compensation Table for that flight.  Where the additional variable cost to the Company occurs on such a flight for solely personal purposes of that Named Executive Officer or guest, that cost is included in the Summary Compensation Table entry for that officer.  Because it is rare for a flight to be purely personal in nature, fixed costs (such as hangar expenses, crew salaries and monthly leases) are not included in the Summary Compensation Table.  In any case, in the event such a cost is non-deductible by the Company under the Internal Revenue Code, the value of that lost deduction is included in the Summary Compensation Table entry for that Named Executive Officer.  When employees, including the Named Executive Officers, use Company aircraft for such travel they are attributed with taxable income in accordance with regulations pursuant to the Internal Revenue Code.  The Company does not "gross up" or reimburse an employee for taxes he or she owes on such attributed income.  Messrs. Duncan, Hughes and Landes have made use of the aircraft for personal travel, the variable cost, if any, of which is included in their respective entries in the Summary Compensation Table.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Executive Compensation:  Summary Compensation Table."
 
 
 
79

 

 
·  
Enhanced Long Term Disability Benefit – The Company provides the Named Executive Officers and other senior executive officers of the Company with an enhanced long term disability benefit.  This benefit provides a supplemental replacement income benefit of 60% of average monthly compensation capped at $10,000 per month.  The normal replacement income benefit applying to other of our employees is capped at $5,000 per month.

·  
Enhanced Short Term Disability Benefit – The Company provides the Named Executive Officers and other senior executive officers of the Company with an enhanced short term disability benefit.  This benefit provides a supplemental replacement income benefit of 66 2/3% of average monthly compensation, capped at $2,300 per week.  The normal replacement income benefit applying to other of our employees is capped at $1,150 per week.

·  
Miscellaneous – Aside from benefits offered to its employees generally, the Company provided miscellaneous other benefits to its Named Executive Officers including the following (see "Part III – Item 11 – Executive Compensation:  Summary Compensation Table – Components of 'All Other Compensation'"):

·  
Success Sharing – An incentive program offered to all of our employees that shares 15% of the excess earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, amortization and share based compensation expense over the highest previous year ("Success Sharing").

·  
Tax Reimbursement – Provided to all of our employees, including the Named Executive Officers, from time to time, on $100 longevity stock awards.

·  
Board Fees – Provided to Mr. Duncan as one of our directors. The Compensation Committee believes that it is appropriate to provide such board fees to Mr. Duncan given the additional oversight responsibilities and the accompanying liability incumbent upon members of our board.  In determining the appropriate amount of overall compensation payable to Mr. Duncan in his capacity as  Chief Executive Officer, the Compensation Committee does take into account any such board fees that are payable to Mr. Duncan.  This monitoring of Mr. Duncan's overall compensation package for services rendered as Chief Executive Officer and as a director is done to ensure that Mr. Duncan is not being doubly compensated for the same services rendered to the Company.
 
 
Retirement and Welfare BenefitsGCI 401(k) Plan.  Named Executive Officers may, along with our employees generally, participate in our GCI 401(k) Plan in which we may provide matching contributions in accordance with the terms of the plan.

We initially adopted our qualified employee stock purchase plan effective in January 1987.  It has been subsequently amended from time to time and presently is our GCI 401(k) Plan.  The plan is qualified under Section 401 of the Internal Revenue Code.  All of our employees (excluding employees subject to a collective bargaining agreement) who have completed at least one year of service are eligible to participate in the plan.  An eligible highly compensated employee (earning more than $110,000 within the prior year) may elect to contribute up to 12% of such compensation to the employee's account in the plan.  Otherwise, an eligible employee may elect to contribute up to 50% of such compensation.  In both cases, these contributions are up to a maximum per employee of $16,500 for 2011.  Participants over the age of 50 may make additional elective deferral contributions to their accounts in the plan of up to $5,500 for 2011.

Subject to certain limitations, we may make matching contributions to our GCI 401(k) Plan for the benefit of employees.  Matching contributions will vest in accordance with a six-year schedule if the employee completes at least 1,000 hours of service in each year.  Such a contribution will vest in increments over the first six years of employment.  Thereafter, they are fully vested when made.

Except for additional elective contributions made by participants over age 50, the combination of pre-tax elective contributions, Roth 401(k) contributions and our matching contributions for any employee cannot exceed $33,000 for 2011.

Under the terms of our GCI 401(k) Plan, participating eligible employees may direct their contributions to be invested in common stock of the Company and shares of various identified mutual funds.

 
80

 
Our GCI 401(k) Plan is administered through a plan administrator (currently Mr. Lowber, our Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer) and our Plan Committee.  The plan administrator and members of the Plan Committee all are our employees.  The Plan Committee has broad administrative discretion under the terms of the plan.

As of December 31, 2010, there remained 2,209,849 shares of Class A and 463,989 shares of Class B common stock allocated to our GCI 401(k) Plan and available for issuance by us or otherwise acquisition by the plan for the benefit of participants in the plan.

– Deferred Compensation Plan and Arrangements.  The Company provides to certain of our employees, including our executive officers and Named Executive Officers, opportunities to defer certain compensation under our nonqualified, unfunded, deferred compensation plan ("Deferred Compensation Plan").  In addition, we offer to our executive officers and to certain of our Named Executive Officers nonqualified, deferred compensation arrangements more specifically fashioned to the needs of the officer and us ("Deferred Compensation Arrangements").  During 2010, none of our officers participated in the Deferred Compensation Plan.  However, during 2010, two of our officers, both Named Executive Officers, participated in Deferred Compensation Arrangements specifically fashioned to their respective needs.  These Deferred Compensation Arrangements enable these individuals to defer compensation in excess of limits that apply to qualified plans, like our GCI 401(k) Plan, and to pursue other income tax goals which they set for themselves.

Based upon its review of the Deferred Compensation Arrangements, our Compensation Committee concluded that the benefits provided under them are in each case both reasonable and an important tool in retaining the executive officers involved with those arrangements.

– Welfare Benefits.  With the exception of the enhanced long term and short term disability benefits described previously, the Company provided to the Named Executive Officers the same health and welfare benefits provided generally to all other employees of the Company at the same general premium rates as charged to those employees.  The cost of the health and welfare programs is subsidized by the Company for all eligible employees including the Named Executive Officers.

Performance Rewarded –

Our Compensation Program is, in large part, designed to reward individual performance.  What constitutes performance varies from officer to officer, depending upon the nature of the officer's responsibilities.  Consistent with the Compensation Program, the Company identified key business metrics and established defined targets related to those metrics for each Named Executive Officer.  In the case of each Named Executive Officer, the targets were regularly reviewed by management, from time to time, and provided an immediate and clear picture of performance and enabled management to respond quickly to both potential problems as well as potential opportunities.  The Compensation Program also was used to establish and track corresponding applicable targets for individual management employees.

In 2010, the Compensation Program was used in development of each Named Executive Officer's individual performance goals and established incentive compensation targets.  The Compensation Committee evaluated the performance of each of the executive officers and the financial performance of the Company and awarded incentive compensation as described above.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Elements of Compensation – Incentive Compensation Plan."

Our Compensation Committee separately determined to increase the cash component of Mr. Chapados' base salary from $240,000 to $300,000 effective July 1, 2010.  The increase to the cash component of Mr. Chapados' base salary was the first such increase received by Mr. Chapados since 2006.  The Compensation Committee made such increase in recognition of Mr. Chapados' excellent performance and the relatively low position of his salary in the marketplace, as well as the growth in the responsibilities of his position within the Company that have occurred since he joined the Company in 2006.  Mr. Chapados has been instrumental in the acquisition and integration of United Utilities, Inc. United-KUC, Inc. and Unicom, Inc. (collectively, "United Companies") with the Company.  Additionally, Mr. Chapados was a key member of the team that obtained the federal grant to build Terra Southwest, an $88 million project to bring broadband services to rural Alaska.

 
81

 
As described elsewhere in this report, the incentive compensation portion of this Compensation Program for the Four Named Executive Officers was significantly revised late in 2010.  However, no adjustments were made to Mr. Landes' Incentive Compensation Plan during 2010.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Elements of Compensation – Incentive Compensation Plan."

Timing of Equity Awards –

Overview.  Timing of equity awards under our Director Compensation Plan and equity awards under out Compensation Program varies with the plan or portion of that program.  However, the Company does not, and has not in the past, timed its release of material nonpublic information for purposes of affecting the value of equity compensation.  Timing issues and our grant policy are described further below.

Director Compensation Plan.  As a part of the Director Compensation Plan, we grant awards of our common stock to board members, including those persons who may be also serving as one or more of our executive officers.  Mr. Duncan, a board member and Named Executive Officer, has been granted such awards in the past.  These awards are made annually in June of each year in accordance with the terms of the Director Compensation Plan.  The awards are made through our Stock Option Plan.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Elements of Compensation – Stock Option Plan."

Incentive Compensation Plan.  As a part of our Compensation Program, from time to time, we grant stock options and awards in our Class A common stock to our executive officers, including the Named Executive Officers.  In particular, stock options and awards are granted in conjunction with the agreements that we enter into with Named Executive Officers pursuant to our Incentive Compensation Plan.  The grants of such options and awards are typically made early in the year at the time our board finalizes the prior year incentive compensation plan payouts for each of the Named Executive Officers.  All such options and awards are granted through the Stock Option Plan.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Elements of Compensation – Incentive Compensation Plan" and "– Elements of Compensation – Stock Option Plan."

Stock Option Plan.  As a part of our Compensation Program, from time to time, we grant stock options or awards in our Class A common stock to our executive officers, including the Named Executive Officers, and to certain of our advisors.  In the case of an executive officer, these options or awards may be granted regardless of whether there is in place an agreement entered into with the officer under our Incentive Compensation Plan.  In the case of a new hire and where we choose to grant options or awards, the grant may be done at the time of hire.  Under the Stock Option Plan, the Compensation Committee may set the exercise price for our Class A common stock at not less than its fair market value.  That value is presently determined on Nasdaq.  In all cases, regardless of the identity of the grantee, the timing, amount and other terms of the grant of options or awards under our Stock Option Plan are determined in the sole discretion of our Compensation Committee.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Elements of Compensation – Stock Option Plan."

In the event an executive level employee is hired or promoted during a year, that employee may be eligible to receive an equity option under the plans previously described in this section.  Grants of options in this context may be made at the recommendation of management and only with action of the Compensation Committee.

Grant Policy.  Under our grant policy, all approved grants are granted effective the date they were approved by the committee and are priced at the market value at the close of trading on that date.  The terms of the award are then communicated immediately to the recipient.

Tax and Accounting Treatment of Executive Compensation –
 
In determining the amount and form of compensation granted to executive officers, including the Named Executive Officers, the Company takes into consideration both tax treatment and accounting treatment of the compensation.  Tax and accounting treatment for various forms of compensation is subject to changes in, and changing interpretations of, applicable laws, regulations, rulings and other factors not within the Company's control.  As a result, tax and accounting treatment is only one of several factors that the Company takes into account in designing the previously described elements of compensation.

Compensation Policies and Practices in Relation to Our Risk Management –

At the direction of our board, Company management has reviewed our compensation policies, plans and practices to determine whether they create incentives or encourage behavior that is reasonably likely to have
 
 
82

 
a materially adverse effect on the Company.  This effort included a review of our various employee compensation plans and practices as described elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Process."

The purpose of the review was to evaluate risks and the internal controls we have implemented to manage those risks.  The controls include multiple performance metrics, corporate-wide financial measures, statutory clawbacks on equity awards, and board and board committee oversight and approvals.

In completing this review, our board and management believe risks created by our compensation policies, plans and practices that create incentives likely to have a material adverse effect on us are remote.

Shareholder Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation

The agenda for the 2011 annual meeting will include for the first time an opportunity for our shareholders to adopt two proposals pertaining to executive compensation of our Named Executive Officers and frequency of shareholder advisory votes on executive compensation for our named executive officers as identified in our management proxy statements, i.e., an option of every one, two or three years.  Both votes are advisory only.  That is, they are not binding on the Company or its board.

Our board views decisions as to compensation of Company named executive officers, including but not limited to those for 2010, as its responsibility.  Our board takes this responsibility seriously and has gone to considerable effort to establish and implement a process for determining executive compensation as described elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis."

Our board carefully considers all proposals from our shareholders.  However, in light of its responsibilities to the Company, our board may or may not follow the advice of those shareholder votes.

At present, our board contemplates next placing before our shareholders a proposal of frequency of shareholder advisory votes on executive compensation of our named executive officers at our 2017 annual shareholder meeting.

Executive Compensation

Summary Compensation Table –

As of December 31, 2010, the Company did not have employment agreements with any of the Named Executive Officers.  The following table summarizes total compensation paid or earned by each Named Executive Officer for fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008.  The process followed by the Compensation Committee in establishing total compensation for each Named Executive Officer as set forth in the table is described elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis."
 
 
83

 
Summary Compensation Table

Name and
Principal Position
Year
Salary1
($)
Bonus
($)
Nonequity Incentive Plan
Compen-sation
($)
Stock
Awards2
($)
Option Awards2
($)
Change in Pension Value and Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Earnings3
($)
All Other Compensation
($)4
Total
($)
Ronald A. Duncan5
  President and Chief
  Executive Officer
2010
2009
2008
600,000
600,000
600,000
454,3976
400,000
400,000
725,000
350,000
350,000
33,744
36,500
24,509
433,635
  - - -
  - - -
 - - -
 - - -
 - - -
64,249
84,489
69,229
2,311,025
1,470,989
1,443,738
G. Wilson Hughes
  Executive Vice
  President and
  General Manager
2010
2009
2008
487,500
486,4597
462,5007
185,7176
102,000
103,000
233,333
150,000
100,000
 - - -
32,453
 - - -
- - -
 - - -
438,680
6,153
10,899
7,556
18,238
  25,281
24,268
930,941
807,092
1,136,004
John M. Lowber
  Senior Vice President,
  Chief Financial Officer
  and Secretary/
  Treasurer
2010
2009
2008
728,709
325,000
325,000
116,9446
25,000
103,000
175,000
100,000
100,000
323,251
55,428
 - - -
- - -
 - - -
 - - -
 - - -
 - - -
 646
18,238
25,281
24,268
1,362,142
530,709
552,914
Gregory F. Chapados
  Senior Vice President
2010
2009
2008
270,000
240,000
240,000
95,2546
53,000
104,000
175,000
100,000
100,000
844,750
172,471
- - -
- - -
- - -
438,680
- - -
- - -
- - -
16,456
24,594
43,771
1,401,460
590,065
926,451
Paul E. Landes
  Vice President and General Manager – Consumer  Services
2010
2009
2008
150,000
150,000
150,000
- - -
 - - -
 - - -
726,366
664,671
343,700
- - -
12,842
- - -
- - -
- - -
216,730
- - -
- - -
- - -
20,131
26,933
24,585
896,497
854,446
735,015


1
For 2008 and 2009, salary includes deferred compensation of $225,000 and $65,000 for Messrs. Hughes and Lowber, respectively.  For 2010, salary includes deferred compensation of $125,000 for Mr. Hughes and $468,709 for Mr. Lowber of which $403,709 for Mr. Lowber reflects the vesting of a multi-year retention agreement.

2
This column reflects the grant date fair values of awards of Class A common stock, restricted stock awards or stock options granted in the fiscal year indicated which were computed in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") Accounting Standards Codification Topic 718, Compensation – Stock Options ("ASC Topic 718"). Assumptions used in the calculation of these amounts are set forth in Footnote 9 of "Part II – Item 8 – Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data."

3
The amount shown represents the above-market earnings on nonqualified deferred compensation plan balances. Above market-earnings is defined as earnings in excess of 120% of the long-term monthly applicable federal rate (AFR).

4
See, "Components of 'All Other Compensation'" table displayed below for more detail.

5
In 2008, Mr. Duncan received $64,509 in compensation relating to his service on our board including $40,000 in board fees and stock awards valued at $24,509.  In 2009, Mr. Duncan received $76,500 in compensation for service on our board in the form of director fees of $40,000 and stock awards valued at $36,500.  In 2010, Mr. Duncan received $73,744 in compensation relative to his service on our board including $40,000 in board fees and stock awards valued at $33,744.

6
The Bonus Compensation represents compensation paid pursuant to the Incentive Compensation Plan in excess of the maximum payment under the plan.

 
 
84

 

 
7
For 2008 and 2009, includes $37,500 for Mr. Hughes representing the amount vested during each of 2008 and 2009 pursuant to prepaid retention agreements.
 
 

The amounts reported under the "All Other Compensation" column are comprised of the following:

Components of "All Other Compensation"

Name and
Principal Position
Year
Stock Purchase
Plan1
($)
Board
Fees
($)
Success Sharing2
($)
Use of Company Leased
Aircraft3
($)
Miscellan-
eous4
($)
Total
($)
Ronald A. Duncan
2010
2009
2008
13,490
23,334
23,000
40,000
40,000
40,000
- - -
- - -
 - - -
10,759
21,155
6,229
          - - -
          - - -
          - - -
64,249
84,489
69,229
G. Wilson Hughes
2010
2009
2008
15,334
23,334
23,000
- - -
 - - -
 - - -
2,904
1,947
1,268
 - - -
 - - -
 - - -
          - - -
          - - -
          - - -
18,238
25,281
24,268
John M. Lowber
2010
2009
2008
15,334
23,334
23,000
- - -
- - -
- - -
2,904
1,947
1,268
- - -
 - - -
 - - -
          - - -
          - - -
          - - -
18,238
25,281
24,268
Gregory F. Chapados
2010
2009
2008
13,552
22,647
21,670
- - -
- - -
- - -
2,904
1,947
1,268
- - -
- - -
- - -
          - - -
          - - -
     20,0004
16,456
24,594
43,771
Paul E. Landes
2010
2009
2008
16,500
24,500
23,000
- - -
 - - -
 - - -
3,631
2,433
1,585
- - -
 - - -
 - - -
          - - -
          - - -
          - - -
20,131
26,933
24,585



1
Amounts are contributions by us matching each employee's contribution.  Matching contributions by us under our GCI 401(k) Plan are available to each of our full time employees with over one year of service.  During 2010, the match was based upon the lesser of $16,500 ($24,500 for 2009 and $23,000 for 2008), 10% of the employee's salary and the total of the employee's pre-tax and post-tax contributions to the plan.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Elements of Compensation – Retirement and Welfare Benefits – GCI 401(k) Plan."  The match for 2010 is reduced by an estimated amount that will be returned to us following completion of the annual discrimination tests.

2
The value for 2010 is based upon an estimate that is to be finalized subsequent to the filing of this report.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Elements of Compensation – Perquisites."

3
The value of use of Company leased aircraft are shown at variable cost to the Company.

4
Includes for Mr. Chapados vesting of a $20,000 portion of a $100,000 signing bonus received in 2006.
 
 
 
 
 
85

 
Grants of Plan-Based Awards Table –

The following table displays specific information on grants of options, awards and non-equity incentive plan awards under our Compensation Program and, in addition, in the case of Mr. Duncan, our Director Compensation Plan, made to Named Executive Officers during 2010.

Grants of Plan-Based Awards

Name
Grant Date
Estimated Future Payouts
Under
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Awards
 
Estimated Future Payouts
Under
Equity Incentive Plan Awards
All Other
Stock
Awards:
Number of
Shares
of Stock
or Units
All Other
Option
Awards:
Number of Securities
Underlying
Options
Exercise
or Base
Price of
Option
Awards
($/Sh)
Grant Date
Fair Value of Stock and Option Awards1
($)
   
Threshold
($)
Target
($)2
Maximum
($)3
 
Threshold
(#)
Target
(#)
Maximum
(#)
(#)
(#)
   
Ronald A. Duncan
02/08/10
06/01/10
10/07/105
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
3,600,000
- - -
- - -
4,300,000
 
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
  - - -
    5,7004
- - -
150,000
- - -
- - -
5.32
- - -
- - -
 433,635
   33,744
- - -
G. Wilson Hughes
10/07/10
- - -
1,200,000
1,700,000
 
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
John M. Lowber
02/08/10
10/07/105
- - -
- - -
- - -
1,100,000
- - -
1,500,000
 
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
14,098
25,000
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
  75,001
248,250
Gregory F. Chapados
02/08/10
10/07/105
- - -
- - -
- - -
1,100,000
- - -
1,500,000
 
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
18,797
75,000
- - -
- - -
100,000
744,250
Paul E. Landes
10/07/105
- - -
- - -
- - -
 
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -


1
Computed in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718.

2
Represents target cash payout under our Incentive Compensation Plan for 2010 through 2013 (except for Mr. Landes, who was not provided with a target payout).  Actual amounts paid with respect to 2010 are included in the "Non-Equity Plan Compensation" and "Bonus" columns of the Summary Compensation Table above.  Although a target payout is provided and certain performance goals are established, the Compensation Committee retains complete discretionary authority to adjust the compensation paid at the end of the year.  The business measurements and performance goals evaluated by the Compensation Committee for determining the payout amounts are described above under "Compensation Discussion and Analysis – Elements of Compensation – Incentive Compensation Plan."

3
Represents maximum cash payout under our Incentive Compensation Plan for 2010 through 2013.  Although a maximum payout is provided, the Compensation Committee retains complete discretionary authority to change the maximum payout.

4
Mr. Duncan's stock award was granted pursuant to the terms of our Director Compensation Plan.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Director Compensation."

5
The Incentive Compensation Plan will be paid to the Named Executive Officer in the form of cash and restricted stock grants.  The restricted grants are not reflected as there is no grant date per FASB ASC Topic 718.  The restricted stock grant will be disclosed in future years when the shares are granted.


 
86

 
Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End Table –

The following table displays specific information on unexercised options, stock that has not vested and equity incentive plan awards for each of the Named Executive Officers and outstanding as of December 31, 2010.  Vesting of these options and awards varies for the Named Executive Officers as described in the footnotes to the table.

Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End

Name
Option Awards1
Stock Awards
Number of Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options
(#)
Exercisable
Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options (#) Unexercisable
Option
Exercise
Price
($)
Option
Expiration
Date
Number of Shares or
Units of Stock
That Have Not
Vested (#)
Market Value
of Shares or
Units of Stock
that Have
Not Vested
     ($)
Equity Incentive Plan Awards:  Number of Unearned Shares, Units or Other Rights That Have Not Vested (#)
Equity Incentive Plan Awards:  Market or Payout Value of Unearned Shares, Units or Other Rights That Have Not Vested ($)
Ronald A. Duncan
    150,000
    250,000
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
   150,000
       - - -
7.25
8.40
5.32
- - -
02/08/12
06/24/14
02/08/20
- - -
        - - -
        - - -
        - - -
     75,0002
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
   949,5002
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
G. Wilson Hughes
       - - -
       - - -
- - -
- - -
   218,2993
 2,763,6653
       - - -
       - - -
John M. Lowber
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
- - -
 - - -
 - - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
   226,0783
     14,0984
     25,0005
 2,862,1483
    178,4814
    316,5005
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
Gregory F. Chapados
    30,000
    50,000
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
    50,000
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
6.00
7.95
     - - -
     - - -
     - - -
     - - -
02/10/13
01/09/18
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
      - - -
      - - -
    18,7974
    25,0006
    50,0007
  136,7193
      - - -
       - - -
   237,9704
   316,5006
   633,0007
1,730,8633
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
       - - -
Paul E. Landes
       - - -
       - - -
- - -
- - -
    56,1933
   711,4033
       - - -
       - - -


1  
Stock option awards generally vest over five years and expire ten years from grant date, except as noted in the footnotes below.

2  
Stock Award vests on February 19, 2011.

3  
Restricted stock vests 50% on December 20, 2011 and 50% on February 28, 2012.

4  
Restricted stock vests on February 8, 2013.

5  
Restricted stock vests on December 31, 2013.

6  
Restricted stock vests 5,000 shares on October 7 of 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014 and 2015.

7  
Restricted stock vests on October 7, 2015.


 
87

 
Option Exercises and Stock Vested Table –

The following table displays specific information on each exercise of stock options, stock appreciation rights, and similar instruments, and each vesting of stock, including restricted stock, restricted stock units and similar instruments on an aggregate basis, for each of the Named Executive Officers during 2010:

Option Exercises and Stock Vested

 
Option Awards
 
Stock Awards
Name
Number of Shares
Acquired on Exercise (#)
Value Realized on Exercise
($)
 
Number of Shares
Acquired on Vesting (#)
Value Realized on Vesting
($)
Ronald A. Duncan
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
 
   5,7001
75,000
  33,744
428,250
G. Wilson Hughes
- - -
- - -
 
- - -
- - -
John M. Lowber
- - -
- - -
 
- - -
- - -
Gregory F. Chapados
- - -
- - -
 
- - -
- - -
Paul E. Landes
- - -
- - -
 
- - -
- - -



1
This stock award relates to Mr. Duncan's service as one of our directors.


Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control

As of December 31, 2010, there were no compensatory plans or arrangements providing for payments to any of the Named Executive Officers in conjunction with any termination of employment or other working relationship of such an officer with us (including without limitation, resignation, severance, retirement or constructive termination of employment of the officer).  Furthermore, as of December 31, 2010, there were no such plans or arrangements providing for payments to any of the Named Executive Officers in conjunction with a change of control of us or a change in such an officer's responsibilities to us.  However, all outstanding options and awards for each of our Named Executive Officers would vest upon his or her disability, retirement or death, or a change-in-control of the Company.

Nonqualified Deferred Compensation

Deferred Compensation Plan –

We established our Deferred Compensation Plan in 1995 to provide a means by which certain of our employees may elect to defer receipt of designated percentages or amounts of their compensation and to provide a means for certain other deferrals of compensation.  Employees eligible to participate in our Deferred Compensation Plan are determined by our board.  We may, at our discretion, contribute matching deferrals in amounts as we select.

Participants immediately vest in all elective deferrals and all income and gain attributable to that participation.  Matching contributions and all income and gain attributable to them vest on a case-by-case basis as determined by us.  Participants may elect to be paid in either a single lump-sum payment or annual installments over a period not to exceed ten years.  Vested balances are payable upon termination of employment, unforeseen emergencies, death or total disability of the participant or change of control of us or our insolvency.  Participants become our general unsecured creditors with respect to deferred compensation benefits of our Deferred Compensation Plan.

None of our Named Executive Officers participated in our Deferred Compensation Plan during 2010.

 
88

 
Deferred Compensation Arrangements –

We have, from time to time, entered into Deferred Compensation Arrangements with certain of our executive officers, including two of the Named Executive Officers.  These arrangements are negotiated with individual officers on a case-by-case basis.  The status of our Deferred Compensation Arrangements with our Named Executive Officers during 2010 is summarized for each of our Named Executive Officers in the following table, and further descriptions of them are provided following the table.

Nonqualified Deferred Compensation

Name
Executive
Contributions
in Last FY
($)
Registrant
Contribution
in Last FY
($)
Aggregate
Earnings (Loss)
in Last FY
($)
Aggregate
Withdrawals/
Distributions
($)
Aggregate
Balance
at Last FY
($)
Ronald A. Duncan
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
G. Wilson Hughes1
125,000
- - -
1,446,364
- - -
3,869,939
John M. Lowber
  65,000
403,709
    56,312
200,000
1,150,707
Gregory F. Chapados
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
Paul E. Landes
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -
- - -


1
Includes earnings of $6,153 for Mr. Hughes that is reported in the Summary Compensation Table.
 
 

Mr. Hughes' Deferred Compensation Arrangement with us consists of three components.  The first component consisted of deferred compensation invested in 217,300 shares of Company Class A common stock.  The second component is $568,921 accrued at year end of which $125,000 in salary were deferred and $51,720 of interest were accrued during 2010.  This arrangement with us earns interest at the rate of 10% per year based upon the balance at the beginning of the year plus new salary deferrals during the year.  The third component is $550,000 accrued at year end of which $30,000 were accrued for 2010 interest.  This arrangement earns interest at 7.5% per year based upon the original $400,000 that was given to Mr. Hughes in consideration for his continued employment at the Company from January 1, 2006 through December 31, 2009.

Mr. Hughes' Deferred Compensation Arrangement provides that at his discretion or at termination of employment, he is entitled to receive the full amount owed in a lump sum, in monthly installments paid over a ten-year period, or in installments negotiated with the Company in accordance with statutory requirements.

Mr. Lowber's Deferred Compensation Arrangement with us consists of deferred salary which earns interest on the amounts deferred at 9% per year.  As of December 31, 2010 and under this plan, there were accrued $746,998, of which $121,312 had accrued ($65,000 in principal plus $56,312 in interest) and $200,000 had been paid out during 2010.  Additionally, effective January 1, 2007, the Company agreed to enter into a retention agreement with Mr. Lowber.  In exchange for his commitment to remain in the employ of the Company through the end of 2010, the Company agreed to establish a deferred compensation account in the amount of $350,000 that vested on December 31, 2010.  The account is to accrue interest at the rate of 7.25% per annum, compounding annually.  The balance in that account was $403,709 as of December 31, 2010.

Messrs. Duncan, Chapados and Landes did not participate in a Deferred Compensation Arrangement with us during 2010.

Other than the Deferred Compensation Arrangements described above, no Named Executive Officer was, as of December 31, 2010, entitled to defer any additional consideration.  Any additional Deferred Compensation Arrangements would have to be separately negotiated with, and agreed to by, the Compensation Committee.

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

 
89

 
Our Compensation Committee is composed of seven members of our board as identified elsewhere in this report.  All of these members served on the committee during all of 2010.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Compensation Discussion and Analysis:  Overview."  The relationships of them to us are described elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 10 – Identification," "Part III – Item 12 – Principal Shareholders" and "Part III – Item 13 – Certain Transactions."

Compensation Committee Report

The Compensation Committee has reviewed and discussed with management the Compensation Discussion and Analysis.  Based upon that review and discussion, the Compensation Committee recommended to our board that the Compensation Discussion and Analysis be included in our 2010 annual report.

Compensation Committee
Stephen M. Brett, Chair
Jerry A. Edgerton
Scott M. Fisher
William P. Glasgow
Mark W. Kroloff
Stephen R. Mooney
James M. Schneider

Director Compensation

The following table sets forth certain information concerning the cash and non-cash compensation earned by our directors ("Director Compensation Plan"), each for services as a director during the year ended December 31, 2010:

2010 Director Compensation1

Name
 
Fees
Earned
or
Paid in
Cash
($)
   
Stock
Awards2,3
($)
   
Option
Awards3
($)
   
Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($)
   
Change in
Pension
Value and
 Nonqualified
Deferred
Compensation
Earnings
($)
   
All Other
Compensation
($)
   
Total
($)
 
Stephen M. Brett
    40,000       33,744       - - -       - - -       - - -       - - -       73,744  
Jerry A. Edgerton
    40,000       33,744       - - -       - - -       - - -       - - -       73,744  
Scott M. Fisher
    40,000       33,744       - - -       - - -       - - -       - - -       73,744  
William P. Glasgow
    50,000       33,744       - - -       - - -       - - -       - - -       83,744  
Mark W. Kroloff
    40,000       33,744       - - -       - - -       - - -       - - -       73,744  
Stephen R. Mooney
    50,000       33,744       - - -       - - -       - - -       - - -       83,744  
James M. Schneider
    50,000       42,624       - - -       - - -       - - -       - - -       92,624  


1
Compensation to Mr. Duncan as a director is described elsewhere in this report.  See "Part III – Item 11 – Executive Compensation" and "Compensation Discussion and Analysis."

2
Each director received a grant of awards of 5,700 shares of Company Class A common stock on June 1, 2010, with the exception of our Audit Committee chair (Mr. Schneider) who received 7,200 shares.  The value of the shares on the date of grant was $5.92 per share, i.e., the closing price of the stock on Nasdaq on that date and as required in accordance with GAAP.

3
This column reflects the grant date fair values of awards of Class A common stock, restricted stock awards or stock options granted in the fiscal year indicated which were computed in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718. Assumptions used in the calculation of these amounts are set forth in Footnote 9 of "Part II – Item 8 – Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data."
 
 
 
 
 
90

 
Our initial Director Compensation Plan was adopted in 2004 by our board to acknowledge and compensate, from time to time, directors on the board for ongoing dedicated service.  During 2010, the plan provided for $40,000 per year (prorated for days served and paid quarterly) plus $10,000 per year for each director serving on our Audit Committee.

During 2010, the stock compensation portion of our Director Compensation Plan consisted of a grant of 5,700 shares to a director for a year of service, or a portion of a year of service.  Grants are made and vest annually under the plan on June 1 of each year.  For 2010, grants of awards were made under our Director Compensation Plan as of June 1, 2010.  As of December 31, 2010, our board anticipated that grants of awards of 5,400 shares of Class A common stock to each director would be made under the plan as of June 1, 2011.  Also as of that date, our board anticipated an additional award of 1,500 shares of Class A common stock to our Audit Committee chair.  Because the shares vest upon award, they are subject to taxation based upon the then fair market value of the vested shares.

Under our Director Compensation Plan, compensation is to be paid only to those directors who are to receive the benefit individually, whether or not they are our employees.

Except for our Director Compensation Plan, during 2010 the directors on our board received no other direct compensation for serving on the board and its committees.  However, they were reimbursed for travel and out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with attendance at meetings of our board and its committees.  The director fee structure as described in this section continued otherwise unchanged through December 31, 2010.

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans

The following table sets forth, as of the end of 2010, information on equity compensation plans approved by our shareholders and separately such plans not approved by our shareholders.  The information is focused on outstanding options, warrants and rights, and so the only such plan is our Stock Option Plan as approved by our shareholders.

Equity Compensation Plan Information

Plan category
Number of securities
to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options, warrants and rights
Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
($)
Number of securities
remaining available for future issuance under equity compensation plans (excluding securities reflected in the second column)
Equity compensation
plans approved by
security holders
1,249,050
7.08
4,180,226
Equity compensation
plans not approved by
security holders
- - -
- - -
- - -
Total:
1,249,050
7.08
4,180,226

Ownership of Company

Principal Shareholders –

The following table sets forth, as of December 31, 2010 (unless otherwise noted), certain information regarding the beneficial ownership of our Class A common stock and Class B common stock by each of the following:
 
 
91

 

 
·  
Each person known by us to own beneficially 5% or more of the outstanding shares of Class A common stock or Class B common stock.

·  
Each of our directors.

·  
Each of the Named Executive Officers.

·  
All of our executive officers and directors as a group.

All information with respect to beneficial ownership has been furnished to us by the respective shareholders.

 
 
 
 
Name of
Beneficial Owner1
 
 
 
 
Title of
Class2
 
Amount and
Nature of
Beneficial
Ownership
(#)
 
 
 
 
 
% of Class
 
 
% of Total Shares Outstanding
 (Class A & B)2
 
 
% Combined
Voting
Power
(Class A & B)2
 
Stephen M. Brett
 
Class A
Class B
 
      52,3503
        - - -
 
*
- - -
 
*
 
*
 
Ronald A. Duncan
 
Class A
Class B
 
 1,298,0143,4
    661,8094
 
  2.9
20.8
 
 4.1
 
 
10.4
 
 
Jerry A. Edgerton
 
 
Class A
Class B
 
     27,3503
       - - -
 
*
- - -
 
*
 
*
 
Scott M. Fisher
 
Class A
Class B
 
   114,9623,5
   437,6885
 
*
13.8
 
 1.1
 
 5.9
 
William P. Glasgow
 
Class A
Class B
 
     77,2943,6
        - - -
 
*
- - -
 
*
 
*
 
Mark W. Kroloff
 
Class A
Class B
 
     20,7003,7
        - - -
 
*
- - -
 
*
 
*
 
 
Stephen R. Mooney
 
Class A
Class B
 
     38,0003
        - - -
 
*
- - -
 
*
 
*
 
James M. Schneider
 
Class A
Class B
 
     38,2503
         - - -
 
*
- - -
 
*
 
*
 
G. Wilson Hughes
 
 
Class A
Class B
 
   618,0018
       2,695
 
 1.4
*
 
 1.3
 
*
 
 
John M. Lowber
 
Class A
Class B
 
    372,3439
       6,2039
 
*
*
 
*
 
*
 
 
Gregory F. Chapados
 
Class A
Class B
 
    326,43610
        - - -
 
*
*
 
*
 
*
 
 
Paul E. Landes
 
Class A
Class B
 
     92,52911
        - - -
 
*
- - -
 
*
 
*
 
Black Rock, Inc.
55 East 52nd Street
New York, New York 10055
 
Class A
Class B
 
4,345,918
        - - -
 
 
9.8
- - -
 
 9.2
 
5.7
 
GCI 401(k) Plan
2550 Denali St., Ste. 1000
Anchorage, AK 99503
 
Class A
Class B
 
 4,947,356
      62,739
 
11.2
  2.0
 
10.6
 
  7.4
 
Gary Magness
c/o Raymond L. Sutton, Jr.
303 East 17th Ave., Ste 1100
Denver, CO 80203-1264
 
Class A
Class B
 
 
 1,347,961
    433,924
 
 
  3.0
13.7
 
 
  3.8
 
  7.5
 
Private Management
Group, Inc.
20 Corporate Park, Suite 400
Irvine, CA 92606
 
Class A
Class B
 
2,456,852
        - - -
 
 
 5.6
        - - -
 
 
 5.2
 
 3.2
 
 
 
92

 
 
 
John W. Stanton and
Theresa E. Gillespie
155 108th Avenue., N.E.,
Suite 450
Bellevue, WA 98004
 
Class A
Class B
 
2,342,627
1,436,469
 
  5.3
45.2
 
  8.0
 
22.1
 
All Directors and Executive
  Officers As a Group
  (18 Persons)
 
Class A
Class B
 
 
3,626,81512
1,183,15612
 
  8.2
37.2
 
10.0
 
20.3


*
Represents beneficial ownership of less than 1% of the corresponding class or series of stock.

1
Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with Rule 13d-3 of the Exchange Act.  Shares of our stock that a person has the right to acquire within 60 days of December 31, 2010 are deemed to be beneficially owned by such person and are included in the computation of the ownership and voting percentages only of such person.  Each person has sole voting and investment power with respect to the shares indicated, except as otherwise stated in the footnotes to the table.  Addresses are provided only for persons other than management who own beneficially more than 5% of the outstanding shares of Class A or B common stock.

2
"Title of Class" includes our Class A common stock and Class B common stock.  "Amount and Nature of Beneficial Ownership" and "% of Class" are given for each class of stock.  "% of Total Shares Outstanding" and "% Combined Voting Power" are given for the combination of outstanding Class A common stock and Class B common stock, and the voting power for Class B common stock (10 votes per share) is factored into the calculation of that combined voting power.

3
Includes 5,700 shares of our Class A common stock granted to each of those persons pursuant to the Director Compensation Plan for services performed during 2010 except for Mr. Schneider, who received 7,200 shares of our Class A common stock.

4
Includes 153,459 shares of Class A common stock and 6,165 shares of Class B common stock allocated to Mr. Duncan under the GCI 401(k) Plan as of December 31, 2010.  Includes 131 shares of Class A common stock held by Missy, LLC which is 25% owned by Mr. Duncan.  Includes 400,000 shares of Class A common stock subject to stock options granted under the Stock Option Plan to Mr. Duncan which he has the right to acquire within 60 days of December 31, 2010 by exercise of the stock options.  Does not include 35,560 shares of Class A common stock or 8,242 shares of Class B common stock held by the Amanda Miller Trust, with respect to which Mr. Duncan has no voting or investment power.  Ms. Miller is Mr. Duncan's daughter, and Mr. Duncan disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares.   Does not include 30,660 shares of Class A common stock or 27,020 shares of Class B common stock held by Dani Bowman, Mr. Duncan's wife, of which Mr. Duncan disclaims beneficial ownership.  Includes 512,499 shares of Class A common stock and 493,644 shares of Class B common stock pledged as security.

5
Includes 87,512 shares of Class A and 437,688 shares of Class B common stock owned by Fisher Capital Partners, Ltd. of which Mr. Fisher is a partner.

6
Does not include 158 shares owned by a daughter of Mr. Glasgow.  Mr. Glasgow disclaims any beneficial ownership of the shares held by his daughter.

7
Includes 10,000 shares of Class A common stock owned jointly by Mr. Kroloff and his wife.

8
Includes 5,188 shares of Class A common stock allocated to Mr. Hughes under the GCI 401(k) Plan, as of December 31, 2010.  Includes 325,890 shares of Class A common stock pledged as security.  Excludes 217,300 shares held by the Company pursuant to Mr. Hughes' Deferred Compensation Agreement.
 
 
93

 

 
9
Includes 27,834 shares of Class A common stock and 5,933 shares of Class B common stock allocated to Mr. Lowber under the GCI 401(k) Plan, as of December 31, 2010.

10
Includes 15,920 shares of Class A common stock allocated to Mr. Chapados under the GCI 401(k) Plan, as of December 31, 2010.  Includes 80,000 shares of Class A common stock subject to stock options granted under the Stock Option Plan to Mr. Chapados which he has the right to acquire within 60 days of December 31, 2010 by exercise of those options.

11
Includes 36,299 shares of Class A common stock allocated to Mr. Landes under the GCI 401(k) Plan, as of December 31, 2010.

12
Includes 480,000 shares of Class A common stock which such persons have the right to acquire within 60 days of December 31, 2010 through the exercise of vested stock options.  Includes 358,020 shares of Class A common stock and 12,831 shares of Class B common stock allocated to such persons under the GCI 401(k) Plan.
 
 

Changes in Control –

Pledged Assets and Securities.  Our obligations under our credit facilities are secured by substantially all of our assets.  Should there be a default by us under such agreements, our lenders could gain control of our assets.  We have been at all times during 2010 in compliance with all material terms of these credit facilities.

Senior Notes.  In 2004, GCI, Inc., our wholly-owned subsidiary, sold $320 million in aggregate principal amount of senior debt securities due in 2014.

The senior notes are subject to the terms of an indenture entered into by GCI, Inc.  Upon the occurrence of a change of control, as defined in the Indenture, GCI, Inc. is required to offer to purchase those senior notes at a price equal to 101% of their principal amount, plus accrued and unpaid interest.  The indenture provides that those senior notes are redeemable at the option of GCI, Inc. at specified redemption prices commencing in 2009.  The terms of the senior notes contain limitations on the ability of GCI, Inc. and its restricted subsidiaries to incur additional indebtedness, limitations on investments, payment of dividends and other restricted payments and limitations on liens, asset sales, mergers, transactions with affiliates and operation of unrestricted subsidiaries.  The indenture also limits the ability of GCI, Inc. and its restricted subsidiaries to enter into, or allow to exist, specified restrictions on the ability of GCI, Inc. to receive distributions from restricted subsidiaries.

For purposes of the indenture and the senior notes, the restricted subsidiaries consist of all of our direct or indirect subsidiaries, with the exception of certain unrestricted subsidiaries.  Under the terms of the indenture, an unrestricted subsidiary is a subsidiary of GCI, Inc. so designated from time to time in accordance with procedures as set forth in the indenture.  As of December 31, 2010, these unrestricted subsidiaries consisted of the United Companies.

In November 2009, GCI, Inc. issued an additional $425 million of senior notes at 8.625% interest due in November 2019.  The new senior notes have substantially similar terms as the 2004 senior notes.  They were used to pay off senior bank debt and for general corporate purposes.

We and GCI, Inc. have since the issuance of the senior notes and up through December 31, 2010, been in compliance with all material terms of the Indenture including making timely payments on the obligations of GCI, Inc.

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

Certain Transactions

Transactions with Related Persons –

Stanton Shareholdings, Registration Rights Agreement.  As of December 31, 2010, John W. Stanton and Theresa E. Gillespie, husband and wife (collectively, "Stantons"), continued to be significant shareholders of our Class B common stock.  As of that date, neither the Stantons nor the Stantons' affiliates were our directors, officers, nominees for election as directors, or members of the immediate family of
 
 
94

 
such directors, officers, or nominees.

We are a party to a registration rights agreement ("Stanton Registration Rights Agreement") with the Stantons regarding all unregistered shares the Stantons hold in our Class B common stock and any shares of our Class A common stock resulting from conversion of that Class B common stock to Class A common stock.  The basic terms of the Stanton Registration Rights Agreement are as follows.  If we propose to register any of our securities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended ("Securities Act") for our own account or for the account of one or more of our shareholders, we must notify the Stantons of that intent.  In addition, we must allow the Stantons an opportunity to include the holder's shares ("Stanton Registerable Shares") in that registration.

Under the Stanton Registration Rights Agreement, the Stantons also have the right, under certain circumstances, to require us to register all or any portion of the Stanton Registerable Shares under the Securities Act.  The agreement is subject to certain limitations and restrictions, including our right to limit the number of Stanton Registerable Shares included in the registration.  Generally, we are required to pay all registration expenses in connection with each registration of Stanton Registerable Shares pursuant to this agreement.

The Stanton Registration Rights Agreement specifically states we are not required to effect any registration on behalf of the Stantons regarding Stanton Registerable Shares if the request for registration covers an aggregate number of Stanton Registerable Shares having a market value of less than $1.5 million.  The agreement further states we are not required to effect such a registration for the Stantons where we have at that point previously filed two registration statements with the SEC, or where the registration would require us to undergo an interim audit or prepare and file with the SEC sooner than otherwise required financial statements relating to the proposed transaction.  Finally, the agreement states we are not required to effect such a registration when in the opinion of our legal counsel a registration is not required in order to permit resale under Rule 144 as adopted by the SEC pursuant to the Exchange Act.

The Stanton Registration Rights Agreement provides that the first demand for registration by the Stantons must be for no less than 15% of the total number of Stanton Registerable Shares.  However, the Stantons may take the opportunity to require us to include the Stanton Registerable Shares as incidental to a registered offering proposed by us.

Duncan Leases.  In 1991, we entered into a long-term capital lease agreement with a partnership in which Mr. Duncan held a 50% ownership interest.  Mr. Duncan later sold that interest to an individual who later became his spouse.  However, Mr. Duncan remains a guarantor on the note which was used to finance the acquisition of the property subject to the lease.  The leased asset was capitalized in 1991 at the owner's cost of $900,000 and the related obligation was recorded in the accompanying financial statements.  The lease agreement was amended in 2008, and we have increased our existing capital lease asset and liability by $1.3 million to record the extension of the capital lease.  The amended lease terminates on September 30, 2026.  The property consists of a building presently occupied by us.  As of December 31, 2010, the payments on the lease were $21,532 per month.  They continue at that rate through September 2011.  In October 2011, the payments on the lease will increase to $22,332 per month.

In January 2001, we entered into an aircraft operating lease agreement with a company owned by Mr. Duncan.  The lease agreement is presently month-to-month and may be terminated at any time upon 120 days' prior written notice.  The lease rate is $75,000 per month.  Upon signing the lease, the lessor was granted an option purchase 250,000 shares of Company Class A common stock at $6.50 per share, none of which shares of the option remained or were exercisable at December 31, 2010.  We paid a deposit of $1.5 million in connection with the lease.  The deposit will be repaid to us upon the earlier of six months after the agreement terminates, or nine months after the date of a termination notice.  In December 2010, we paid $350,000 to the lessor for the right to return the aircraft to the lessor in the same condition it was in on December 27, 2010.

ASRC Stock Purchase.  In October 2010, we repurchased 7,486,240 shares of our Class A common stock for $10.16 per share, representing a total purchase price of approximately $76 million

Robert Walp Stock Purchase.  In November and December 2010, we repurchased 201,893 shares of our Class A common stock for $11.10 per share, representing a total purchase price of approximately $2.2 million.

 
95

 
Review Procedure for Transactions with Related Persons –

The following describes our policies and procedures for the review, approval or ratification of transactions in which we are to be a participant and where the amount involved in each instance exceeds $120,000 and in which any related person had or is to have a direct or indirect material interest ("Related Transactions").  Here, we use the term "related person" to mean any person who is one of our directors, a nominee for director, an immediate family member of one of our directors or executive officers, any person who is a holder of five percent or more of a class of our common stock, or any immediate family member of such a holder.

A related person who is one of our officers, directors or employees ("Employee") is subject to our Ethics Code.  The Ethics Code requires the Employee to act in the best interest of the Company and to avoid situations which may conflict with this obligation.  The code specifically provides that a conflict of interest occurs when an Employee's private interest interferes in any way with our interest.  In the event an Employee suspects such a conflict, or even an appearance of conflict, he or she is urged by the Ethics Code to report the matter to an appropriate authority.  The Ethics Code, Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee Charter and the Audit Committee Charter define that authority as being our Chief Financial Officer, the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, the Audit Committee (in the context of suspected illegal or unethical behavior-related violations pertaining to accounting, or internal controls on accounting or audit matters), or the Employee's supervisor within the Company, as the case may be.

The Ethics Code further provides that an Employee is prohibited from taking a personal interest in a business opportunity discovered through use of corporate position, information or property that properly belongs to us.  The Ethics Code also provides that an Employee must not compete with, and in particular, must not use corporate position, information, or property for personal gain or to compete with, us.

The Ethics Code provides that any waiver of its provisions for our executive officers and directors may be made only by our board and must be promptly disclosed to our shareholders.  This disclosure must include an identification of the person who received the waiver, the date of the grant of the waiver by our board, and a brief description of the circumstances and reasons under which it was given.

The Ethics Code is silent as to the treatment of immediate family members of our Employees, holders of five percent or more of a class of our stock, or the immediate family members of them.  We consider such Related Transactions with such persons on a case-by-case basis, if at all, by analogy to existing procedures as above described pertaining to our Employees.

During 2010, there were no Related Transactions.  The leases described previously were entered into prior to the establishment of the Ethics Code.

Director Independence

The term Independent Director as used by us is an individual, other than one of our executive officers or employees, and other than any other individual having a relationship which in the opinion of our board would interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the responsibilities of a director.  See "Part III – Item 10 – Audit Committee, Audit Committee Financial Expert."

Mr. Brett, our Chairman of the Board, while in that capacity an officer under our Bylaws and responsible for the conduct of our board meetings and shareholder meetings when present, is considered by our board to have no greater influence on our affairs or authority to act on behalf of us than any of the non-executive directors on our board.

 
96

 
Our board believes each of its members satisfies the definition of an Independent Director, with the exception of Mr. Duncan who is an officer and employee of the Company.  That is, in the case of all other board members, our board believes each of them is an individual having a relationship which does not interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the member's director responsibilities to us.  

Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services

Overview

On February 7, 2011 our Audit Committee approved the appointment of Grant Thornton as the Company's External Accountant for 2011.  Also on that date, our board ratified that appointment by the Audit Committee.

During the Company's two most recent fiscal years and prior to its initial appointment as the Company’s External Accountant on August 11, 2009, neither the Company nor anyone on its behalf consulted Grant Thornton regarding the application of accounting principles to a specific transaction regarding the Company or the type of audit opinion that might be rendered on the Company's financial statements.  Furthermore during that period, neither the Company nor anyone on its behalf consulted Grant Thornton on any matter regarding the Company that was either the subject of a disagreement or a reportable event under then current SEC rules.

On August 11, 2009, KPMG LLP ("KPMG") was dismissed as the Company's External Accountant based upon the recommendation of our Audit Committee.  The audit reports of KPMG on the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of, and for, the year ended December 31, 2008 and on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008 did not contain any adverse opinion or disclaimer of opinion and were not qualified or modified as to uncertainty, audit scope or accounting principles, except for two matters.

These two matters are as follows.  First, KPMG's report on the Company's consolidated financial statements as of, and for, the year ended December 31, 2008 contained a separate paragraph stating the following:  "As discussed in Note 1(ai) to the financial statements, the Company has elected to change its method of accounting for recording depreciation on their [sic] property and equipment placed in service in 2008."

Second, KPMG's report on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008 indicated that the Company did not maintain effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008 because of the effect of material weaknesses on the achievement of objectives of the control criteria and contained an explanatory paragraph that stated the entity-level control related to the selection and application of accounting policies in accordance with GAAP was not designed to include policies and procedures to review periodically our accounting policies to ensure ongoing compliance with those accounting principles.  That paragraph further stated that the internal control over financial reporting at Alaska DigiTel (a wholly-owned subsidiary) did not include activities adequate to identify timely changes in financial reporting risks, monitor the continued effectiveness of controls and did not include staff with adequate technical expertise to ensure that policies and procedures necessary for reliable interim and annual financial statements were selected and applied.

During 2008 and through August 11, 2009, there were no disagreements with KPMG on any matter of accounting principles or practices, financial statement disclosure or auditing scope or procedure, which disagreements, if not resolved to the satisfaction of KPMG, would have caused it to make reference in connection with its opinion to the subject matter of the disagreement.  Furthermore during that period, there were no reportable events under then current SEC rules, except that KPMG advised the Company that it did not maintain effective internal control over financial reporting because of the effect of material weaknesses on the achievement of the objectives of the control criteria as previously described.

Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures

We have established as policy, through the adoption of the Audit Committee Charter that, before our External Accountant is engaged by us to render audit services, the engagement must be approved by the Audit Committee.

Our Audit Committee Charter provides that our Audit Committee is directly responsible for appointment, compensation, retention, oversight, qualifications and independence of our External Accountant.  Also under
 
 
97

 
our Audit Committee Charter, all audit services provided by our External Accountant must be pre-approved by the Audit Committee.
 
Our pre-approval policies and procedures with respect to Non-Audit Services include as a part of the Audit Committee Charter that the Audit Committee may choose any of the following options for approving such services:

·  
Full Audit Committee The full Audit Committee can consider each Non-Audit Service.

·  
Designee The Audit Committee can designate one of its members to approve a Non-Audit Service, with that member reporting approvals to the full committee.

·  
Pre-Approval of Categories The Audit Committee can pre-approve categories of Non-Audit Services.  Should this option be chosen, the categories must be specific enough to ensure both of the following –

·  
The Audit Committee knows exactly what it is approving and can determine the effect of such approval on auditor independence.

·  
Management will not find it necessary to decide whether a specific service falls within a category of pre-approved Non-Audit Service.

The Audit Committee's pre-approval of Non-Audit Services may be waived under specific provisions of the Audit Committee Charter.  The prerequisites for waiver are as follows: (1) the aggregate amount of all Non-Audit Services constitutes not more than 5% of the total amount of revenue paid by us to our External Accountant during the fiscal year in which those services are provided; (2) the service is originally thought to be a part of an audit by our External Accountant; (3) the service turns out to be a Non-Audit Service; and (4) the service is promptly brought to the attention of the Audit Committee and approved prior to completion of the audit by the committee or by one or more members of the committee who are members of our board to whom authority to grant such approvals has been delegated by the committee.

During 2010, there were no waivers of our Audit Committee pre-approval policy.

Fees and Services

The aggregate fees billed to us by our External Accountant in each of these categories for each of 2010 and 2009 are set forth as follows:

External Accountant Auditor Fees

Type of Fees
20101
Grant Thornton
20092
Grant Thornton
KPMG
Audit Fees3
$1,120,650
$998,350
$998,825
Audit-Related Fees4
16,116
           - - -
19,900
Tax Fees5
134,721
64,211
- - -
All Other Fees6
94,694
   138,600
    134,325
Total
$1,366,181
$1,201,161
$1,153,050



1
Grant Thornton was our External Accountant for this year.

2
KPMG was our External Accountant up to August 11, 2009, and Grant Thornton was our External Accountant for the balance of that year.  KPMG fees include charges subsequent to its dismissal.

3
Consists of fees for our annual financial statement audit, quarterly financial statement reviews, reviews of other filings by us with the SEC, audit of our internal control over financial reporting and for services that are normally provided by an auditor in connection with statutory and regulatory filings or engagements.  The audit fees included in the 2009 KPMG column include charges for our 2008 annual financial statement audit that were not previously reported.
 
 
98

 

 
4
Consists of fees for audit of the GCI 401(k) Plan and review of the related annual report on Form 11-K filed with the SEC.

5
Consists of fees for review of our state and federal income tax returns and consultation on various tax advice and tax planning matters.

6
Consists of fees for any services not included in the first three types of fees identified in the table.  In 2009, these fees were limited to ones pertaining to agreed upon procedures relating, in the case of Grant Thornton, totally to our debt refinancing effort, and relating, in the case of KPMG, primarily to that effort.
 
 

All of the services described above were approved in conformity with the Audit Committee's pre-approval policy.


 
99

 

Part IV

Item 15. Exhibits, Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules

       
(I)  Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Page No.
 
       
         Included in Part II of this Report:
     
       
Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms
    101  
         
Consolidated Balance Sheets, December 31, 2010 and 2009
    104  
         
Consolidated Statements of Operations, years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
    106  
         
Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity, years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
    107  
         
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
    108  
         
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
    109  
         
(2)  Consolidated Financial Statement Schedules
       
         
Schedules are omitted, as they are not required or are not applicable, or the required information is shown in the applicable financial statements or notes thereto.
       
         
(3) Exhibits
    147  

 
100

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 

 
Board of Directors and Shareholders
General Communication, Inc.

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries (an Alaska corporation) (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2010. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the two years ended December 31, 2010, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) and our report dated March 14, 2011, expressed an adverse opinion thereon.

(signed) Grant Thornton LLP

Seattle, Washington
March 14, 2011

 
101

 


 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
The Board of Directors and Stockholders
General Communication, Inc.:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows of General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries (the Company) for the year ended December 31, 2008. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the results of operations and cash flows of General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries for the year ended December 31, 2008, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

(signed) KPMG LLP

Anchorage, Alaska
 
March 20, 2009 except for Note 13,
 
as to which the date is March 12, 2010

 
102

 


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
Board of Directors and Shareholders
General Communication, Inc.

We have audited General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries’ (an Alaska Corporation) (the “Company”)  internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).  The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.  Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances.  We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

A material weakness is a deficiency, or combination of control deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of the company’s annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. The following material weakness has been identified and included in management’s assessment.  The Company’s internal controls in the financial reporting process related to the USF high cost program support revenue accrual were inadequately designed.  In our opinion, because of the effect of the material weakness described above on the achievement of the objectives of the control criteria, General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries has not maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by COSO.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of General Communication, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2010.  The material weakness identified above was considered in determining the nature, timing, and extent of audit tests applied in our audit of the 2010 financial statements, and this report does not affect our report dated March 14, 2011, which expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.

(signed) Grant Thornton LLP

Seattle, Washington
March 14, 2011

 
103

 
 

 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
(Amounts in thousands)
 
December 31,
 
ASSETS
 
2010
   
2009
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
Current assets:
 
 
   
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 33,070       48,776  
 
               
Receivables
    132,856       147,859  
Less allowance for doubtful receivables
    9,189       7,060  
Net receivables
    123,667       140,799  
 
               
Deferred income taxes
    10,145       17,618  
Prepaid expenses
    5,950       4,491  
Inventories
    5,804       9,278  
Other current assets
    3,940       5,872  
Total current assets
    182,576       226,834  
 
               
Property and equipment in service, net of depreciation
    798,278       823,080  
Construction in progress
    31,144       26,161  
Net property and equipment
    829,422       849,241  
 
               
Cable certificates
    191,635       191,565  
Goodwill
    73,932       73,452  
Wireless licenses
    25,967       25,967  
Other intangible assets, net of amortization
    17,717       19,561  
Deferred loan and senior notes costs, net of amortization
  of $6,469 and $4,662 at December 31, 2010 and 2009,
  respectively
    13,661       13,168  
Other assets
    16,850       18,609  
Total other assets
    339,762       342,322  
Total assets
  $ 1,351,760       1,418,397  
 
               
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
 
               
 
               
 
               
 
         
(Continued)
 

 
104

 


GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
(Continued)
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
(Amounts in thousands)
 
December 31,
 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
 
2010
   
2009
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
Current liabilities:
 
 
   
 
 
Current maturities of obligations under long-term debt and
  capital leases
  $ 7,652       9,892  
Accounts payable
    35,589       30,697  
Deferred revenue
    17,296       21,404  
Accrued payroll and payroll related obligations
    22,132       21,874  
Accrued interest
    13,456       14,821  
Accrued liabilities
    12,557       15,037  
Subscriber deposits
    1,271       1,549  
Total current liabilities
    109,953       115,274  
 
               
Long-term debt, net
    779,201       771,247  
Obligations under capital leases, excluding current maturities
    84,144       89,279  
Obligation under capital lease due to related party
    1,885       1,876  
Deferred income taxes
    102,401       100,386  
Long-term deferred revenue
    49,175       52,342  
Other liabilities
    24,495       21,676  
Total liabilities
    1,151,254       1,152,080  
 
               
Commitments and contingencies
               
Stockholders’ equity:
               
Common stock (no par):
               
Class A. Authorized 100,000 shares; issued 44,213 and
               
51,899 shares at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively; outstanding 43,958 and 51,627 shares at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively
    69,396       150,911  
Class B. Authorized 10,000 shares; issued and
               
outstanding 3,178 and 3,186 shares at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively; convertible on a share-per-share basis into Class A common stock
    2,677       2,684  
Less cost of 255 and 272 Class A and Class B common
               
shares held in treasury at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively
    (2,249 )     (2,339 )
Paid-in capital
    37,075       30,410  
Retained earnings
    93,607       84,651  
Total stockholders’ equity
    200,506       266,317  
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
  $ 1,351,760       1,418,397  
 
               
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 

 
105

 
 

GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
 
YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 2010, 2009, AND 2008
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
(Amounts in thousands, except per share amounts)
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Revenues
  $ 651,250       595,811       575,442  
Cost of goods sold (exclusive of depreciation and
                       
amortization shown separately below)
    207,817       193,676       203,058  
Selling, general and administrative expenses
    228,808       212,671       210,306  
Depreciation and amortization expense
    126,114       123,362       114,369  
 Operating income
    88,511       66,102       47,709  
 
                       
Other income (expense):
                       
Interest expense (including amortization and write-off
                       
of deferred loan fees)
    (70,329 )     (58,761 )     (50,363 )
Interest and investment income
    261       111       576  
Other
    -       -       (217 )
 Other expense, net
    (70,068 )     (58,650 )     (50,004 )
   Income (loss) before income tax expense
    18,443       7,452       (2,295 )
Income tax expense
    9,488       3,936       1,077  
 
                       
   Net income (loss)
    8,955       3,516       (3,372 )
Net loss attributable to the non-controlling interest
    -       -       1,503  
  Net income (loss) attributable to General
   Communication, Inc.
  $ 8,955       3,516       (1,869 )
Basic net income (loss) attributable to General
  Communication, Inc. common stockholders per Class A
  common share
  $ 0.17       0.07       (0.04 )
Basic net income (loss) attributable to General
  Communication, Inc. common stockholders per Class B
  common share
  $ 0.17       0.07       (0.04 )
Diluted net income (loss) attributable to General
  Communication, Inc. common stockholders per Class A
  common share
  $ 0.17       0.06       (0.04 )
Diluted net income (loss) attributable to General
  Communication, Inc. common stockholders per Class B
  common share
  $ 0.17       0.06       (0.04 )
 
                       
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements
         

 
106

 
 
 

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
 
YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2010, 2009 AND 2008
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
Class A Common Stock
   
Class B Common Stock
   
Class A and B Shares Held in Treasury
   
Paid-in Capital
   
Retained Earnings
   
Non-controlling Interest
   
Total Stockholders’ Equity
 
 
(Amounts in thousands)
Balances at January 1, 2008
    155,980       2,751       (3,448 )     20,132       77,540       6,478       259,433  
Net loss
    -       -       -       -       (1,869 )     (1,503 )     (3,372 )
Acquisition of remaining shares of
  non-controlling interest
    -       -       -       -       -       (4,975 )     (4,975 )
Common stock retirements
    (5,465 )     -       -       -       5,465       -       -  
Shares issued under stock option
  plan
    415       -       -       -       -       -       415  
Issuance of restricted stock
  awards
    331       -       -       (331 )     -       -       -  
Share-based compensation
  expense
    -       -       -       7,432       -       -       7,432  
Reclassification from treasury
  stock to be held for general
  corporate purposes to common
  stock to be retired
    -       -       960       -       (960 )     -       -  
Other
    1       (45 )     26       -       -       -       (18 )
Balances at December 31, 2008
    151,262       2,706       (2,462 )     27,233       80,176       -       258,915  
Net income
    -       -       -       -       3,516       -       3,516  
Common stock retirements
    (950 )     (9 )     9       -       950       -       -  
Shares issued under stock option
  plan
    423       -       -       -       -       -       423  
Issuance of restricted stock
  awards
    398       -       -       (398 )     -       -       -  
Share-based compensation
  expense
    -       -       -       3,575       -       -       3,575  
Other
    (222 )     (13 )     114       -       9       -       (112 )
Balances at December 31, 2009
    150,911       2,684       (2,339 )     30,410       84,651       -       266,317  
Net income
    -       -       -       -       8,955       -       8,955  
Common stock repurchases and
  retirements
    (80,901 )             94               -               (80,807 )
Shares issued under stock option
  plan
    659       -       -       -       -       -       659  
Issuance of restricted stock
  awards
    (1,280 )     -       -       1,280       -       -       -  
Share-based compensation
  expense
    -       -       -       5,385       -       -       5,385  
Other
    7       (7 )     (4 )     -       1       -       (3 )
Balances at December 31, 2010
    69,396       2,677       (2,249 )     37,075       93,607       -       200,506  
 
                                                       
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements
 

 
107

 
 
 

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2010, 2009 AND 2008
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
(Amounts in thousands)
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Cash flows from operating activities:
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
Net income (loss)
  $ 8,955       3,516       (3,372 )
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash
                       
provided by operating activities, net of effect of acquisitions:
                       
Depreciation and amortization expense
    126,114       123,362       114,369  
Deferred income tax expense
    9,488       3,936       1,077  
Share-based compensation expense
    6,733       2,804       7,278  
Other noncash income and expense items
    6,725       14,919       8,896  
Change in operating assets and liabilities, net of effect
  of acquisitions
    13,244       (47,618 )     47,087  
Net cash provided by operating activities
    171,259       100,919       175,335  
Cash flows from investing activities:
                       
Purchases of property and equipment, including construction
   period interest
    (96,194 )     (120,983 )     (221,458 )
Purchase of businesses and non-controlling interest,
  net of cash received
    (5,545 )     (109 )     (65,335 )
Purchase of marketable securities
    941       (305 )     -  
Proceeds from sale of marketable securities
    (202 )     613       4,800  
Insurance proceeds
    990       -       -  
Purchases of other assets and intangible assets
    (4,712 )     (5,093 )     (8,974 )
Net cash used in investing activities
    (104,722 )     (125,877 )     (290,967 )
Cash flows from financing activities:
                       
Issuance of 2019 Senior Notes
    -       421,473       -  
Repayment of debt and capital lease obligations
    (35,974 )     (402,710 )     (10,248 )
Borrowing on long-term debt
    6,206       3,884       114,486  
Payment of debt issuance costs
    (2,300 )     (9,006 )     (2,118 )
Repurchase of common stock
    (80,807 )     -       -  
Borrowing on Senior Credit Facility
    30,000       30,000       30,000  
Other
    632       189       342  
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    (82,243 )     43,830       132,462  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    (15,706 )     18,872       16,830  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
    48,776       29,904       13,074  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
  $ 33,070       48,776       29,904  
 
                       
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
                       

 
108

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements



(1)        Business and Summary of Significant Accounting Principles
In the following discussion, General Communication, Inc. (“GCI”) and its direct and indirect subsidiaries are referred to as “we,” “us” and “our.”

 
(a)
Business
GCI, an Alaska corporation, was incorporated in 1979. We offer the following services:
·  
Origination and termination of traffic in Alaska for certain common carriers,
·  
Cable television services throughout Alaska,
·  
Competitive local access services throughout Alaska,
·  
Incumbent local access services in areas of rural Alaska,
·  
Long-distance telephone service,
·  
Sale of postpaid and prepaid wireless telephone services and sale of wireless telephone handsets and accessories,
·  
Data network services,
·  
Internet access services,
·  
Wireless roaming for certain wireless carriers,
·  
Broadband services, including our SchoolAccess® offering to rural school districts, our ConnectMD® offering to rural hospitals and health clinics, and managed video conferencing,
·  
Managed services to certain commercial customers,
·  
Sales and service of dedicated communications systems and related equipment, and
·  
Lease, service arrangements and maintenance of capacity on our fiber optic cable systems used in the transmission of voice and data services within Alaska and between Alaska and the remaining United States and foreign countries.

 
(b)
Principles of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the consolidated accounts of GCI and its wholly-owned subsidiaries, as well as a variable interest entity in which we were the primary beneficiary prior to August 18, 2008 when we acquired the remaining 18.1% equity interest and voting control of Alaska DigiTel, LLC (“Alaska DigiTel”).  All significant intercompany transactions between non-regulated affiliates of our company are eliminated.   Intercompany transactions generated between regulated and non-regulated affiliates of our company are not eliminated in consolidation.

 
(c)
Acquisitions
Effective June 1, 2008, we closed on our purchase of 100% of the outstanding stock of United Utilities, Inc. (“UUI”) and Unicom, Inc. (“Unicom”), which were subsidiaries of United Companies, Inc. (“UCI”).  UUI, together with its subsidiary, United-KUC, Inc. (“United-KUC”), provides local telephone service to 60 rural communities in the Bethel, Alaska area.  Unicom operates DeltaNet, a long-haul broadband microwave network ringing the Yukon-Kuskokwim Delta.  This investment expanded our Managed Broadband services in rural Alaska.  The UUI and Unicom acquisition were stock purchases but we elected to treat them as an asset purchase for income tax purposes, resulting in goodwill being deductible for tax purposes.
 
 
Effective July 1, 2008, we closed on our purchase of 100% of the ownership interests of Alaska Wireless Communications, LLC (“Alaska Wireless”), which provides wireless and Internet services in the Dutch Harbor, Sand Point, Akutan, and Adak, Alaska areas.  Such purchase was treated as an asset purchase for income tax purposes.  This investment expanded our wireless services in the Aleutian Chain region of rural Alaska.  We consider this business combination to be immaterial to our consolidated financial statements.

On August 18, 2008, we exercised our option to acquire the remaining 18.1% of the equity interest and voting control of Alaska DigiTel for $10.4 million.  Prior to August 18, 2008, our ability to control the operations of Alaska DigiTel was limited as required by the Federal Communications Commission (“FCC”) upon their approval of our initial acquisition of 81.9% of the non-controlling equity interest obtained in January 2007.  Subsequent to the acquisition of the non-controlling interest, we own 100% of the outstanding common ownership units and voting control of Alaska DigiTel.  Such purchase was treated as an asset purchase for income tax purposes.  We purchased Alaska DigiTel as a way to participate in the future growth of the Alaska wireless industry.  We consolidated 100% of Alaska
 
(Continued)
 
109

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
DigiTel's assets and liabilities at fair value beginning on January 1, 2007, when we determined that Alaska DigiTel was a variable interest entity of which we were the primary beneficiary.  Upon our acquisition of the non-controlling interest in Alaska DigiTel on August 18, 2008, we recorded 18.1% of the change in fair value between the assets and liabilities on January 1, 2007 and the fair value of the assets and liabilities on August 18, 2008.

On the closing date of the UUI and Unicom acquisition, $8.0 million of the purchase price was deposited in an escrow account to compensate us for any indemnification claims we may have after the acquisition and was included in the purchase price.  As of December 31, 2010, $2.0 million remained in the escrow account, the balance of which was released in January 2011.

We have agreed to make additional payments for UUI and Unicom in each of the years 2009 through 2013 that are contingent on sequential year-over-year revenue growth for specified customers.  During the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, we paid an additional $388,000 and $109,000, respectively, to the former shareholders of UUI.  As of December 31, 2010, we have recorded an accrual of $480,000 for contingent consideration to the former shareholders of UUI.  We made an additional $5.2 million payment for Alaska Wireless in 2010 that was contingent on meeting certain financial conditions.  We are unable to reasonably estimate the remaining contingent consideration amounts that may be paid for the UUI acquisition, but do not believe any amount paid will be significant.

Our business acquisitions and the acquisition of the non-controlling interest in Alaska DigiTel were recorded with the purchase price allocated based on the fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed.  In addition, the acquired companies' results of operations are included since the effective date of each acquisition.

The purchase prices, including contingent payments, for our 2008 acquisitions, net of cash received of approximately $1.7 million from UUI and Unicom, are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
As Originally Reported at December 31, 2008
   
Adjustments
   
Revised Purchase Price at December 31, 2010
 
UUI and Unicom
  $ 40,575       977       41,552  
Alaska Wireless
  $ 14,508       5,157       19,665  
Alaska DigiTel
  $ 10,434       -       10,434  

The purchase price for the UUI and Unicom acquisition had been allocated at December 31, 2009.  During the year ended December 31, 2010, we accrued an additional contingency payment to UUI of $480,000.  Therefore our allocation of the purchase price at December 31, 2009 has been adjusted for this consideration and is as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
(Continued)
 
110

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
Originally Recorded at December 31, 2008
   
Adjustments
   
Revised Balance at December 31, 2009
   
Adjustments
   
Revised Balance at December 31, 2010
 
Current assets
  $ 15,008       -       15,008       -       15,008  
Property and equipment,
  including construction in progress
    59,629       68       59,697       -       59,697  
Intangible assets
    8,175       -       8,175       -       8,175  
Wireless licenses
    100       -       100       -       100  
Goodwill
    9,102       1,427       10,529       480       11,009  
Deferred income taxes
    -       679       679       -       679  
Other assets
    3,106       -       3,106       -       3,106  
Total assets acquired
    95,120       2,174       97,294       480       97,774  
Current liabilities
    4,916       96       5,012       -       5,012  
Long-term debt, including
  current portion
    43,614       -       43,614       -       43,614  
Other long-term liabilities
    4,335       1,581       5,916       -       5,916  
Total liabilities assumed
    52,865       1,677       54,542       -       54,542  
Net assets acquired
  $ 42,255       497       42,752       480       43,232  

The purchase price for the Alaska DigiTel acquisition has been finalized and allocated as of December 31, 2008 as follows (amounts in thousands):

Current assets
  $ 2,220  
Property and equipment, including construction in progress
    6,015  
Intangible assets
    1,468  
Wireless licenses
    4,396  
Goodwill
    4,534  
Other assets
    1  
Total assets acquired
    18,634  
Current liabilities
    2,588  
Long-term debt, including current portion
    5,515  
Other long-term liabilities
    97  
Total liabilities assumed
    8,200  
Net assets acquired
  $ 10,434  

Goodwill increased $480,000 at December 31, 2010 as compared to December 31, 2009 due to a contingent payment to UUI.  Goodwill increased $6.6 million at December 31, 2009 as compared to December 31, 2008, primarily to record a $930,000 adjustment for grant deferred revenue to the UUI and Unicom purchase price allocations and for additional $5.2 million and $497,000 contingent payments to Alaska Wireless and UUI, respectively.

We modified the initial preliminary UUI and Unicom purchase price allocation during 2008 by increasing current assets $548,000, decreasing property and equipment $8.5 million, increasing intangible assets $1.7 million, increasing goodwill $3.1 million, increasing other assets $695,000, increasing current liabilities $464,000, increasing long-term debt $910,000, and decreasing other long-term liabilities $3.9 million for adjustments due to the refinement of the estimated fair value.

We modified the initial preliminary Alaska DigiTel purchase price allocation for the purchase of the non-controlling interest during 2008 by decreasing property and equipment $202,000, increasing intangible assets $503,000, decreasing goodwill $88,000, and increasing liabilities $253,000 for adjustments to the fair value of the fixed assets and intangibles due to refinement of the valuation. An adjustment to the fair value of the liabilities was due to refinement of the estimated fair value.

(Continued)
 
111

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
All of our 2008 acquisitions resulted in goodwill which is deductible over 15 years for income tax purposes.

Revenues from the date of acquisition, net of intercompany revenue, for our acquisitions of UUI, Unicom, Alaska DigiTel and Alaska Wireless are allocated to our Consumer, Network Access, Managed Broadband, and Regulated Operations segments.

The following unaudited pro forma financial information is presented as if we had acquired the companies as of the beginning of the period presented.  The pro forma results of operation as if the acquisitions occurred on January 1, 2008 for the year ended December 31, 2008 is as follows (amount in thousands, unaudited):

Pro forma consolidated revenue
  $ 588,691  
Pro forma net loss
  $ (2,932 )
 
       
EPS:
       
Basic – pro forma
  $ (0.06 )
Diluted – pro forma
  $ (0.06 )

(d)   Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements
Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2009-13 addresses the accounting for multiple deliverable arrangements to enable vendors to account for products or services (“deliverables”) separately rather than as a combined unit. Specifically, this guidance amends the criteria in Subtopic 605-25, “Revenue Recognition - Multiple-Element Arrangements”, for separating consideration in multiple-deliverable arrangements. This guidance establishes a selling price hierarchy for determining the selling price of a deliverable, which is based on: (a) vendor-specific objective evidence; (b) third-party evidence; or (c) estimates. This guidance also eliminates the residual method of allocation and requires that arrangement consideration be allocated at the inception of the arrangement to all deliverables using the relative selling price method. In addition, this guidance significantly expands required disclosures related to a vendor's multiple-deliverable revenue arrangements. ASU 2009-13 is effective prospectively for revenue arrangements entered into or materially modified in fiscal years beginning on or after June 15, 2010. The adoption of ASU 2009-13 is not expected to have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flows.

In December 2010, the FASB issued ASU 2010-28 “Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): When to Perform Step 2 of the Goodwill Impairment Test for Reporting Units with Zero or Negative Carrying Amounts”.  Under ASU 2010-28, if the carrying amount of a reporting unit is zero or negative, an entity must assess whether it is more likely than not that goodwill impairment exists. To make that determination, an entity should consider whether there are adverse qualitative factors that could impact the amount of goodwill, including those listed in ASC 350-20-35-30. As a result of the new guidance, an entity can no longer assert that a reporting unit is not required to perform the second step of the goodwill impairment test because the carrying amount of the reporting unit is zero or negative, despite the existence of qualitative factors that indicate goodwill is more likely than not impaired. ASU 2010-28 is effective for public entities for fiscal years, and for interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2010, with early adoption prohibited.  The adoption of ASU 2009-28 is not expected to have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flows.

In December 2010, the FASB issued the ASU 2010-29 “Business Combinations (Topic 805): Disclosure of Supplementary Pro Forma Information for Business Combinations”.  ASU 2010-29 specifies that if a public entity presents comparative financial statements, the entity should disclose revenue and earnings of the combined entity as though the business combination(s) that occurred during the current year had occurred as of the beginning of the comparable prior annual reporting period only. The amendments in this update also expand the supplemental pro forma disclosures under Topic 805
 
(Continued)
 
112

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
to include a description of the nature and amount of material, nonrecurring pro forma adjustments directly attributable to the business combination included in the reported pro forma revenue and earnings. The amended guidance is effective prospectively for business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2010. Early adoption is permitted.  The adoption of ASU 2009-29 is not expected to have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flows.
 
(e)   Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements
ASU 2009-17 addresses a revision to former SFAS No. 167, “Amendments to FASB Interpretation No. 46(R)” ("SFAS 167"). ASU 2009-17 amends previous accounting related to the consolidation of variable interest entities ("VIE") to require an enterprise to qualitatively assess the determination of the primary beneficiary of a variable interest entity based on whether the entity (1) has the power to direct the activities of a VIE that most significantly impact the entity’s economic performance and (2) has the obligation to absorb losses of the entity or the right to receive benefits from the entity that could potentially be significant to the VIE. Also, SFAS No. 167 requires an ongoing reconsideration of the primary beneficiary, and amends the events that trigger a reassessment of whether an entity is a VIE. Enhanced disclosures are also required to provide information about an enterprise’s involvement in a VIE. The adoption of ASU 2009-17 on January 1, 2010, did not have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flows.

ASU No. 2010-06, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (Topic 820): Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements” requires new disclosures and clarifies existing disclosure requirements about fair value measurement as set forth in Codification Subtopic 820-10. The FASB’s objective is to improve these disclosures and, thus, increase the transparency in financial reporting. Specifically, ASU 2010-06 amends Codification Subtopic 820-10 to now require that (a) a reporting entity should disclose separately the amounts of significant transfers in and out of Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements and describe the reasons for the transfers; and (b) in the reconciliation for fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs, a reporting entity should present separately information about purchases, sales, issuances, and settlements.  In addition, ASU 2010-06 clarifies the requirements of the following existing disclosures:

·  
For purposes of reporting fair value measurement for each class of assets and liabilities, a reporting entity needs to use judgment in determining the appropriate classes of assets and liabilities; and
·  
A reporting entity should provide disclosures about the valuation techniques and inputs used to measure fair value for both recurring and nonrecurring fair value measurements.

We adopted ASU 2010-06 as of January 1, 2010, except for the disclosures about purchases, sales, issuances, and settlements in the roll forward of activity in Level 3 fair value measurements. Those disclosures are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010, and for interim periods within those fiscal years. Early application is permitted. The adoption of ASU 2010-06 did not have a material impact on our statement of operations, financial position or cash flow.

 
(f)
Regulatory Accounting and Regulation
We account for our regulated operations in accordance with the accounting principles for regulated enterprises.  This accounting recognizes the economic effects of rate regulation by recording cost and a return on investment as such amounts are recovered through rates authorized by regulatory authorities.  Accordingly, plant and equipment is depreciated over lives approved by regulators and certain costs and obligations are deferred based upon approvals received from regulators to permit recovery of such amounts in future years.  Our cost studies and depreciation rates for our regulated operations are subject to periodic audits that could result in a change to recorded revenues.

 
(g)
Earnings per Common Share
We compute net income per share of Class A and Class B common stock using the “two class” method.  Therefore, basic net income per share is computed by dividing net income applicable to common stockholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period.  Diluted net income per share is computed by dividing net income by the weighted average
 
(Continued)
 
113

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
number of common and dilutive common equivalent shares outstanding during the period.  The computation of the dilutive net income per share of Class A common stock assumes the conversion of Class B common stock to Class A common stock, while the dilutive net income per share of Class B common stock does not assume the conversion of those shares. Additionally in applying the “two-class” method, undistributed earnings are allocated to both common shares and participating securities. Our restricted stock grants are entitled to dividends and meet the criteria of a participating security.

Undistributed earnings for each year are allocated based on the contractual participation rights of Class A and Class B common shares as if the earnings for the year had been distributed.  In accordance with our Articles of Incorporation which provide that, if and when dividends are declared on our common stock in accordance with Alaska corporate law, equivalent dividends shall be paid with respect to the shares of Class A and Class B common stock. Both classes of common stock have identical dividend rights and would therefore share equally in our net assets in the event of liquidation. As such, we have allocated undistributed earnings on a proportionate basis.

Earnings per common share (“EPS”) and common shares used to calculate basic and diluted EPS consist of the following (amounts in thousands, except per share amounts):

 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended
 
 
 
December 31, 2010
 
 
 
Class A
   
Class B
 
Basic net income per share:
 
 
   
 
 
Numerator:
 
 
   
 
 
Allocation of undistributed earnings
  $ 8,420       535  
 
               
Denominator:
               
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    50,076       3,183  
Basic net income per share
  $ 0.17       0.17  
 
               
Diluted net income per share:
               
Numerator:
               
Allocation of undistributed earnings for basic computation
  $ 8,420       535  
Reallocation of undistributed earnings as a result of conversion of Class B to Class A shares
    535       -  
Reallocation of undistributed earnings as a result of conversion of Class B to Class A shares outstanding
    -       (2 )
Net income adjusted for allocation of undistributed earnings
  $ 8,955       533  
 
               
Denominator:
               
Number of shares used in basic computation
    50,076       3,183  
Conversion of Class B to Class A common shares outstanding
    3,183       -  
Unexercised stock options
    167       -  
Number of shares used in per share computations
    53,426       3,183  
Diluted net income per share
  $ 0.17       0.17  
 
 
(Continued)
 
114

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2009
   
2008
 
 
 
Class A
   
Class B
   
Class A
   
Class B
 
Basic net income (loss) per share:
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
Numerator:
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
Allocation of undistributed earnings (losses)
  $ 3,305       211     $ (1,754 )     (115 )
 
                               
Denominator:
                               
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    50,159       3,195       49,080       3,241  
Basic net income (loss) attributable to GCI common stockholders per common share
  $ 0.07       0.07     $ (0.04 )     (0.04 )
 
                               
Diluted net income (loss) per share:
                               
Numerator:
                               
Allocation of undistributed earnings (losses) for basic computation
  $ 3,305       211     $ (1,754 )     (115 )
Reallocation of undistributed earnings (losses) as a result of conversion of Class B to Class A shares
    211       -       (115 )     -  
Reallocation of undistributed earnings (losses) as a result of conversion of Class B to Class A shares
  outstanding
    -       (29 )     -       -  
Effect of share based compensation that may be settled in cash or shares
    (454 )     -       -       -  
Net income (loss) adjusted for allocation of undistributed earnings (losses) and effect of share based
  compensation that may be settled in cash or shares
  $ 3,062       182     $ (1,869 )     (115 )
 
                               
Denominator:
                               
Number of shares used in basic computation
    50,159       3,195       49,080       3,241  
Conversion of Class B to Class A common shares outstanding
    3,195       -       3,241       -  
Unexercised stock options
    258       -       -       -  
Effect of share based compensation that may be settled in cash or shares
    236       -       -       -  
Number of shares used in per share computations
    53,848       3,195       52,321       3,241  
Diluted net income (loss) attributable to GCI common stockholders per common share
  $ 0.06       0.06     $ (0.04 )     (0.04 )

Weighted average shares associated with outstanding share awards for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 which have been excluded from the computations of diluted EPS, because the effect of including these share awards would have been anti-dilutive, consist of the following (shares, in thousands):

 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Shares associated with anti-dilutive unexercised stock options
    460       3,753       4,238  
Share-based compensation that may be settled in cash or shares, the effect of which is anti-dilutive
    217       -       289  
 
    677       3,753       4,527  
 

 
(Continued)
 
115

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Additionally, 50,000, 420,000 and 258,000 weighted average shares associated with contingent options and awards for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, were excluded from the computation of diluted EPS because the contingencies of these options and awards have not been met at December 31, 2010, 2009, and 2008, respectively.

 
(h)
Common Stock
Following are the changes in issued common stock for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 (shares, in thousands):

 
 
Class A
   
Class B
 
Balances at January 1, 2008
    50,437       3,257  
Class B shares converted to Class A
    54       (54 )
Shares issued upon stock option exercises
    71       -  
Share awards issued
    45       -  
Shares retired
    (540 )     -  
Other
    (5 )     -  
Balances at December 31, 2008
    50,062       3,203  
Class B shares converted to Class A
    15       (15 )
Shares issued upon stock option exercises
    77       -  
Share awards issued
    1,964       -  
Shares retired
    (219 )     (2 )
Balances at December 31, 2009
    51,899       3,186  
Class B shares converted to Class A
    8       (8 )
Shares issued upon stock option exercises
    116       -  
Share awards issued
    336       -  
Shares retired
    (8,144 )     -  
Other
    (2 )     -  
Balances at December 31, 2010
    44,213       3,178  

We retired 17,000, 219,000, and 540,000 shares of our Class A common stock during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, that were acquired to settle the minimum statutory tax-withholding requirements pursuant to restricted stock award vesting and the settlement of deferred compensation.

GCI’s Board of Directors has authorized a common stock buyback program for the repurchase of GCI’s Class A and Class B common stock in order to reduce the outstanding shares of Class A and Class B common stock. In October 2010, GCI’s Board of Directors approved an increase to the common stock buyback plan.  Under the amended plan, we were authorized to repurchase up to $100.0 million worth of GCI common stock.   In December 2010, GCI’s Board of Directors approved an additional $100.0 million increase to the stock buyback plan.  We are authorized to increase our repurchase limit $5.0 million per quarter indefinitely and to use stock option exercise proceeds to repurchase additional shares.

 
On October 21, 2010, we entered into a stock purchase agreement with Arctic Slope Regional Corporation (“ASRC”), pursuant to which GCI repurchased 7,486,240 shares of GCI’s Class A common stock for $10.16 per share, representing a total purchase price of $76.0 million.  Prior to the repurchase ASRC was a related party.

During the year ended December 31, 2010 we repurchased a total of 8.0 million shares of our Class A and B common stock at a cost of $80.8 million.  The cost of the repurchased common stock reduced Common Stock on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  The repurchase reduced the amount available under the stock buyback program to $125.5 million.  The repurchased stock was retired as of December 31, 2010.  There were no repurchases during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.

(Continued)
 
116

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
If stock repurchases are less than the total approved quarterly amount the difference may be carried forward and used to repurchase additional shares in future quarters.  We expect to continue the repurchases for an indefinite period dependent on leverage, liquidity, company performance, market conditions and subject to continued oversight by GCI’s Board of Directors. The open market repurchases have complied and will continue to comply with the restrictions of Rule 10b-18 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

 
(i)
Redeemable Preferred Stock
 
We have 1,000,000 shares of preferred stock authorized with no shares issued and outstanding at years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008.

 
(j)
Treasury Stock
 
We account for treasury stock purchased for general corporate purposes under the cost method and include treasury stock as a component of Stockholders’ Equity.  Treasury stock purchased with intent to retire (whether or not the retirement is actually accomplished) is charged to Class A or Class B Common Stock.

 
(k)
Cash Equivalents
 
Cash equivalents consist of overnight sweep investments and certificates of deposit which have an original maturity of three months or less at the date acquired and are readily convertible into cash.

 
(l)
Accounts Receivable and Allowance for Doubtful Receivables
 
Trade accounts receivable are recorded at the invoiced amount and do not bear interest. The allowance for doubtful receivables is our best estimate of the amount of probable credit losses in our existing accounts receivable. We base our estimates on the aging of our accounts receivable balances, financial health of specific customers, regional economic data, changes in our collections process, regulatory requirements, and our customers’ compliance with Universal Service Administrative Company ("USAC") rules. We review our allowance for doubtful receivables methodology at least annually.

 
Depending upon the type of account receivable our allowance is calculated using a pooled basis with an allowance for all accounts greater than 120 days past due, a specific identification method, or a combination of the two methods. When a specific identification method is used, past due balances over 90 days old and balances less than 90 days old but potentially uncollectible due to bankruptcy or other issues are reviewed individually for collectability. Account balances are charged off against the allowance when we feel it is probable the receivable will not be recovered. We do not have any off-balance-sheet credit exposure related to our customers.

 
(m)
Inventories
 
Wireless handset inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market (net realizable value). Cost is determined using the average cost method. Handset costs in excess of the revenues generated from handset sales, or handset subsidies, are expensed at the time of sale. We do not recognize the expected handset subsidies prior to the time of sale because the promotional discount decision is made at the point of sale and/or because we expect to recover the handset subsidies through service revenue.

 
Inventories of other merchandise for resale and parts are stated at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined using the average cost method.

 
(n)
Property and Equipment
 
Property and equipment is stated at cost. Construction costs of facilities are capitalized. Equipment financed under capital leases is recorded at the lower of fair market value or the present value of future minimum lease payments at inception of the lease. Construction in progress represents transmission equipment and support equipment and systems not placed in service on December 31, 2010 that management intends to place in service during 2011.
 
(Continued)
 
117

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method based upon the shorter of the estimated useful lives of the assets or the lease term, if applicable, in the following ranges:

Asset Category
Asset Lives
Telephony transmission equipment and distribution facilities
5-20 years
Fiber optic cable systems
15-25 years
Cable transmission equipment and distribution facilities
5-30 years
Support equipment and systems
3-20 years
Transportation equipment
5-13 years
Property and equipment under capital leases
12-20 years
Buildings
25 years
Customer premises equipment
2-20 years

Amortization of property and equipment under capital leases is included in Depreciation and Amortization Expense on the Consolidated Statements of Operations.

Repairs and maintenance are charged to expense as incurred. Expenditures for major renewals and betterments are capitalized. Accumulated depreciation is removed and gains or losses are recognized at the time of sales or other dispositions of property and equipment.

 
(o)
Intangible Assets and Goodwill
Goodwill, cable certificates (certificates of convenience and public necessity) and wireless licenses are not amortized. Cable certificates represent certain perpetual operating rights to provide cable services. Wireless licenses represent the right to utilize certain radio frequency spectrum to provide wireless communications services.  Goodwill represents the excess of cost over fair value of net assets acquired in connection with a business acquisition. Goodwill is not allocated to our reportable segments as our Chief Operating Decision Maker does not review a balance sheet by reportable segment to make decisions about resource allocation or evaluate reportable segment performance, however, goodwill is allocated to our reporting units for the sole purpose of the annual impairment test.

All other amortizable intangible assets are being amortized over 2 to 20 year periods using the straight-line method.

 
(p)
Impairment of Intangibles, Goodwill, and Long-lived Assets
Cable certificates and wireless license assets are treated as indefinite-lived intangible assets and are tested annually for impairment or more frequently if events and circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired. The impairment test consists of a comparison of the fair value of the asset with its carrying amount. If the carrying amount of the assets exceeds its fair value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. After an impairment loss is recognized, the adjusted carrying amount of the asset becomes its new accounting basis. Impairment testing of our cable certificate and wireless license assets as of October 31, 2010 and 2009 used a direct value method.

Our goodwill is tested annually for impairment, and is tested for impairment more frequently if events and circumstances indicate that the assets might be impaired.  We are required to determine goodwill impairment using a two-step process.  The first step of the goodwill impairment test is used to identify potential impairment by comparing the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount.  If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied fair value of the reporting unit's goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill.  If the carrying amount of the reporting unit's goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.  The
 
(Continued)
 
118

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill that would be recognized in a business combination.  We use a discounted cash flow method to determine the fair value of our reporting units.  This method requires us to make estimates and assumptions including projected cash flows and discount rate.  These estimates and assumptions could have a significant impact on whether an impairment charge is recognized and also the magnitude of any such impairment charge.

During the third quarter of 2009, we changed the date of our annual impairment test from the last day of the fiscal year to the last day of the tenth month of the fiscal year for all of our indefinite-lived intangibles. As we grew, it became increasingly difficult to complete the various impairment analyses in a timely manner, therefore, we believed the change in accounting principle related to the annual testing date was preferable as it provided us additional time to complete the impairment test and report the results of that test in our annual filing on Form 10-K. We believe that the change to the annual testing date did not delay, accelerate or avoid an impairment charge. We determined that this change in accounting principle was preferable under the circumstances and it did not result in adjustments to our financial statements when applied retrospectively. The annual impairment test was performed as of December 31, 2008 and was performed again as of October 31, 2009, therefore, less than 12 months elapsed between impairment tests.  We completed our annual review and no impairment charge was recorded for the years ended December 31, 2009 or 2010.

Long-lived assets, such as property, plant, and equipment, and purchased intangibles subject to amortization, are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset group may not be recoverable. Recoverability of an asset group to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of an asset group to estimated undiscounted future cash flows expected to be generated by the asset group. If the carrying amount of an asset group exceeds its estimated undiscounted future cash flows, an impairment charge is recognized by the amount by which the carrying amount of the asset group exceeds the fair value of the asset group.

 
(q)
Amortization and Write-off of Loan Fees
Debt issuance costs are deferred and amortized using the effective interest method. If a refinancing or amendment of a debt instrument is a substantial modification, all or a portion of the applicable debt issuance costs are written off.  If a debt instrument is repaid prior to the maturity date we will write-off a proportional amount of debt issuance costs.

 
(r)
Other Assets
Other Assets primarily include long-term deposits, prepayments, and non-trade accounts receivable.

 
(s)
Asset Retirement Obligations
We record the fair value of a liability for an asset retirement obligation in the period in which it is incurred in Other Liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheets if the fair value of the liability can be reasonably estimated. When the liability is initially recorded, we capitalize a cost by increasing the carrying amount of the related long-lived asset. In periods subsequent to initial measurement, period-to-period changes in the liability for an asset retirement obligation resulting from revisions to either the timing or the amount of the original estimate of undiscounted cash flows are recognized.  Over time, the liability is accreted to its present value each period, and the capitalized cost is depreciated over the useful life of the related asset.  Upon settlement of the liability, we either settle the obligation for its recorded amount or incur a gain or loss upon settlement.

The majority of our asset retirement obligations are the estimated cost to remove telephony transmission equipment and support equipment from leased property.  Following is a reconciliation of the beginning and ending aggregate carrying amount of our liability for asset retirement obligations (amounts in thousands):

Balance at December 31, 2008
  $ 6,179  
Liability incurred
    5,764  
Accretion expense
    634  
Liability settled
    (63 )
 
(Continued)
 
119

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
Balance at December 31, 2009
    12,514  
Liability incurred
    1,253  
Accretion expense
    289  
Liability settled
    (21 )
Balance at December 31, 2010
  $ 14,035  

During the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 we recorded additional capitalized costs of $1.3 million and $5.8 million, respectively, in Property and Equipment in Service, Net of Depreciation.

Certain of our network facilities are on property that requires us to have a permit and the permit contains provisions requiring us to remove our network facilities in the event that the permit is not renewed.  We expect to continually renew our permits and therefore cannot estimate any liabilities associated with such agreements.  A remote possibility exists that we would not be able to successfully renew a permit, which could result in us incurring significant expense in complying with restoration or removal provisions.

 
(t)
Revenue Recognition
All revenues are recognized when the earnings process is complete. Revenue recognition is as follows:

 
·
Revenues generated from long-distance service usage and plan fees, Internet service excess usage, and managed services are recognized when the services are provided,
 
·
We recognize unbilled revenues when the service is provided based upon minutes of use processed, and/or established rates, net of credits and adjustments,
 
·
Cable television service package fees, local access and Internet service plan fees, and private line telecommunication revenues are billed in advance, recorded as Deferred Revenue on the balance sheet, and are recognized as the associated service is provided,
 
·
Certain of our wireless services offerings have been determined to be revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables. Revenues are recognized as each element is earned based on objective evidence regarding the relative fair value of each element and when there are no undelivered elements that are essential to the functionality of the delivered elements. Revenues generated from wireless service usage and plan fees are recognized when the services are provided. Revenues generated from the sale of wireless handsets and accessories are recognized when title to the handset and accessories passes to the customer. As the non-refundable, up-front activation fee charged to the customer does not meet the criteria as a separate unit of accounting, we allocate the additional arrangement consideration received from the activation fee to the handset (the delivered item) to the extent that the aggregate handset and activation fee proceeds do not exceed the fair value of the handset. Any activation fees not allocated to the handset would be deferred upon activation and recognized as service revenue on a straight-line basis over the expected customer relationship period,
 
·
The majority of our equipment sale transactions involve the sale of communications equipment with no other services involved. Such equipment is subject to standard manufacturer warranties and we do not manufacture any of the equipment we sell. In such instances the customer takes title to the equipment generally upon delivery. We recognize revenue for such transactions when title passes to the customer and the revenue is earned and realizable. On certain occasions we enter into agreements to sell and satisfactorily install or integrate telecommunications equipment for a fixed fee. Customers may have refund rights if the installed equipment does not meet certain performance criteria. We defer revenue recognition until we have received customer acceptance per the contract or agreement, and all other required revenue recognition elements have been achieved. Revenues from contracts with multiple element arrangements, such as those including installation and integration services, are recognized as each element is earned based on objective evidence regarding the relative fair value of each element and when there are no undelivered elements that are essential to the functionality of the delivered elements,
 
·
Technical services revenues are derived primarily from maintenance contracts on equipment and are recognized on a prorated basis over the term of the contracts,
·          
We account for fiber capacity Indefeasible Rights to Use ("IRU") agreements as an operating lease or service arrangement and we defer the revenue and recognize it ratably over the life of the IRU or as service is rendered,
·          
Access revenue is recognized when earned.  We participate in access revenue pools with other telephone companies.  Such pools are funded by toll revenue and/or access charges regulated by the Regulatory Commission of Alaska ("RCA") within the intrastate jurisdiction and the FCC within the interstate jurisdiction. Much of the interstate access revenue is initially recorded based on estimates. These estimates are derived from interim financial information, available separation studies and the most recent information available about achieved rates of return. These estimates are subject to adjustment in future accounting periods as additional information becomes available. To the extent that a dispute arises over revenue settlements, our policy is to defer revenue collected until the dispute is resolved,
 
·
As an Eligible Telecommunications Carrier ("ETC"), we receive support from the Universal Service Fund ("USF") to support the provision of wireline local access and wireless service in high-cost areas.  We accrue estimated program revenue quarterly based on current line counts, the most current rates paid to us, our assessment of the impact of current FCC regulations, and our assessment of the potential outcome of FCC proceedings. Our estimated accrued revenue is subject to our judgment regarding the outcome of many variables and is subject to upward or downward adjustment in subsequent periods. Our ability to collect our accrued USF support is contingent upon continuation of the USF program and upon our eligibility to participate in that program, which is subject to change by future regulatory, legislative or judicial actions. We adjust revenue and the account receivable in the period the FCC makes a program change or we assess the likelihood that such a change has increased or decreased revenue. The payment from the USF is generally received approximately ten months subsequent to the services being performed. At December 31, 2010 we have $40.0 million in accounts receivable related to the USF high-cost area program.  We do not recognize revenue until our ETC status has been approved by the RCA,
 
·
We receive refunds from time to time from incumbent local exchange carriers (“ILECs”), with which we do business in respect of their earnings that exceed regulatory requirements. Telephone companies that are rate regulated by the FCC using the rate of return method are required by the FCC to refund earnings from interstate access charges assessed to long-distance carriers when their earnings exceed their authorized rate of return. Such refunds are computed based on the regulated carrier’s earnings in several access categories. Uncertainties exist with respect to the amount of their earnings, the refunds (if any), their timing, and their realization. We account for such refundable amounts as gain contingencies, and, accordingly, do not recognize them until realization is a certainty upon receipt,
 
·
We receive grant revenue for the purpose of building communication infrastructure in rural areas.  We defer the revenue and recognize it over the life of the asset that was constructed using grant funds, and
 
·
Other revenues are recognized when the service is provided.
 
 
(Continued)
 
120

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
We recognized $2.8 million of wireless revenue in July 2008 from USAC for interstate common line support. Due to the uncertainty in our ability to retroactively claim reimbursement under the program, we accounted for this payment as a gain contingency and, accordingly, recognized revenue only upon receipt of payment when realization was certain.

 
(u)
Payments Received from Suppliers
Our Consumer segment occasionally receives reimbursements for video services costs to promote suppliers’ services, called cooperative advertising arrangements. The supplier payment is classified as a reduction of selling, general and administrative expenses if it reimburses specific, incremental and identifiable costs incurred to resell the suppliers’ services.  If the supplier payment is unspecific, the payment is classified as a reduction to Cost of Goods Sold.  Recognition occurs upon receipt of the payment because collection is not assured.
 
(Continued)
 
121

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
(v)
Advertising Expense
We expense advertising costs in the year during which the first advertisement appears. Advertising expenses were $4.3 million, $4.1 million and $5.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 
(w)
Leases
Scheduled operating lease rent increases are amortized over the expected lease term on a straight-line basis. Rent holidays are recognized on a straight-line basis over the operating lease term (including any rent holiday period).

Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of their economic lives or the lease term. We may amortize a leasehold improvement over a term that includes assumption of a lease renewal if the renewal is reasonably assured. Leasehold improvements acquired in a business combination are amortized over the shorter of the useful life of the assets or a term that includes required lease periods and renewals that are deemed to be reasonably assured at the date of acquisition. Leasehold improvements that are placed in service significantly after and are not contemplated at or near the beginning of the lease term are amortized over the shorter of the useful life of the assets or a term that includes required lease periods and renewals that are deemed to be reasonably assured at the date the leasehold improvements are purchased. Leasehold improvements made by us and funded by landlord incentives or allowances under an operating lease are recorded as deferred rent and amortized as reductions to lease expense over the lease term.

 
(x)
Interest Expense
Material interest costs incurred during the construction period of non-software capital projects are capitalized.  Interest costs incurred during the development period of a software capital project are capitalized.  Interest is capitalized in the period commencing with the first expenditure for a qualifying capital project and ending when the capital project is substantially complete and ready for its intended use. We capitalized interest cost of $1.1 million, $548,000 and $4.2 million during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 
(y)
Income Taxes
Income taxes are accounted for using the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for their future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax basis. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable earnings in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. A valuation allowance is recognized if it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax asset will not be realized.

We file federal income tax returns in the U.S. and in various state jurisdictions.  We are no longer subject to U.S. or state tax examinations by tax authorities for years before 2007 except that  certain U.S. federal income tax returns for years after 1997 are not closed by relevant statutes of limitations due to unused net operating losses reported on those income tax returns.

We recognize accrued interest on unrecognized tax benefits in interest expense and penalties in selling, general and administrative expenses.  We did not have any unrecognized tax benefits as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, and accordingly, we did not recognize any interest expense.  Additionally, we recorded no penalties during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008.
 
 
 
(z)
Share-based Payment Arrangements
We currently use the Black-Scholes-Merton option-pricing model to value stock options granted to employees. We use these values to recognize stock compensation expense for stock
 
(Continued)
 
122

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
options.  Compensation expense is recognized in the financial statements for share-based awards based on the grant date fair value of those awards. Share-based compensation expense includes an estimate for pre-vesting forfeitures and is recognized over the requisite service periods of the awards on a straight-line basis, which is generally commensurate with the vesting term. See note 9 for information on the assumptions we used to calculate the fair value of share-based compensation.

We are required to report the benefits associated with tax deductions in excess of recognized compensation cost as a financing cash flow rather than as an operating cash flow.

 
(aa)
Stock Options and Stock Awards Issued for Non-employee Services
Stock options and warrants issued in exchange for non-employee services are accounted for based upon the fair value of the consideration or services received or the fair value of the equity instruments issued using the Black-Scholes-Merton method, whichever is more reliably measurable.

The fair value determined using these principles is charged to operating expense over the shorter of the term for which non-employee services are provided, if stated, or the stock option or warrant vesting period.

 
(ab)
Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with the accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“GAAP”) requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Significant items subject to estimates and assumptions include the allowance for doubtful receivables, unbilled revenues, accrual of the USF high cost area program support, share-based compensation, inventory reserves, reserve for future customer credits, valuation allowances for deferred income tax assets, depreciable and amortizable lives of assets, the carrying value of long-lived assets including goodwill, cable certificates and wireless licenses, purchase price allocations, deferred lease expense, asset retirement obligations, the accrual of Cost of Goods Sold, and the accrual of contingencies and litigation. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

The accounting estimates related to revenues from the high cost USF program are dependent on various inputs including current line counts, the most current rates paid to us, and our assessment of the impact of new FCC regulations, and the potential outcome of FCC proceedings.  Some of the inputs are subjective and based on our judgment regarding the outcome of certain variables and is subject to upward or downward adjustment in subsequent periods. 

Effective in the second quarter of 2010, we changed our USF high-cost area program support accrual methodology due to a change in our estimate of the current amounts expected to be paid to us.  The effect of this change in estimate was a revenue increase of $4.7 million, a net income increase of $3.1 million, and a basic and diluted net income per share increase of $0.06 for the year ended December 31, 2010.

 
(ac)
Concentrations of Credit Risk
Financial instruments that potentially subject us to concentrations of credit risk are primarily cash and cash equivalents and accounts receivable. Excess cash is invested in high quality short-term liquid money instruments. At December 31, 2010 and 2009, substantially all of our cash and cash equivalents were invested in short-term liquid money instruments.   At December 31, 2010 and 2009, cash balances were in excess of Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation insured limits.

We do not have any major customers for the year ended December 31, 2010 (see note 10).  Our customers are located primarily throughout Alaska. Because of this geographic concentration, our growth and operations depend upon economic conditions in Alaska.
 
(Continued)
 
123

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
(ad)
Software Capitalization Policy
Internally used software, whether purchased or developed, is capitalized and amortized using the straight-line method over an estimated useful life of five years. We capitalize certain costs associated with internally developed software such as payroll costs of employees devoting time to the projects and external direct costs for materials and services. Costs associated with internally developed software to be used internally are expensed until the point the project has reached the development stage. Subsequent additions, modifications or upgrades to internal-use software are capitalized only to the extent that they allow the software to perform a task it previously did not perform. Software maintenance and training costs are expensed in the period in which they are incurred. The capitalization of software requires judgment in determining when a project has reached the development stage.

 
(ae)
Guarantees
Certain of our customers have guaranteed levels of service.  If an interruption in service occurs we do not recognize revenue for any portion of the monthly service fee that will be refunded to the customer or not billed to the customer due to these service level agreements.

 
(af)
Classification of Taxes Collected from Customers
We report sales, use, excise, and value added taxes assessed by a governmental authority that is directly imposed on a revenue-producing transaction between us and a customer on a net basis in our statements of operations.  We report a certain surcharge on a gross basis in our statement of operations of $5.2 million, $4.4 million and $4.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 
(ag) Derivatives
From time to time we enter into derivative contracts to manage exposure to variability in cash flows from floating-rate financial instruments, particularly on our long-term debt instruments and credit facilities.  We do not currently have significant exposure from floating-rate financial instruments since we repaid the outstanding indebtedness under our Senior Credit Facility in 2009 with the proceeds from the issuance of the 2019 Notes.  We do not apply hedge accounting to our derivative instruments and therefore treat these instruments as “economic hedges.”   Derivative instruments are accounted for at fair value as either assets or liabilities on the balance sheet.  Changes in the fair value of derivatives are recognized in earnings each reporting period.

In the third quarter of 2008, we entered into two interest rate caps to manage the interest rate risk on our Senior Credit Facility, which was indexed to the London Interbank Offered Rate. These caps had a combined notional value of $180.0 million and an initial cost of $928,000.  The caps had a fair value of $0 and $7,000 at December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, resulting in realization of a loss to interest expense of $7,000 and $921,000 during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  The caps matured on July 1, 2010.

 
(ah) Reclassifications
Reclassifications have been made to the 2009 and 2008 financial statements to make them comparable with the 2010 presentation.

(2)
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows Supplemental Disclosures
 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net effect of acquisitions, consist of (amounts in thousands):

Year ended December 31,
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
(Increase) decrease in accounts receivable
  $ 12,283       (33,555 )     (5,209 )
(Increase) decrease in prepaid expenses
    (1,459 )     1,923       488  
(Increase) decrease in inventories
    3,461       (2,109 )     (3,336 )
(Increase) decrease in other current assets
    1,037       (4,272 )     (69 )
(Increase) decrease in other assets
    2,663       (10,742 )     -  
 
(Continued)
 
124

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
Increase (decrease) in accounts payable
    1,683       (1,889 )     (4,198 )
Increase (decrease) in deferred revenues
    (4,108 )     (787 )     4,543  
Increase (decrease) in accrued payroll and payroll related obligations
    271       (752 )     5,437  
Increase (decrease) in accrued liabilities
    2,585       (1,608 )     2,695  
Increase (decrease) in accrued interest
    (1,365 )     4,597       1,226  
Increase (decrease) in subscriber deposits
    (278 )     287       84  
Increase (decrease) in long-term deferred revenue
    (3,167 )     763       49,153  
Increase (decrease) in components of other long-term liabilities
    (362 )     526       (3,727 )
 
  $ 13,244       (47,618 )     47,087  

The following items are for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 (amounts in thousands):

Net cash paid or received:
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Interest paid, net of amounts capitalized
  $ 71,140       51,161       46,781  
Income tax refund received
  $ 1,163       911       83  
Income tax paid
  $ -       -       884  

The following items are non-cash investing and financing activities for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 (amounts in thousands):

 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Non-cash additions for purchases of property and
  equipment
  $ 7,622       4,427       12,124  
Asset retirement obligation additions to property and
  equipment
  $ 1,253       5,764       1,408  
Warranty receivable applied to capital lease
  obligation
  $ -       465       8,415  
Assets acquired in acquisition
  $ 480       6,475       -  
Capital lease obligation incurred
  $ -       -       99,873  
Satellite warranty receivable
  $ -       -       8,880  

Additional Non-cash Financing Activities
We received cash proceeds of $110.6 million from the $145.0 million term loan that we obtained in May 2008. We used $30.0 million of the term loan to repay the revolving portion of our Senior Credit Facility and our loan proceeds were reduced by $2.9 million for an original issue discount and $1.5 million for bank and legal fees associated with the new term loan.

(3)
Receivables and Allowance for Doubtful Receivables
 
Receivables consist of the following at December 31, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands):

 
 
2010
   
2009
 
Trade
  $ 130,708       145,220  
Employee
    722       315  
Other
    1,426       2,324  
Total Receivables
  $ 132,856       147,859  

 
(Continued)
 
125

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Changes in the allowance for doubtful receivables during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 are summarized below (amounts in thousands).

 
 
 
   
Additions
   
Deductions
   
 
 
Description
 
Balance at beginning of year
   
Charged to costs and expenses
   
Charged to other accounts
   
Write-offs net of recoveries
   
Balance at end of year
 
December 31, 2010
  $ 7,060       3,085       1,670       2,626       9,189  
December 31, 2009
  $ 2,582       3,818       1,734       1,074       7,060  
December 31, 2008
  $ 1,657       3,471       -       2,546       2,582  

Charged to Other Accounts for the year ended December 31, 2010 consists of a $1.7 million charge for a customer that participates in the Rural Health Care Division support program that is operated by the USAC.  We have been providing service to this customer pursuant to a contract since July 1, 2008.  We have received funding commitment letters from USAC for both funding years that have passed since the contract start date.  The commitment letter for the year from July 2008 to June 2009 committed funding for all but $1.7 million of that particular year.  USAC denied funding of $1.7 million based on the timing of customer-owned equipment placed in service in relation to service charges.  On August 23, 2010, we filed with the FCC a request for review of the denial.  We have recorded a reserve by reducing revenue $1.7 million in the year ended December 31, 2010.

Charged to Other Accounts for the year ended December 31, 2009 consists of a $914,000 adjustment recorded upon the conversion of our Alaska DigiTel customer accounts into a Consumer customer billing system that grossed up accounts receivable and the allowance for doubtful receivables to record termination fees for tracking purposes.  Additionally, the year ended December 31, 2009 includes an adjustment of $820,000 due to the decision to temporarily stop revenue recognition for services provided to a customer whose funding from the USAC was denied.

(4)
Net Property and Equipment in Service
Net property and equipment in service consists of the following at December 31, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands):

 
 
2010
   
2009
 
Land and buildings
  $ 36,332       31,279  
Telephony transmission equipment and distribution facilities
    674,246       637,292  
Cable transmission equipment and distribution facilities
    128,919       117,483  
Support equipment and systems
    190,947       170,922  
Transportation equipment
    9,116       9,930  
Property and equipment under capital leases
    102,972       102,972  
Customer premise equipment
    124,655       121,943  
Fiber optic cable systems
    244,381       242,309  
 
    1,511,568       1,434,130  
Less accumulated depreciation
    693,645       598,687  
Less accumulated amortization
    19,645       12,363  
Net property and equipment in service
  $ 798,278       823,080  
 
 
(Continued)
 
126

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 (5)
Intangible Assets and Goodwill
As of October 31, 2010 cable certificates, wireless licenses and goodwill were tested for impairment and the fair values were greater than the carrying amounts, therefore these intangible assets were determined not to be impaired at December 31, 2010. The remaining useful lives of our cable certificates, wireless licenses and goodwill were evaluated as of October 31, 2010 and events and circumstances continue to support an indefinite useful life.

There are no indicators of impairment of our intangible assets subject to amortization as of December 31, 2010.

Other Intangible Assets subject to amortization include the following at December 31, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands):

 
 
2010
   
2009
 
Software license fees
  $ 26,403       22,459  
Customer relationships
    11,034       11,217  
Customer contracts
    3,538       3,538  
Right-of-way
    783       783  
Other
    543       529  
 
    42,301       38,526  
Less accumulated amortization
    24,584       18,965  
Net other intangible assets
  $ 17,717       19,561  

Changes in Other Intangible Assets are as follows (amounts in thousands):

Balance at December 31, 2008
  $ 22,976  
Asset additions
    4,772  
Less amortization expense
    7,628  
Less asset write-off
    559  
Balance at December 31, 2009
    19,561  
Asset additions
    4,533  
Less amortization expense
    6,360  
Less asset write-off
    17  
Balance at December 31, 2010
  $ 17,717  

Goodwill increased $480,000 at December 31, 2010 as compared to December 31, 2009 due to the contingent payment to the former shareholders of UUI.  Goodwill increased $6.6 million at December 31, 2009 as compared to December 31, 2008, primarily to record a $930,000 adjustment for grant deferred revenue to the UUI and Unicom purchase price allocations and for the additional $5.2 million and $497,000 contingent payments to Alaska Wireless and the former shareholders of UUI, respectively.
 
Amortization expense for amortizable intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 follow (amounts in thousands):
 
(Continued)
 
127

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Amortization expense
  $ 6,360       7,628       5,948  

Amortization expense for amortizable intangible assets for each of the five succeeding fiscal years is estimated to be (amounts in thousands):

Years Ending December 31,
 
 
 
2011 
  $ 5,298  
2012 
    3,810  
2013 
    2,749  
2014 
    1,896  
2015 
    1,150  

(6)
Long-Term Debt
Long-term debt consists of the following (amounts in thousands):

 
 
December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
 
2019 Notes (a)
  $ 425,000       425,000  
2014 Notes (b)
    320,000       320,000  
Senior Credit Facility (c)
    20,000       -  
Rural Utility Service ("RUS") debt (d)
    19,844       34,721  
CoBank Mortgage ("CoBank") note payable (d)
    1,832       2,277  
  Debt
    786,676       781,998  
Less unamortized discount paid on the 2019 Notes
    3,266       3,460  
Less unamortized discount paid on the 2014 Notes
    1,693       2,158  
Less current portion of long-term debt
    2,516       5,133  
Long-term debt, net of unamortized discount
  $ 779,201       771,247  

(a)  
We pay interest of 8.63% on notes that are due in 2019 (“2019 Notes”).  The 2019 Notes are senior unsecured obligations which rank equally in right of payment with the existing and future senior unsecured debt, including our 2014 Notes described below, and senior in right of payment to all future subordinated indebtedness.  The 2019 Notes are carried on our Consolidated Balance Sheet net of the unamortized portion of the discount, which is being amortized to Interest Expense over the term of the 2019 Notes using the effective interest method and an effective interest rate of 9.07%.

The 2019 Notes are redeemable at our option, in whole or in part, on not less than thirty days nor more than sixty days notice, at the following redemption prices, plus accrued and unpaid interest (if any) to the date of redemption:

If redeemed during the twelve month period commencing November 15 of the year indicated:
 
Redemption Price
 
2014 
    104.313 %
2015 
    102.875 %
2015 
    101.438 %
2017 and thereafter
    100.000 %


The 2019 Notes mature on November 15, 2019.  Semi-annual interest payments are payable on May 15 and November 15 of each year.

The 2019 Notes were issued pursuant to an Indenture, dated as of the Closing Date, between us and Union Bank, N.A., as trustee.

(Continued)
 
128

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
We are not required to make mandatory sinking fund payments with respect to the 2019 Notes.

Upon the occurrence of a change of control, each holder of the 2019 Notes will have the right to require us to purchase all or any part (equal to $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof, except that no 2019 Note will be purchased in part if the remaining portion thereof would not be at least $2,000) of such holder’s 2019 Notes at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount of such 2019 Notes, plus accrued and unpaid interest on such 2019 Notes, if any.  If we or certain of our subsidiaries engage in asset sales, we must generally either invest the net cash proceeds from such sales in our business within a period of time, prepay debt under any outstanding credit facility, or make an offer to purchase a principal amount of the 2019 Notes equal to the excess net cash proceeds, with the purchase price equal to 100% of their principal amount, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any.

The covenants in the Indenture restrict GCI, Inc. and certain of its subsidiaries from incurring debt, but permits debt under the Senior Credit Facility and vendor financing as long as our leverage ratio, as defined, does not exceed 5.5 to one.  If our leverage ratio does not exceed 5.5 to one, we are able to enter into sale and leaseback transactions; pay dividends or distributions on capital stock or repurchase capital stock; issue stock of subsidiaries; make certain investments; create liens on assets to secure debt; enter into transactions with affiliates; merge or consolidate with another company; and  transfer and sell assets.  These covenants are subject to a number of limitations and exceptions, as further described in the Indenture.

We paid closing costs totaling $9.1 million in connection with the offering, which were recorded as deferred loan costs and are being amortized over the term of the 2019 Notes. Unamortized deferred loan costs related to the Senior Credit Facility totaling $1.4 million were written off in the year ended December 31, 2009.

We were in compliance with all 2019 Notes loan covenants at December 31, 2010.
 
 
(b)
We pay interest of 7.25% on notes that are due in 2014 (“2014 Notes”). The 2014 Notes are an unsecured senior obligation of GCI, Inc. The 2014 Notes are carried on our Consolidated Balance Sheet net of the unamortized portion of the discount, which is being amortized to Interest Expense over the term of the 2014 Notes using the effective interest method and an effective interest rate of 7.50%.

The 2014 Notes are redeemable at our option, in whole or in part, on not less than thirty days nor more than sixty days notice, at the following redemption prices, plus accrued and unpaid interest (if any) to the date of redemption:

If redeemed during the twelve month period commencing February 1 of the year indicated:
 
Redemption Price
 
2011 
    101.208 %
2012 and thereafter
    100.000 %

The 2014 Notes restrict GCI, Inc. and certain of its subsidiaries from incurring debt, but permits debt under the Senior Credit Facility and vendor financing as long as our leverage ratio, as defined, does not exceed 6.0 to one.  In addition, certain other debt is permitted regardless of our leverage ratio, including debt under the Senior Credit Facility not exceeding (and reduced by certain stated items):

 
·
$250.0 million, reduced by the amount of any prepayments, or
 
·
3.0 times earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization for the last four full fiscal quarters of GCI, Inc. and its subsidiaries.

The 2014 Notes limit the ability of our subsidiaries to make cash dividend payments to GCI.

Semi-annual interest payments of $11.6 million are payable in February and August of each year.

(Continued)
 
129

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
The 2014 Notes are structurally subordinate to our Senior Credit Facility.

We are not required to make mandatory sinking fund payments with respect to the 2014 Notes.

Our 2014 Notes’ key debt covenants require our Total Leverage Ratio (as defined) be 6.0:1.0 or less and our Senior Leverage Ratio (as defined) be 3.0:1.0 or less if our Senior Debt (as defined) is greater than $250.0 million.

We were in compliance with all 2014 Notes loan covenants at December 31, 2010.

 
(c)
In November 2009, we completed our offering of the 2019 Notes and used the net proceeds from this offering to repay the outstanding amount of $389.8 million under our Senior Credit Facility, including $349.8 million outstanding on the term loan and $40.0 million outstanding on the revolving portion of the Senior Credit Facility.  The term loan was retired upon the repayment but the revolving portion was still available to us at December 31, 2009.

On January 29, 2010, GCI Holdings, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary of GCI, entered into a Second Amended and Restated Credit and Guarantee Agreement with Calyon New York Branch, as administrative agent, Royal Bank of Canada, as syndication agent, and CoBank, ACB, Union Bank of California, N.A. and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., as documentation agents ("amended Senior Credit Facility"). The amended Senior Credit Facility provides a $75.0 million revolving credit facility with a $25.0 million sublimit for letters of credit.  The amended Senior Credit Facility replaced our then existing Senior Credit Facility.  The amended Senior Credit Facility will mature on January 29, 2015.

On October 20, 2010, we borrowed $30.0 million under our revolving credit facility to partially fund a repurchase of our Class A common stock as further described in note 9.  In November 2010, we repaid $10.0 million of the $30.0 million outstanding balance.   After consideration of these transactions, we have $2.7 million of letters of credit outstanding and $52.3 million available for borrowing under our revolving credit facility at December 31, 2010.

The interest rate on our amended Senior Credit Facility is the London Interbank Offered Rate plus the following Applicable Margin set forth opposite each applicable Total Leverage Ratio below:

Total Leverage Ratio (as defined)
 
Applicable Margin
 
>3.75
    4.00 %
>3.25 but <3.75
    3.50 %
>2.75 but <3.25
    3.00 %
<2.75
    2.50 %

Borrowings under the amended Senior Credit Facility are subject to certain financial covenants and restrictions on indebtedness.  Our amended Senior Credit Facility Total Leverage Ratio (as defined) may not exceed 5.25:1.00; the Senior Leverage Ratio (as defined) may not exceed 3.00:1.00; and our Interest Coverage Ratio (as defined) must not be less than 2.50:1.00 at any time.

The obligations under the amended Senior Credit Facility are secured by a security interest on substantially all of the assets of GCI Holdings, Inc. and the subsidiary guarantors, and on the stock of GCI Holdings, Inc.

In connection with the amended Senior Credit Facility, we paid loan fees of $2.0 million which are being amortized over the life of the amended Senior Credit Facility.
 
(Continued)
 
130

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
(d)
We acquired long-term debt upon our acquisition of UUI and Unicom effective June 1, 2008, from the RUS and CoBank.  The long-term debt is due in monthly installments of principal based on a fixed rate amortization schedule.  The interest rates on the various loans to which this debt relates range from 2.0% to 6.8%.  Through UUI and Unicom, we have $48.7 million available for borrowing for specific capital expenditures under existing borrowing arrangements.  Substantially all of the assets of UUI and Unicom are collateral for the amounts due to RUS and CoBank.
 
Maturities of long-term debt as of December 31, 2010 are as follows (amounts in thousands):

Years ending December 31,
 
 
 
2011 
  $ 2,516  
2012 
    2,462  
2013 
    2,611  
2014 
    322,199  
2015 
    22,048  
2016 and thereafter
    434,840  
 
    786,676  
Less unamortized discount paid on 2019 Notes
    3,266  
Less unamortized discount paid on 2014 Notes
    1,693  
Less current portion of long-term debt
    2,516  
 
  $ 779,201  

(7)
Income Taxes
Total income tax expense of $9.5 million, $3.9 million and $1.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, was allocated to income/loss in each year. We did not record any excess tax benefit generated from stock options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 since we are in a net operating loss carryforward position and the income tax deduction will not yet reduce income taxes payable.  The cumulative excess tax benefits generated for stock options exercised that have not been recognized is $4.6 million at December 31, 2010.

We have income tax receivables for federal and state alternative minimum tax of $0 and $1.2 million at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Income tax expense consists of the following (amounts in thousands):

 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Deferred tax expense:
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
Federal taxes
  $ 8,086       3,494       922  
State taxes
    1,402       442       155  
 
    9,488       3,936       1,077  
 
  $ 9,488       3,936       1,077  

Total income tax expense differed from the “expected” income tax expense determined by applying the statutory federal income tax rate of 35% as follows (amounts in thousands):
 
(Continued)
 
131

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
“Expected” statutory tax expense (benefit)
  $ 6,455       2,608       (803 )
 State income taxes, net of federal expense (benefit)
    1,129       456       (48 )
 Income tax effect of nondeductible entertainment expenses
    775       703       725  
 Impact of non-controlling interest attributable to non-tax paying entity
    -       -       526  
 Income tax effect of nondeductible lobbying expenses
    405       380       424  
 Income tax effect of nondeductible officer compensation
    722       761       246  
 Other, net
    2       (972 )     7  
 
  $ 9,488       3,936       1,077  

The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of deferred tax assets and liabilities at December 31, 2010 and 2009 are summarized below (amounts in thousands):

 
 
2010
   
2009
 
Current deferred tax assets, net of current deferred tax liability:
 
 
   
 
 
Compensated absences, accrued for financial reporting purposes
  $ 2,115       2,565  
Net operating loss carryforwards
    -       8,354  
Workers compensation and self insurance health reserves, principally due to accrual for financial reporting purposes
    810       580  
Accounts receivable, principally due to allowance for doubtful receivables
    3,770       2,981  
Deferred compensation expense for tax purposes in excess of amounts recognized for financial reporting purposes
    92       (270 )
Other
    3,358       3,408  
Total current deferred tax assets
  $ 10,145       17,618  
 
               
Long-term deferred tax assets:
               
Net operating loss carryforwards
  $ 88,967       74,345  
Deferred revenue for financial reporting purposes
    19,481       22,422  
Alternative minimum tax credits
    1,895       1,892  
Deferred compensation expense for tax purposes in excess of amounts recognized for financial reporting purposes
    2,908       1,093  
Asset retirement obligations in excess of amounts recognized for tax purposes
    1,885       1,775  
Share-based compensation expense for financial reporting purposes in excess of amounts recognized for tax purposes
    8,647       3,026  
Other
    1,168       4,132  
Total long-term deferred tax assets
    124,951       108,685  
 
 
(Continued)
 
132

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
 
               
Long-term deferred tax liabilities:
               
Plant and equipment, principally due to differences in depreciation
    182,490       170,260  
Intangible assets
    44,862       38,811  
Total long-term deferred tax liabilities
    227,352       209,071  
Net long-term deferred tax liabilities
  $ 102,401       100,386  

At December 31, 2010, we have tax net operating loss carryforwards of $226.4 million that will begin expiring in 2011 if not utilized, and alternative minimum tax credit carryforwards of $1.9 million available to offset regular income taxes payable in future years.  Our utilization of remaining acquired net operating loss carryforwards is subject to annual limitations pursuant to Internal Revenue Code section 382 which could reduce or defer the utilization of these losses.

We are no longer subject to U.S. or state tax examinations by tax authorities for years before 2007 except that  certain U.S. federal income tax returns for years after 1997 are not closed by relevant statutes of limitations due to unused net operating losses reported on those income tax returns.

Our tax net operating loss carryforwards are summarized below by year of expiration (amounts in thousands).

Years ending December 31,
 
Federal
   
State
 
2011 
  $ 759       759  
2018 
    1,313       1,294  
2019 
    25,942       25,391  
2020 
    44,744       43,797  
2021 
    29,614       28,987  
2022 
    14,081       13,788  
2023 
    3,968       3,903  
2024 
    722       -  
2025 
    737       -  
2026 
    150       -  
2027 
    1,010       -  
2028 
    39,879       39,715  
2029 
    48,370       47,558  
2030 
    15,157       15,022  
Total tax net operating loss carryforwards
  $ 226,446       220,214  

Tax benefits associated with recorded deferred tax assets are considered to be more likely than not realizable through taxable income earned in carryback years, future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, and future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences and carryforwards. The amount of deferred tax asset considered realizable, however, could be reduced if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced.

(8)
Financial Instruments

Fair Value of Financial Instruments
The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount at which the instrument could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing parties. At December 31, 2010 and 2009, the fair values of cash and cash equivalents, net receivables, accounts payable, accrued payroll and payroll related obligations, accrued interest, accrued liabilities, and subscriber deposits approximate their carrying value due to the short-term nature of these financial instruments. The carrying amounts and estimated fair values of our financial instruments at December 31, 2010 and 2009 follow (amounts in thousands):
 
(Continued)
 
133

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
 
 
December 31,
   
December 31,
 
 
 
2010
   
2009
 
 
 
Carrying Amount
   
Fair Value
   
Carrying Amount
   
Fair Value
 
Current and long-term debt and capital lease obligations
  $ 872,882       908,286       872,294       866,820  
Other liabilities
    73,309       72,065       72,770       71,623  

The following methods and assumptions were used to estimate fair values:

 
Current and long-term debt and capital lease obligations:  The fair values of our 2019 Notes, 2014 Notes, RUS debt, CoBank mortgage note payable, and capital leases are based upon quoted market prices for the same or similar issues or on the current rates offered to us for the same remaining maturities.  The fair value of our amended Senior Credit Facility is estimated to approximate the carrying value because this instrument is subject to variable interest rates.

 
Other Liabilities:  Lease escalation liabilities are valued at the discounted amount of future cash flows using quoted market prices on current rates offered to us. Deferred compensation liabilities are carried at fair value, which is the amount payable as of the balance sheet date. Asset retirement obligations are recorded at their fair value and, over time, the liability is accreted to its present value each period. Our non-employee share-based compensation awards are reported at their fair value at each reporting period.

Fair Value Measurements
ASC Topic 820 “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures” established a three-tiered fair value hierarchy that prioritizes inputs to valuation techniques used in fair value calculations. Level 1 inputs, the highest priority, are quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Level 2 inputs reflect other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are either observable directly or through corroboration with observable market data. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs, due to little or no market activity for the asset or liability, such as internally-developed valuation models.  We have applied the provisions of Topic 820 to our trading securities and the assets of our deferred compensation plan (primarily mutual funds).
 
 Assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
Fair Value Measurement at Reporting Date Using
 
December 31, 2010 Assets
 
Quoted Prices in Active Markets for Identical Assets (Level 1)
   
Significant Other Observable Inputs (Level 2)
   
Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3)
 
Deferred compensation plan assets (mutual funds)
    1,678       -       -  
Total assets at fair value
  $ 1,678       -       -  
 
                       
December 31, 2009 Assets
                       
Money market funds
  $ 12       -       -  
U.S. government and agency obligations
    883       -       -  
Deferred compensation plan assets (mutual funds)
    1,522       -       -  
Total assets at fair value
  $ 2,417       -       -  
 
(Continued)
 
134

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
The valuation of our marketable securities, money markets funds, and mutual funds are determined using quoted market prices in active markets utilizing market observable inputs.

(9)
Stockholders’ Equity

Common Stock
GCI’s Class A and Class B common stock are identical in all respects, except that each share of Class A common stock has one vote per share and each share of Class B common stock has ten votes per share. Each share of Class B common stock outstanding is convertible, at the option of the holder, into one share of Class A common stock.

During the year ended December 31, 2010, we repurchased 8.0 million shares of our Class A and Class B common stock at a cost of $80.8 million, pursuant to the Class A and Class B common stock repurchase program authorized by GCI’s Board of Directors.  There were no repurchases during the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.  During the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 we retired 8.0 million, 219,000, and 540,000 shares, respectively, of our Class A and Class B common stock.

Shared-Based Compensation
Our Amended and Restated 1986 Stock Option Plan ("Stock Option Plan"), provides for the grant of options and restricted stock awards (collectively "award") for a maximum of 15.7 million shares of GCI Class A common stock, subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of stock dividends, stock splits, mergers, consolidations or certain other changes in corporate structure or capitalization. If an award expires or terminates, the shares subject to the award will be available for further grants of awards under the Stock Option Plan. The Compensation Committee of GCI’s Board of Directors administers the Stock Option Plan. Substantially all restricted stock awards granted vest over periods of up to three years. Substantially all options vest in equal installments over a period of five years and expire ten years from the date of grant. The requisite service period of our awards is generally the same as the vesting period.  Options granted pursuant to the Stock Option Plan are only exercisable if at the time of exercise the option holder is our employee, non-employee director, or a consultant or advisor working on our behalf. New shares are issued when stock option agreements are exercised or restricted stock awards are granted.

The fair value of restricted stock awards is determined based on the number of shares granted and the quoted price of our common stock.  We use a Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing model to estimate the fair value of stock options issued.  The Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing model incorporates various and highly subjective assumptions, including expected term and expected volatility. We have reviewed our historical pattern of option exercises and have determined that meaningful differences in option exercise activity existed among employee job categories. Therefore, we have categorized these awards into two groups of employees for valuation purposes.

We estimated the expected term of options granted by evaluating the vesting period of stock options, employee’s past exercise and post-vesting employment departure behavior, and expected volatility of the price of the underlying shares.

We estimated the expected volatility of our common stock at the grant date using the historical volatility of our common stock over the most recent period equal to the expected stock option term and evaluated the extent to which available information indicated that future volatility may differ from historical volatility.

The risk-free interest rate assumption was determined using the Federal Reserve nominal rates for U.S. Treasury zero-coupon bonds with maturities similar to those of the expected term of the award being valued. We have never paid any cash dividends on our common stock and we do not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Therefore, we assumed an expected dividend yield of zero.

(Continued)
 
135

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
The following table shows our assumptions used to compute the share-based compensation expense for stock options granted during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008:

 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Expected term (years)
    5.0 – 6.5       5.2 – 6.8       5.2 – 6.8  
Volatility
    52.6% – 55.8 %     53.6% – 59.1 %     47.6% – 55.4 %
Risk-free interest rate
    2.0% – 2.9 %     1.7% – 3.2 %     1.6% – 3.4 %

We estimate pre-vesting option forfeitures at the time of grant and periodically revise those estimates in subsequent periods if actual forfeitures differ from those estimates. We record share-based compensation expense only for those awards expected to vest using an estimated forfeiture rate based on our historical pre-vesting forfeiture data.

A summary of option activity under the Stock Option Plan as of December 31, 2010 and changes during the year then ended is presented below (share amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
 
 
Weighted
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
Weighted
 
Average
 
Aggregate
 
 
 
 
   
Average
 
Remaining
 
Intrinsic
 
 
 
 
   
Exercise
 
Contractual
 
Value
 
 
 
Shares
   
Price
 
Term
 
(in thousands)
 
Outstanding at January 1, 2010
    1,627     $ 7.35  
 
 
 
 
Granted
    203     $ 5.34  
 
 
 
 
Exercised
    (116 )   $ 5.67  
 
 
 
 
Forfeited and retired
    (466 )   $ 7.60  
 
 
 
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2010
    1,249     $ 7.08  
4.5 years
  $ 6,976  
Exercisable at December 31, 2010
    914     $ 7.33  
3.1 years
  $ 4,885  
  Available for grant at December 31, 2010
    4,180          
 
       

The weighted average grant date fair value of options granted during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $2.84 per share, $3.49 per share and $3.10 per share, respectively.  The total fair value of options vesting during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 was $377,000, $110,000 and $3.3 million, respectively.  The total intrinsic values, determined as of the date of exercise, of options exercised in the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 were $511,000, $120,000 and $214,000, respectively. We received $659,000, $423,000 and $416,000 in cash from stock option exercises in the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

A summary of nonvested restricted stock award activity under the Stock Option Plan for the year ended December 31, 2010, follows (share amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Weighted
 
 
 
 
   
Average
 
 
 
 
   
Grant Date
 
 
 
Shares
   
Fair Value
 
Nonvested at January 1, 2010
    2,225     $ 5.69  
Granted
    336     $ 7.55  
Vested
    (233 )   $ 8.30  
Forfeited
    (132 )   $ 12.51  
Nonvested at December 31, 2010
    2,196     $ 5.29  
 
(Continued)
 
136

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
The following is a summary of our share-based compensation expense for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 (in thousands):

 
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Employee share-based compensation expense
  $ 5,385       5,709       7,282  
Expense reversal for performance based options and awards not expected to vest
    -       (2,134 )     -  
Adjustment to fair value of liability classified awards
    1,348       (771 )     (4 )
  Total share-based compensation expense
  $ 6,733       2,804       7,278  

Share-based compensation expense is classified as selling, general and administrative expense in our consolidated Statements of Operations.  Unrecognized share-based compensation expense was $4.9 million relating to 2.2 million restricted stock awards and $732,000 relating to 335,000 unvested stock options as of December 31, 2010.  We expect to recognize share-based compensation expense over a weighted average period of 1.9 years for stock options and 1.5 years for restricted stock awards.

The following is a summary of activity for stock option grants that were made not pursuant to the Stock Option Plan for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 (share amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
Weighted
 
 
 
 
   
Average
 
 
 
 
   
Exercise
 
 
 
Shares
   
Price
 
Outstanding at December 31, 2008 and 2009
    150     $ 6.50  
Options forfeited and retired
    (150 )   $ 6.50  
Outstanding at December 31, 2010
    -          
Available for grant at December 31, 2010
    -          

In January 2001 we entered into an aircraft operating lease agreement with a company owned by our President and Chief Executive Officer.  The lease was amended effective January 1, 2002, February 25, 2005 and December 27, 2010.  Upon signing the lease, the lessor was granted an option to purchase 250,000 shares of GCI Class A common stock at $6.50 per share, of which 100,000 shares were exercised during the year ended December 31, 2006 and the remaining 150,000 shares expired on March 31, 2010.

On August 6, 2009, we filed a Tender Offer Statement on Schedule TO (“Exchange Offer”) with the SEC.  The Exchange Offer was an offer by us to eligible officers, employees and stakeholders, other than officers of GCI who also serve on GCI’s Board of Directors (“Participants”) to exchange, on a grant-by-grant basis, their outstanding eligible stock options that were granted under our Stock Option Plan, whether vested or unvested, for shares of restricted stock of GCI Class A common stock that we granted under the Stock Option Plan (“Restricted Stock”). Generally, eligible options included all options issued pursuant to the Stock Option Plan between January 1, 1999, and February 15, 2009, excluding any options that vest based on EBITDA performance (“Eligible Options”).  We accepted for cancellation, Eligible Options to purchase 5,241,700 shares of GCI Class A common stock from 166 Participants, representing approximately 86% of the options eligible for exchange in the offer with a fair value of $6.2 million as of the date of the exchange.  We issued 1,908,890 shares of Restricted Stock to Participants, with a fair value of $7.1 million as of the date of the exchange, in each case, in accordance with the terms of the Exchange Offer.

In accordance with the terms of the Restricted Stock agreement, one-half of the Restricted Stock received in exchange for eligible options will vest on December 20, 2011 with the remainder vesting on February 28, 2012. The number of shares of Restricted Stock that were offered in exchange for each eligible option was equal to the lesser of (i) a number of shares of Restricted Stock having a fair value
 
(Continued)
 
137

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
equal to 100% of the fair value of the eligible options exchanged for shares of Restricted Stock, or (ii) a number of shares of Restricted Stock equal to 40% of the number of shares issuable pursuant to the eligible options surrendered.

The exchange of stock options for Restricted Stock was treated as a modification of the stock options.  The remaining unamortized stock compensation expense related to the original options will continue to be amortized over the vesting period of the Restricted Stock.  The compensation expense for the incremental difference between the fair value of the Restricted Stock and the fair value of the original options on the date of modification, reflecting the current facts and circumstances on the modification date, will be amortized over the vesting period of the Restricted Stock.  The incremental share-based compensation expense related to the modification, net of estimated forfeitures, is $940,000, of which $378,000 and $122,000 was expensed in the years ending December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  We used a lattice model to value the options exchanged for Restricted Stock for purposes of determining our incremental share-based compensation expense.

Employee Stock Purchase Plan
In 1986, we adopted an Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“GCI 401(k) Plan”) qualified under Section 401 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986. The GCI 401(k) Plan provides for acquisition of GCI’s Class A common stock at market value as well as various mutual funds. The GCI 401(k) Plan permits each employee who has completed one year of service to elect to participate. Eligible employees could elect to reduce their compensation by up to 50 percent of such compensation (subject to certain limitations) up to a maximum of $16,500 during the year ended December 31, 2010.  Contributions may be made on either a pretax or Roth basis.

Eligible employees were allowed to make catch-up contributions of no more than $5,500 during the year ended December 31, 2010 and will be able to make such contributions limited to $5,500 during the year ended December 31, 2011. We do not match employee catch-up contributions.

We may match up to 100% of employee salary reductions in any amount, decided by GCI’s Board of Directors each year, but not more than 10 percent of any one employee’s compensation will be matched in any year. Matching contributions vest over the initial six years of employment. For the year ended December 31, 2010, the combination of employee and matching contributions (pre-tax contributions and Roth basis) could not exceed the lesser of 100 percent of an employee’s compensation or $33,000 excluding catch-up contributions. For the year ended December 31, 2009, the combination of pre-tax contributions, after tax contributions and matching contributions could not exceed the lesser of 100 percent of an employee’s compensation or $49,000 excluding catch-up contributions.

Employee contributions receive up to 100% matching and employees self-direct their matching investment. Our matching contributions allocated to participant accounts totaled $6.9 million, $6.2 million, and $5.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009, and 2008, respectively.  We used cash to fund all of our employer-matching contributions during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008.

(10)
Industry Segments Data
Our reportable segments are business units that offer different products and are each managed separately.

A description of our reportable segments follows:

Consumer - We offer a full range of voice, video, data and wireless services to residential customers.

Network Access - We offer a full range of voice, data and wireless services to common carrier customers.

Commercial - We offer a full range of voice, video, data and wireless services to small businesses, local, national and global businesses, governmental entities and public and private educational institutions.

(Continued)
 
138

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Managed Broadband - We offer data services to rural school districts, hospitals and health clinics through our SchoolAccess® and ConnectMD® initiatives and managed video conferencing.

Regulated Operations - We offer voice and data services to residential, business, and governmental customers in areas of rural Alaska.

Corporate related expenses including engineering, information technology, accounting, legal and regulatory, human resources, and other general and administrative expenses for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 are allocated to our segments using segment margin for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007, respectively.  Bad debt expense for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 is allocated to our segments using a combination of specific identification and allocations based upon segment revenue for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Corporate related expenses and bad debt expense are specifically identified for our Regulated Operations segment and therefore, are not included in the allocations.

We evaluate performance and allocate resources based on earnings before depreciation and amortization expense, net interest expense, income taxes, share-based compensation expense, accretion expense and non-cash contribution adjustment (“Adjusted EBITDA”). Management believes that this measure is useful to investors and other users of our financial information in evaluating operating profitability as an analytical indicator of income generated to service debt and fund capital expenditures.  In addition, multiples of current or projected EBITDA are used to estimate current or prospective enterprise value.  The accounting policies of the reportable segments are the same as those described in the summary of significant accounting policies in note 1.  Intersegment sales are recorded at cost plus an agreed upon intercompany profit.

We earn all revenues through sales of services and products within the United States. All of our long-lived assets are located within the United States of America, except approximately 82% of our undersea fiber optic cable systems which transit international waters and all of our satellite transponders.

Summarized financial information for our reportable segments for the years ended December 31, 2010 2009 and 2008 follows (amounts in thousands):

 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
Consumer
   
Network Access
   
Commercial
   
Managed Broadband
   
Regulated Operations
   
Total Reportable Segments
 
2010 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
Revenues:
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
Intersegment
  $ -       -       5,442       -       176       5,618  
External
    342,898       107,227       128,458       49,962       22,705       651,250  
Total revenues
    342,898       107,227       133,900       49,962       22,881       656,868  
Cost of Goods Sold:
                                               
Intersegment
    -       600       2,515       -       176       3,291  
External
    104,481       25,030       59,885       14,012       4,409       207,817  
Total Cost of Goods Sold
    104,481       25,630       62,400       14,012       4,585       211,108  
Contribution:
                                               
Intersegment
    -       (600 )     2,927       -       -       2,327  
External
    238,417       82,197       68,573       35,950       18,296       443,433  
Total contribution
    238,417       81,597       71,500       35,950       18,296       445,760  
Less SG&A
    127,130       33,566       38,838       17,338       11,936       228,808  
Plus share-based compensation
    3,361       1,598       1,117       651       6       6,733  
Plus non-cash contribution expense
    (81 )     (41 )     (24 )     (14 )     -       (160 )
Plus accretion
    149       71       43       26       -       289  
Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 114,716       50,259       30,871       19,275       6,366       221,487  
 
(Continued)
 
139

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
 
 
                                               
2009 
                                               
Revenues:
                                               
Intersegment
  $ -       419       5,729       -       192       6,340  
External
    294,925       122,072       110,135       44,875       23,804       595,811  
Total revenues
    294,925       122,491       115,864       44,875       23,996       602,151  
Cost of Goods Sold:
                                               
Intersegment
    419       600       2,694       -       192       3,905  
External
    96,894       27,253       52,245       11,135       6,149       193,676  
Total Cost of Goods Sold
    97,313       27,853       54,939       11,135       6,341       197,581  
Contribution:
                                               
Intersegment
    (419 )     (181 )     3,035       -       -       2,435  
External
    198,031       94,819       57,890       33,740       17,655       402,135  
Total contribution
    197,612       94,638       60,925       33,740       17,655       404,570  
Less SG&A
    112,883       38,348       35,363       14,450       11,627       212,671  
Plus share-based compensation
    1,145       891       549       219       -       2,804  
Plus non-cash contribution expense
    294       201       98       47       -       640  
Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 86,587       57,563       23,174       19,556       6,028       192,908  
 
                                               
2008 
                                               
Revenues:
                                               
Intersegment
  $ 84       916       5,808       -       157       6,965  
External
    255,632       153,821       114,660       37,047       14,282       575,442  
Total revenues
    255,716       154,737       120,468       37,047       14,439       582,407  
Cost of Goods Sold:
                                               
Intersegment
    656       685       2,821       125       97       4,384  
External
    89,853       40,326       59,480       10,265       3,134       203,058  
Total Cost of Goods Sold
    90,509       41,011       62,301       10,390       3,231       207,442  
Contribution:
                                               
Intersegment
    (572 )     231       2,987       (125 )     60       2,581  
External
    165,779       113,495       55,180       26,782       11,148       372,384  
Total contribution
    165,207       113,726       58,167       26,657       11,208       374,965  
Less SG&A
    110,364       43,057       36,191       13,132       7,562       210,306  
Plus share-based compensation
    2,891       2,443       1,392       552       -       7,278  
Plus non-cash contribution expense
    199       177       76       28       -       480  
Plus non-controlling interest
    661       589       253       -       -       1,503  
Plus other expense
    (217 )     -       -       -       -       (217 )
Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 58,949       73,647       20,710       14,230       3,586       171,122  

A reconciliation of reportable segment revenues to consolidated revenues follows (amounts in thousands):
 
(Continued)
 
140

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Reportable segment revenues
  $ 656,868       602,151       582,407  
Less intersegment revenues eliminated in consolidation
    5,618       6,340       6,965  
Consolidated revenues
  $ 651,250       595,811       575,442  

A reconciliation of reportable segment Adjusted EBITDA to consolidated income (loss) before income tax expense follows (amounts in thousands):

Years Ended December 31,
 
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Reportable segment Adjusted EBITDA
  $ 221,487       192,908       171,122  
Less depreciation and amortization expense
    (126,114 )     (123,362 )     (114,369 )
Less share-based compensation expense
    (6,733 )     (2,804 )     (7,278 )
(Less) plus non-cash contribution expense
    160       (640 )     (480 )
Less net loss attributable to non-controlling interest
    -       -       (1,503 )
Less accretion expense
    (289 )     -       -  
Plus other expense
    -       -       217  
Consolidated operating income
    88,511       66,102       47,709  
Less other expense, net
    (70,068 )     (58,650 )     (50,004 )
Consolidated income (loss) before income tax expense
  $ 18,443       7,452       (2,295 )

Assets at December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 and capital expenditures for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 are not allocated to reportable segments as our Chief Operating Decision Maker does not review a balance sheet or capital expenditures by segment to make decisions about resource allocations or to evaluate segment performance.

We did not have any major customers for the year ended December 31, 2010. We earned revenues included in the Network Access segment from a major customer for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, net of discounts, of $64.5 million and $65.0 million, respectively. As a percentage of total revenues, our major customer’s revenues totaled 11% for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008.

(11)
Related Party Transactions
We entered into a long-term capital lease agreement in 1991 with the wife of our President and CEO for property occupied by us. The leased asset was capitalized in 1991 at the owner’s cost of $900,000 and the related obligation was recorded.  The lease agreement was amended in April 2008 and our existing capital lease asset and liability increased $1.3 million to record the extension of this capital lease. The amended lease terminates on September 30, 2026.

In January 2001 we entered into an aircraft operating lease agreement with a company owned by our President and CEO. The lease was amended effective January 1, 2002, February 25, 2005 and December 27, 2010.  The lease term is month-to-month and may be terminated at any time upon one hundred and twenty days written notice. The monthly lease rate is $75,000. Upon signing the lease, the lessor was granted an option to purchase 250,000 shares of GCI Class A common stock at $6.50 per share, of which 100,000 shares were exercised during the year ended December 31, 2006 and the remaining 150,000 shares expired on March 31, 2010.  We paid a deposit of $1.5 million in connection with the lease.  The deposit will be repaid to us upon the earlier of six months after the agreement terminates, or nine months after the date of a termination notice.  In December 2010 we paid $350,000 to the lessor for the right to return the aircraft to the lessor in the same condition it was in on December 27, 2010.
 
(Continued)
 
141

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
(12)
Commitments and Contingencies

Operating Leases as Lessee
We lease business offices, have entered into site lease agreements and use satellite transponder and fiber capacity and certain equipment pursuant to operating lease arrangements. Many of our leases are for multiple years and contain renewal options.  Rental costs, including immaterial amounts of contingent rent expense, under such arrangements amounted to $31.0 million, $29.5 million and $35.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

Capital Leases as Lessee
We entered into a long-term capital lease agreement in 1991 with the wife of our President and CEO for property occupied by us as further described in note 11.

On March 31, 2006, through our subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. we entered into an agreement to lease transponder capacity on Intelsat, Ltd.’s (“Intelsat”) Galaxy 18 spacecraft that successfully launched on May 21, 2008. We are also leasing capacity on the Horizons 1 satellite, which is owned jointly by Intelsat and JSAT International, Inc.  The leased capacity replaced our existing transponder capacity on Intelsat’s Galaxy XR satellite.

The Intelsat Galaxy 18 C-band and Ku-Band transponders are being leased over an expected term of 14 years. The present value of the lease payments, excluding telemetry, tracking and command services and back-up protection, was $98.6 million. We recorded a capital lease obligation and an addition to our Property and Equipment at December 31, 2008.

In June 2008 Galaxy XR was taken out of service resulting in the removal of the remaining $8.8 million net book value and the recognition of an $8.8 million warranty receivable.  We applied $8.4 million of the warranty receivable to offset our cash obligation relating to the capital lease during the year ended December 31, 2008, resulting in an outstanding warranty receivable of $465,000 as of December 31, 2008.  During the year ended December 31, 2009, we applied the remaining $465,000 of the warranty receivable to offset our cash obligation.

A summary of future minimum lease payments follows (amounts in thousands):

Years ending December 31:
 
Operating
   
Capital
 
2011 
  $ 21,435       11,672  
2012 
    17,614       11,732  
2013 
    16,312       11,742  
2014 
    14,653       11,752  
2015 
    13,764       11,761  
2016 and thereafter
    67,515       78,471  
Total minimum lease payments
  $ 151,293       137,130  
Less amount representing interest
            45,965  
Less current maturity of obligations under capital leases
            5,136  
Long-term obligations under capital leases, excluding
  current maturity
          $ 86,029  

The leases generally provide that we pay the taxes, insurance and maintenance expenses related to the leased assets. Several of our leases include renewal options, escalation clauses and immaterial amounts of contingent rent expense. We expect that in the normal course of business leases that expire will be renewed or replaced by leases on other properties.

 
(Continued)
 
142

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Operating Leases as Lessor and IRU Revenue
We enter into lease or service arrangements for IRU capacity on our fiber optic cable systems with third parties and for many of these leases or service arrangements, we received up-front cash payments.  We have $50.1 million and $52.9 million in deferred revenue at December 31, 2010 and 2009 respectively, representing cash received from customers for which we will recognize revenue in the future.  The arrangements under operating lease or service arrangements expire on various dates through 2029.  The revenue will be recognized over the term of the agreements.

A summary of minimum future lease or service arrangement cash receipts including IRUs and the provision of certain other service are as follows (amounts in thousands):

Years ending December 31,
 
 
 
2011 
  $ 6,741  
2012 
    6,697  
2013 
    6,628  
2014 
    6,140  
2015 
    5,005  
2016 and thereafter
    38,042  
Total minimum future service revenues
  $ 69,253  

The cost of assets that are leased to customers is $256.2 million and $251.5 million as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The carrying value of assets leased to customers is $159.4 million and $166.2 million as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Letters of Credit
We have letters of credit totaling $2.7 million outstanding under our amended Senior Credit Facility as follows:
·  
$2.4 million to secure payment of certain access charges associated with our provision of telecommunications services within the State of Alaska,
·  
$249,000 to meet obligations associated with our insurance arrangements, and
·  
$100,000 to secure right of way access.

Wireless Service Equipment Obligation
We have entered into an agreement to purchase hardware, software, and equipment capable of providing wireless service to small markets in rural Alaska as a reliable substitute for standard wire line service.  The agreement has a total remaining commitment of $4.8 million.  We paid $2.9 million, $5.2 million and $3.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and expect to pay $284,000 and $4.5 million during the years ended December 31, 2011, and 2012, respectively.

Guaranteed Service Levels
Certain customers have guaranteed levels of service with varying terms. In the event we are unable to provide the minimum service levels we may incur penalties or issue credits to customers.

(Continued)
 
143

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Self-Insurance
Through December 31, 2010, we were self-insured for losses and liabilities related primarily to health and welfare claims up to $200,000 per incident and $2.0 million per lifetime per beneficiary above which third party insurance applied.  Effective January 1, 2011, these limits are $500,000 per incident and $2.0 million per lifetime.  A reserve of $1.6 million and $1.1 million was recorded at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively, to cover estimated reported losses, estimated unreported losses based on past experience modified for current trends, and estimated expenses for settling claims. We are self-insured up to $500,000 per incident for losses and liabilities related to workers’ compensation claims and have an insurance policy for any losses in excess of $500,000 per incident.  A reserve of $1.8 million and $72,000 was recorded at December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively, to cover estimated reported losses and estimated expenses for investigating and settling claims.  $1.3 million was included in this reserve for the year ended December 31, 2010 for the GCI-owned aircraft accident further discussed below.  Actual losses will vary from the recorded reserves. While we use what we believe are pertinent information and factors in determining the amount of reserves, future additions to the reserves may be necessary due to changes in the information and factors used.

We are self-insured for damage or loss to certain of our transmission facilities, including our buried, undersea, and above-ground transmission lines. If we become subject to substantial uninsured liabilities due to damage or loss to such facilities, our financial position, results of operations or liquidity may be adversely affected.

Litigation, Disputes, and Regulatory Matters
We are involved in various lawsuits, billing disputes, legal proceedings, and regulatory matters that have arisen from time to time in the normal course of business. While the ultimate results of these items cannot be predicted with certainty we do not expect, at this time, that the resolution of them will have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or liquidity.  In addition we are involved in the following matters:

·  
In September 2008, the FCC’s Office of Inspector General initiated an investigation regarding Alaska DigiTel’s compliance with program rules and requirements under the Lifeline Program. The request covered the period beginning January 1, 2004 through August 31, 2008 and related to amounts received for Lifeline service.  Alaska DigiTel was an Alaska based wireless communications company of which we acquired an 81.9% equity interest on January 2, 2007 and the remaining 18.1% equity interest on August 18, 2008 and was subsequently merged with one of our wholly owned subsidiaries in April 2009. Prior to August 18, 2008, our control over the operations of Alaska DigiTel was limited as required by the FCC upon its approval of our initial acquisition completed in January 2007. We responded to this request on behalf of Alaska DigiTel and the GCI companies as affiliates.  On January 18, 2011, we reached an agreement with the FCC and the Department of Justice to settle the matter, which required us to contribute $1.6 million to the United States Treasury and grants us a broad release of claims including those under the False Claims Act.  The $1.6 million contribution, of which $154,000, $661,000 and $741,000 was recognized in selling, general and administrative expense in the Statement of Operations in the years ending December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, was paid in January 2011; and
·  
In August 2010, a GCI-owned aircraft was involved in an accident resulting in five fatalities and injuries to the remaining four passengers on board.  We had aircraft and liability insurance coverage in effect at the time of the accident.  We cannot predict the likelihood or nature of any potential claims related to the accident.

Universal Service
The USF pays ETCs to support the provision of local service in high cost areas. Under FCC regulations and RCA orders, we are an authorized competitive ETC for purposes of providing wireless and wireline telephone service in Anchorage, Juneau, Fairbanks, and the Matanuska Telephone Association study area (which includes the Matanuska-Susitna Valley) and other less populated areas throughout Alaska. Without ETC status, we would not qualify for USF support in these areas or other rural areas where we propose to offer wireline and wireless local services, and our revenue for providing local services in these areas would be materially adversely affected.

(Continued)
 
144

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
On May 1, 2008, the FCC issued an order adopting the recommendation of the Federal State Joint Board on Universal Service to impose a state-by-state interim cap on high cost funds to be distributed to competitive ETCs.  As part of the revised policy, the FCC adopted a limited exception from the cap for competitive ETCs serving tribal lands or Alaska Native regions.  While the operation of the cap has generally reduced the high cost fund amounts available to competitive ETCs as new competitive ETCs are designated and as existing competitive ETCs acquire new customers, providers like us who serve tribal lands or Alaska Native regions were provided some relief.  On March 5, 2009, the FCC issued an additional order waiving a previously adopted limitation to the exception, the result of which was to provide uncapped support for all lines served by competitive ETCs for tribal lands or Alaska Native regions during the time the interim cap is in effect.  The uncapped support for tribal lands or Alaska Native regions and the cap for all other regions will be in place until the FCC takes action on proposals for long term reform.

On March 16, 2010, the FCC staff released the National Broadband Plan, including among its topics a proposal to transition existing USF high cost support from voice to broadband networks over a 10-year period.  On April 21, 2010, the FCC initiated a proceeding to consider interim and long-term USF reforms, including a five-year phase-out of support to competitive ETCs.  On February 8, 2011, the FCC issued a Notice of Proposed Rulemaking to consider adopting reforms to its high cost support program, including, among other things, the proposed competitive ETC phase-out and ways to fund and distribute support for broadband services.  We cannot predict at this time the outcome of this proceeding or its effect on high cost support available to us, but our revenue for providing local services in these areas would be materially adversely affected by the reduction of USF support. 

Cable Service Rate Reregulation
Federal law permits regulation of basic cable programming services rates. However, Alaska law provides that cable television service is exempt from regulation by the RCA unless 25% of a system’s subscribers request such regulation by filing a petition with the RCA. At December 31, 2010, only the Juneau system is subject to RCA regulation of its basic service rates. No petition requesting regulation has been filed for any other system. The Juneau system serves 7% of our total basic service subscribers at December 31, 2010.

Alaska Wireless Contingent Payment
On July 1, 2008 we completed the acquisition of all of the ownership interests in Alaska Wireless.  We made an initial payment on the acquisition date and an additional payment of $5.2 million in February 2010 that was contingent on the achievement of certain financial conditions.  The commitment was accrued at December 31, 2009.

Code Division Multiple Access (“CDMA”) Network Expansion
During 2007 Alaska DigiTel and GCI signed an agreement with a customer to build-out Alaska DigiTel's CDMA network with various milestones through 2012 to provide expanded roaming area coverage.  If we fail to meet the schedule, the customer has the right to terminate the agreement and we may be required to pay up to $16.0 million as liquidated damages.  We expect to meet the deadlines imposed by the build-out schedule and therefore expect our expenditures to result in an expansion of our wireless facilities rather than payment of the liquidated damages.

TERRA-Southwest
In January 2010 the U.S. Department of Agriculture’s RUS approved our wholly-owned subsidiary, UUI’s application for an $88.2 million loan/grant combination to extend terrestrial broadband service for the first time to Bristol Bay and the Yukon-Kuskokwim Delta, an area in Alaska roughly the size of the state of North Dakota.  Upon completion, TERRA-Southwest (“TERRA-SW”) will be able to serve over 9,000 households and over 700 businesses in the 65 covered communities.  The project will also be able to serve numerous public/non-profit/private community anchor institutions and entities, such as regional health care providers, school districts, and other regional and Alaska native organizations. The RUS award, consisting of a $44.2 million loan and a $44.0 million grant, will be made under the RUS Broadband Initiatives Program established pursuant to the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act.  The award will fund backbone network facilities that we would not otherwise be able to construct within our return-on-investment requirements.  UUI started construction on TERRA-SW in 2010 and expects to complete the project in 2012 or earlier if possible.
 
(Continued)
 
145

 
GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 

 
(13)
Non-controlling Interest
On January 1, 2009 we adopted ASC Topic 810-10-65-1, “Consolidation” (formerly SFAS No. 160, “Non-Controlling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements, an Amendment of Accounting Research Bulletin No. 51”).  As a result of the required retrospective application of the presentation and disclosure provisions, loss before income tax expense changed from $792 previously reported to $2,295 for the year ended December 31, 2008. Our loss previously reported was $1,869 and is now $3,372 for the year ended December 31, 2008.  There was no change in total stockholder’s equity as of December 31, 2008.  There were no adjustments to the consolidated statements of cash flows or basic or diluted EPS attributable to GCI for the year ended December 31, 2008.

(14)
Fourth Quarter Results of Operations (Unaudited)

The following is a summary of unaudited quarterly results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands, except per share amounts):

2010 
First
Second
Third
Fourth
Quarter
Quarter
Quarter
Quarter
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total revenues
$
 152,419 
 162,326 
 171,509 
 164,996 
Operating income
$
 19,129 
 25,048 
 30,203 
 14,131 
Net income (loss) attributable to GCI
$
 1,674 
 1,930 
 7,583 
 (2,232)
Basic net income (loss) attributable to GCI per common share
$
 0.03 
 0.04 
 0.14 
 (0.05)
Diluted net income (loss) attributable to GCI per common share
$
 0.03 
 0.04 
 0.14 
 (0.05)
 
 
 
 
 
 
2009 
 
 
 
 
 
Total revenues
$
 148,689 
 148,796 
 150,816 
 147,510 
Operating income
$
 13,512 
 18,559 
 20,730 
 13,301 
Net income (loss) attributable to GCI
$
 354 
 2,564 
 4,336 
 (3,738)
Basic net income (loss) attributable to GCI per common share
$
 0.01 
 0.05 
 0.08 
 (0.07)
Diluted net income (loss) attributable  to GCI per common share
$
0.00
0.05 
0.08 
(0.07)

During the fourth quarter of 2009, we recognized $1.9 million in interest expense resulting from the write-off of the original issue discount on our Senior Credit Facility, our interest expense increased $1.0 million due to the issuance of $425.0 million in additional Senior Notes, we recognized $1.0 million in interest expense resulting from the write-off of deferred loan costs on our Senior Credit Facility, we recorded an $862,000 adjustment to decrease wireless revenue to correct the accrual of wireless plan fee and usage revenue reported in prior quarters, and we recorded a $760,000 increase to the Allowance for Doubtful Receivables to reserve for a certain customer account receivable.

(15)
Subsequent Events
On January 18, 2011, we repaid $5.0 million of our outstanding long-term debt.  On February 15, 2011 and February 25, 2011, we borrowed $8.0 million and $5.0 million, respectively, under our amended Senior Credit Facility.  After consideration of these transactions, we have $44.3 million available for borrowing under our revolving credit facility.

 
146

 


Item 15(b). Exhibits

Listed below are the exhibits that are filed as a part of this Report (according to the number assigned to them in Item 601 of Regulation S-K):

Exhibit No.
Description
3.1 
Restated Articles of Incorporation of the Company dated August 20, 2007 (37)
3.2 
Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company dated August 20, 2007 (36)
4.1 
Certified copy of the General Communication, Inc. Amendment No. 1, dated as of June 25, 2007, to the Amended and Restated 1986 Stock Option Plan (33)
10.3 
Westin Building Lease (3)
10.4 
Duncan and Hughes Deferred Bonus Agreements (4)
10.5 
Compensation Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and William C. Behnke dated January 1, 1997 (13)
10.6 
Order approving Application for a Certificate of Public Convenience and Necessity to operate as a Telecommunications (Intrastate Interexchange Carrier) Public Utility within Alaska (2)
10.13 
MCI Carrier Agreement between MCI Telecommunications Corporation and General Communication, Inc. dated January 1, 1993 (5)
10.14 
Contract for Alaska Access Services Agreement between MCI Telecommunications Corporation and General Communication, Inc. dated January 1, 1993 (5)
10.15 
Promissory Note Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and Ronald A. Duncan, dated August 13, 1993 (6)
10.16 
Deferred Compensation Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and Ronald A. Duncan, dated August 13, 1993 (6)
10.17 
Pledge Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and Ronald A. Duncan, dated August 13, 1993 (6)
10.20 
The GCI Special Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Plan (7)
10.21 
Transponder Purchase Agreement for Galaxy X between Hughes Communications Galaxy, Inc. and GCI Communication Corp. (7)
10.25 
Licenses: (3)
10.25.1
214 Authorization
10.25.2
International Resale Authorization
10.25.3
Digital Electronic Message Service Authorization
10.25.11
Certificate of Convenience and Public Necessity – Telecommunications Service (Local Exchange) dated July 7, 2000  (29)
10.26 
ATU Interconnection Agreement between GCI Communication Corp. and Municipality of Anchorage, executed January 15, 1997 (12)
10.29 
Asset Purchase Agreement, dated April 15, 1996, among General Communication, Inc., ACNFI, ACNJI and ACNKSI (8)
10.30 
Asset Purchase Agreement, dated May 10, 1996, among General Communication, Inc., and Alaska Cablevision, Inc. (8)
10.31 
Asset Purchase Agreement, dated May 10, 1996, among General Communication, Inc., and McCaw/Rock Homer Cable System, J.V. (8)
10.32 
Asset Purchase Agreement, dated May 10, 1996, between General Communication, Inc., and McCaw/Rock Seward Cable System, J.V. (8)
 
 
147

 
 
10.33 
Amendment No. 1 to Securities Purchase and Sale Agreement, dated October 31, 1996, among General Communication, Inc., and the Prime Sellers Agent (9)
10.34 
First Amendment to Asset Purchase Agreement, dated October 30, 1996, among General Communication, Inc., ACNFI, ACNJI and ACNKSI (9)
10.36 
Order Approving Arbitrated Interconnection Agreement as Resolved and Modified by Order U-96-89(5) dated January 14, 1997 (12)
10.37 
Amendment to the MCI Carrier Agreement executed April 20, 1994 (12)
10.38 
Amendment No. 1 to MCI Carrier Agreement executed July 26, 1994 (11)
10.39 
MCI Carrier Addendum—MCI 800 DAL Service effective February 1, 1994 (11)
10.40 
Third Amendment to MCI Carrier Agreement dated as of October 1, 1994 (11)
10.41 
Fourth Amendment to MCI Carrier Agreement dated as of September 25, 1995 (11)
10.42 
Fifth Amendment to the MCI Carrier Agreement executed April 19, 1996 (12)
10.43 
Sixth Amendment to MCI Carrier Agreement dated as of March 1, 1996 (11)
10.44 
Seventh Amendment to MCI Carrier Agreement dated November 27, 1996 (14)
10.45 
First Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and MCI Telecommunications Corporation dated April 1, 1996 (14)
10.46 
Service Mark License Agreement between MCI Communications Corporation and General Communication, Inc. dated April 13, 1994 (13)
10.47 
Radio Station Authorization (Personal Communications Service License), Issue Date June 23, 1995 (13)
10.50 
Contract No. 92MR067A Telecommunications Services between BP Exploration (Alaska), Inc. and GCI Network Systems dated April 1, 1992 (14)
10.51 
Amendment No. 03 to BP Exploration (Alaska) Inc. Contract No. 92MRO67A effective August 1, 1996 (14)
10.52 
Lease Agreement dated September 30, 1991 between RDB Company and General Communication, Inc. (2)
10.54 
Order Approving Transfer Upon Closing, Subject to Conditions, and Requiring Filings dated September 23, 1996 (13)
10.55 
Order Granting Extension of Time and Clarifying Order dated October 21, 1996 (13)
10.58 
Employment and Deferred Compensation Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and John M. Lowber dated July 1992 (13)
10.59 
Deferred Compensation Agreement between GCI Communication Corp. and Dana L. Tindall dated August 15, 1994 (13)
10.60 
Transponder Lease Agreement between General Communication Incorporated and Hughes Communications Satellite Services, Inc., executed August 8, 1989 (6)
10.61 
Addendum to Galaxy X Transponder Purchase Agreement between GCI Communication Corp. and Hughes Communications Galaxy, Inc. dated August 24, 1995 (13)
10.62 
Order Approving Application, Subject to Conditions; Requiring Filing; and Approving Proposed Tariff on an Inception Basis, dated February 4, 1997 (13)
10.66 
Supply Contract Between Submarine Systems International Ltd. And GCI Communication Corp. dated as of July 11, 1997. (15)
10.67 
Supply Contract Between Tyco Submarine Systems Ltd. And Alaska United Fiber System Partnership Contract Variation No. 1 dated as of December 1, 1997. (15)
 
 
148

 
 
10.71 
Third Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and MCI Telecommunications Corporation dated February 27, 1998 (16) #
10.80 
Fourth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI WorldCom dated January 1, 1999. (17) #
10.89 
Fifth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI WorldCom Network Services, Inc., formerly known as MCI Telecommunications Corporation dated August 7, 2000 # (18)
10.90 
Sixth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI WorldCom Network Services, Inc., formerly known as MCI Telecommunications Corporation dated February 14, 2001 # (18)
10.91 
Seventh Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI WorldCom Network Services, Inc., formerly known as MCI Telecommunications Corporation dated March 8, 2001 # (18)
10.100 
Contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated March 12, 2002 # (21)
10.102 
First Amendment to Lease Agreement dated as of September 2002 between RDB Company and GCI Communication Corp. as successor in interest to General Communication, Inc. (22)
10.103 
Agreement and plan of merger of GCI American Cablesystems, Inc. a Delaware corporation and GCI Cablesystems of Alaska, Inc. an Alaska corporation each with and into GCI Cable, Inc. an Alaska corporation, adopted as of December 10, 2002  (22)
10.104 
Articles of merger between GCI Cablesystems of Alaska, Inc. and GCI Cable, Inc., adopted as of December 10, 2002  (22)
10.105 
Aircraft lease agreement between GCI Communication Corp., and Alaska corporation and 560 Company, Inc., an Alaska corporation, dated as of January 22, 2001 (22)
10.106 
First amendment to aircraft lease agreement between GCI Communication Corp., and Alaska corporation and 560 Company, Inc., an Alaska corporation, dated as of February 8, 2002  (22)
10.108 
Bonus Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and Wilson Hughes (23)
10.109 
Eighth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI WorldCom Network Services, Inc. # (23)
10.110 
Settlement and Release Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and WorldCom, Inc. (23)
10.112 
Waiver letter agreement dated as of February 13, 2004 for Credit, Guaranty, Security and Pledge Agreement  (24)
10.113 
Indenture dated as of February 17, 2004 between GCI, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee  (24)
10.114 
Registration Rights Agreement dated as of February 17, 2004, among GCI, Inc.,  and Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., Jefferies & Company, Inc., Credit Lyonnais Securities (USA), Inc., Blaylock & Partners, L.P., Ferris, Baker Watts, Incorporated, and TD Securities (USA), Inc., as Initial Purchasers (24)
 
 
149

 
 
10.121 
First amendment to contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated July 24, 2002 # (26)
10.122 
Second amendment to contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated December 31, 2003 (26)
10.123 
Third amendment to contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated February 19, 2004 # (26)
10.124 
Fourth amendment to contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated June 30, 2004 # (26)
10.126 
Audit Committee Charter (as revised by the board of directors of General Communication, Inc. effective as of February 3, 2005)  (27)
10.127 
Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee Charter (as revised by the board of directors of General Communication, Inc. effective as of February 3, 2005)  (27)
10.128 
Fifth amendment to contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated January 22, 2005 #  (27)
10.129 
Ninth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI WorldCom Network Services, Inc. #  (28)
10.130 
Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among GCI Holdings, Inc. and Calyon New York Branch as Administrative Agent, Sole Lead Arranger, and Co-Bookrunner, The Initial Lenders and Initial Issuing Bank Named Herein as Initial Lenders and Initial Issuing Bank, General Electric Capital Corporation as Syndication Agent, and Union Bank of California, N.A., CoBank, ACB, CIT Lending Services Corporation and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. as Co-Documentation Agents, dated as of August 31, 2005  (28)
10.131 
Amended and Restated 1986 Stock Option Plan of General Communication, Inc. as of June 7, 2005  (28)
10.132 
Amendment No. 1 to $150 Million EBITDA Incentive Program dated December 30, 2005 (29)
10.134 
Full-time Transponder Capacity Agreement with PanAmSat Corporation dated March 31, 2006 #  (30)
10.135 
Tenth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formerly known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) #  (31)
10.136 
Reorganization Agreement among General Communication, Inc., Alaska DigiTel, LLC, The Members of Alaska DigiTel, LLC, AKD Holdings, LLC and The Members of Denali PCS, LLC dated as of June 16, 2006 (Nonmaterial schedules and exhibits to the Reorganization Agreement have been omitted pursuant to Item 601b.2 of Regulation S-K. We agree to furnish supplementally to the Commission upon request a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit.) #  (32)
10.137 
Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Alaska DigiTel, LLC dated as of January 1, 2007 (We agree to furnish supplementally to the Commission upon request a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit.) #  (32)
 
 
150

 
 
10.138 
Sixth amendment to contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated September 20, 2006 (33)
10.139 
Seventh amendment to contract for Alaska Access Services between Sprint Communications Company L.P. and General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp. dated January 17, 2007 # (33)
10.140 
General Communication, Inc. Director Compensation Plan dated June 29, 2006 (33)
10.141 
Eleventh Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formerly known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) # (35)
10.142 
Third Amendment to the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement among GCI Holdings, Inc., GCI Communication Corp., GCI Cable, Inc., GCI Fiber Communication Co., Potter View Development Co., Inc., and Alaska United Fiber System Partnership, GCI, Inc., the banks, financial institutions, and other lenders party hereto and Calyon New York Branch as Administrative Agent, dated as of September 14, 2007 (36)
10.143 
Joinder Agreement dated as of September 28, 2007 among BNP Paribas, U.S. Bank National Association, GCI Holdings, Inc., GCI Communication Corp., GCI Cable, Inc., GCI Fiber Communication Co., Potter View Development Co., Inc., and Alaska United Fiber System Partnership, GCI, Inc., and Calyon New York Branch as Administrative Agent (36)
10.144 
Strategic Roaming Agreement dated as of October 30, 2007 between Alaska DigiTel, LLC. And WirelessCo L.P. # (37)
10.145 
CDMA Build-out Agreement dated as of October 30, 2007 between Alaska DigiTel, LLC. and WirelessCo L.P. (Nonmaterial schedules and exhibits to the Reorganization Agreement have been omitted pursuant to Item 601b.2 of Regulation S-K. We agree to furnish supplementally to the Commission upon request a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit.) # (37)
10.146 
Long-term de Facto Transfer Spectrum Leasing agreement between Alaska DigiTel, LLC. and SprintCom, Inc. # (37)
10.147 
Twelfth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formerly known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) dated November 19, 2007 (Nonmaterial schedules and exhibits to the Reorganization Agreement have been omitted pursuant to Item 601b.2 of Regulation S-K. We agree to furnish supplementally to the Commission upon request a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit.) # (37)
10.148 
Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of October 12, 2007 among GCI Communication Corp., United Companies, Inc., Sea Lion Corporation and Togiak Natives LTD. (Nonmaterial schedules and exhibits to the Reorganization Agreement have been omitted pursuant to Item 601b.2 of Regulation S-K. We agree to furnish supplementally to the Commission upon request a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit.) (37)
10.149 
Fourth Amendment to the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of May 2, 2008 by and among GCI Holdings, Inc., the other parties thereto and Calyon New York Branch, as administrative agent, and the other Lenders party thereto (38)
 
 
151

 
 
10.150 
Second Amendment to Lease Agreement dated as of April 8, 2008 between RDB Company and GCI Communication Corp. as successor in interest to General Communication, Inc. (39)
10.151 
Audit Committee Charter (as revised by the board of directors of General Communication, Inc. effective as of April 27, 2007) (39)
10.152 
Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee Charter (as revised by the board of directors of General Communication, Inc. effective as of April 27, 2007) (39)
10.153 
Thirteenth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formally known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) dated January 16, 2008 # (39)
10.154 
Fourteenth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formally known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) dated May 15, 2008 (40)
10.155 
Contract for Alaska Access Services between the Company and Verizon, dated January 1, 1993 (41) #
10.156 
Third Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between the Company and Verizon, dated February 27, 1998 (41) #
10.157 
Fourth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between the Company and Verizon, dated January 1, 1999 (41) #
10.158 
Fifth Amendment to the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of October 17, 2008 by and among Holdings, Inc. the other parties thereto and Calyon New York Branch, as administrative agent, and the other Lenders party thereto (42)
10.159 
Amendment to Deferred Bonus Agreement dated December 31, 2008 by and among the Company, the Employer and Mr. Duncan (43)
10.160 
Amendment to Deferred Compensation Agreement dated December 31, 2008 by and among the Company, the Employer and Mr. Duncan (43)
10.161 
First Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated February 15, 2008 # (44)
10.162 
Second Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated April 9, 2008 # (44)
10.163 
Third Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated June 4, 2008 # (44)
10.164 
Fourth Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated June 4, 2008 # (44)
10.165 
Fifth Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated September 30, 2008 # (44)
10.166 
Sixth Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated October 31, 2008 # (44)
10.167 
Seventh Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated November 6, 2008 # (44)
 
 
152

 
 
 
10.168 
Eighth Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication Corp. dated June 8, 2009 # (44)
10.169 
Fifteenth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formally known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) dated May 5, 2009 # (44)
10.170 
Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement dated as of January 29, 2010 by and among GCI Holdings, Inc., the other parties thereto and Calyon New York Branch, as administrative agent, and the other Lenders party thereto (45)
10.171 
Sixteenth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formally known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) dated October 13, 2009 (46)
10.172 
Seventeenth Amendment to Contract for Alaska Access Services between General Communication, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiary GCI Communication Corp., and MCI Communications Services, Inc. d/b/a Verizon Business Services (successor-in-interest to MCI Network Services, Inc., which was formally known as MCI WorldCom Network Services) dated December 8, 2009 #  (46)
10.173 
Audit Committee Charter (as revised by the Board of Directors of General Communication, Inc. effective January 1, 2010) (47)
10.174 
Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee Charter (as revised by the Board of Directors of General Communication, Inc. effective as of January 1, 2010) (47)
10.175 
Ninth Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication, Corp. dated June 29, 2010 # (47)
10.176 
Stock Purchase Agreement between General Communication, Inc. and Arctic Slope Regional Corporation, an Alaska corporation, dated as of October 21, 2010 (48)
10.177 
Description of Incentive Compensation Guidelines for Named Executive Officers (49)
10.178 
Amended and restated aircraft lease agreement between GCI Communication Corp., and Alaska corporation and 560 Company, Inc., an Alaska corporation, dated as of February 25, 2005 *
10.179 
First amendment to the amended and restated aircraft lease agreement between GCI Communication Corp., and Alaska corporation and 560 Company, Inc., an Alaska corporation, dated as of December 27, 2010 *
10.180
Tenth Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication, Corp. dated September 24, 2010 # *
10.181 
Eleventh Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication, Corp. dated September 23, 2010 # *
 
 
153

 
 
10.182 
Twelfth Amendment to the Full-Time Transponder Capacity Agreement (Pre-Launch) between Intelsat Corporation, formerly known as PanAmSat Corporation and GCI Communication, Corp. dated November 5, 2010 # *
10.183 
Reorganization Agreement among General Communication, Inc., Alaska DigiTel, LLC, The Members of Alaska DigiTel, LLC, AKD Holdings, LLC and The Members of Denali PCS, LLC dated as of June 16, 2006 (Nonmaterial schedules and exhibits to the Reorganization Agreement have been omitted pursuant to Item 601b.2 of Regulation S-K. We agree to furnish supplementally to the Commission upon request a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit.) *
10.184 
Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Alaska DigiTel, LLC dated as of January 1, 2007 (We agree to furnish supplementally to the Commission upon request a copy of any omitted schedule or exhibit.) *
10.185 
Amendment No. 2 to the Amended and Restated 1986 Stock Option Plan of General Communication, Inc. (50)
10.186 
Amendment No. 3 to the Amended and Restated 1986 Stock Option Plan of General Communication, Inc. *
10.187 
Amended Memorandum of Understanding dated effective as of January  26, 2006 setting forth the principal terms and conditions of transactions proposed to be consummated among Alaska DigiTel, LLC, an Alaska limited liability company, all of the members of Denali PCS, LLC, an Alaska limited liability company, and General Communication, Inc., an Alaska corporation *
10.188 
Broadband Initiatives Program Loan/Grant and Security Agreement between United Utilities, Inc. and the United States of America dated as of June 1, 2010 # *
14 
Code Of Business Conduct and Ethics (originally reported as exhibit 10.118) (25)
18.1 
Letter regarding change in accounting principle (39)
21.1 
Subsidiaries of the Registrant  *
23.1 
Consent of Grant Thornton LLP (Independent Public Accountant for Company) *
23.2 
Consent of KPMG LLP (Independent Public Accountant for Company)  *
31 
Certifications Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 *
32 
Certifications Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 *
99 
Additional Exhibits:
99.1 
The Articles of Incorporation of GCI Communication Corp. (1)
99.2 
The Bylaws of GCI Communication Corp. (1)
99.7 
The Bylaws of GCI Cable, Inc. (10)
99.8 
The Articles of Incorporation of GCI Cable, Inc. (10)
99.15 
The Bylaws of GCI Holdings, Inc. (13)
99.16 
The Articles of Incorporation of GCI Holdings, Inc. (13)
99.17 
The Articles of Incorporation of GCI, Inc. (12)
99.18 
The Bylaws of GCI, Inc. (12)
99.27 
The Partnership Agreement of Alaska United Fiber System (15)
99.28 
The Bylaws of Potter View Development Co., Inc. (19)
99.29 
The Articles of Incorporation of Potter View Development Co., Inc. (19)
99.34 
The Bylaws of GCI Fiber Communication, Co., Inc. (20)
99.35 
The Articles of Incorporation of GCI Fiber Communication, Co., Inc. (20)
 
 
 
 
 
 
154

 
 
 
 
 
 
#
CONFIDENTIAL PORTION has been omitted pursuant to a request for confidential treatment by us to, and the material has been separately filed with, the SEC.  Each omitted Confidential Portion is marked by three asterisks.
*
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Exhibit Reference
Description
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1990
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1991
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Registration Statement on Form 10 (File No. 0-15279), mailed to the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 30, 1986
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1989.
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 4, 1993.
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1993.
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1995.
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Form S-4 Registration Statement dated October 4, 1996.
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 13, 1996.
10 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1996.
11 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 14, 1996, filed March 28, 1996.
12 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Form S-3 Registration Statement (File No. 333-28001) dated May 29, 1997.
13 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Amendment No. 1 to Form S-3/A Registration Statement (File No. 333-28001) dated July 8, 1997.
14 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Amendment No. 2 to Form S-3/A Registration Statement (File No. 333-28001) dated July 21, 1997.
15 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997.
16 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1998.
17 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 1999.
 
 
155

 
 
18 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2001.
19 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2001.
20 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001.
21 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2002.
22 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002.
23 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2003.
24 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
25 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2004.
26 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2004.
27 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2005.
28 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2005.
29 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005 filed March 16, 2006.
30 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2006.
31 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2006.
32 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2006 filed March 19, 2007.
33 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2007.
34 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Form S-8 filed with the SEC on July 27, 2007.
35 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2007.
36 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2007.
37 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007 filed March 7, 2008.
38 
Incorporated by reference to the Company's Report on Form 8-K for the period May 2, 2008 filed May 8, 2008.
 
 
156

 
 
39 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2008.
40 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2008.
41 
Incorporated by reference to The Company's Report on Form 8-K for the period September 19, 2008 filed on September 22, 2008.
42 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2008.
43 
Incorporated by reference to The Company's Report on Form 8-K for the period December 31, 2008 filed January 6, 2009.
44 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2009.
45 
Incorporated by reference to The Company's Report on Form 8-K for the period January 29, 2010 filed February 3, 2010.
46 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009 filed March 12, 2010.
47 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2010 filed August 5, 2010.
48 
Incorporated by reference to The Company's Report on Form 8-K for the period October 21, 2010 filed October 27, 2010.
49 
Incorporated by reference to The Company's Report on Form 8-K for the period October 7, 2010 filed October 15, 2010.
50 
Incorporated by reference to The Company’s Form SC TO-I dated August 6, 2009.

 
157

 



 
SIGNATURES


Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.

GENERAL COMMUNICATION, INC.

 
By:
  /s/ Ronald A. Duncan  
   
Ronald A. Duncan, President
 
   
(Chief Executive Officer)
 

Date:
  March 14, 2011  

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the date indicated.

Signature
 
Title
 
Date
         
  /s/ Stephen M. Brett  
Chairman of Board and Director
    March 1, 2011
Stephen M. Brett
       
         
  /s/ Ronald A. Duncan  
President and Director
    March 14, 2011
Ronald A. Duncan
 
(Principal Executive Officer)
   
         
  /s/ Jerry A. Edgerton  
Director
    March 1, 2011
Jerry A. Edgerton
       
         
  /s/ Scott M. Fisher  
Director
    March 1, 2011
Scott M. Fisher
       
         
  /s/ William P. Glasgow  
Director
    March 7, 2011
William P. Glasgow
       
         
  /s/ Mark W. Kroloff  
Director
    March 14, 2011
Mark W. Kroloff
       
         
  /s/ Stephen R. Mooney  
Director
    March 14, 2011
Stephen R. Mooney
       
         
  /s/ James M. Schneider  
Director
    March 10, 2011
James M. Schneider
       
         
  /s/ John M. Lowber  
Senior Vice President, Chief Financial
    March 14, 2011
John M. Lowber
 
Officer, Secretary and Treasurer
(Principal Financial Officer)
   
         
  /s/ Lynda L. Tarbath  
Vice President, Chief Accounting Officer
    March 14, 2011
Lynda L. Tarbath
 
(Principal Accounting Officer)
   


 
158